You are on page 1of 621

PureBallast Ballast Water Treatment System

PureBallast Ballast Water Treatment System


System Manual - PureBallast 3.1 PB-01465

System Manual

English
PureBallast: Ballast Water Table of Contents
Treatment System
Safety 1

System Description 2

Operating Instructions and


Control System 3
Description
Parameters 4

Alarms and Faultfinding 5

Installation and Drawings 6


Only foreseeable conditions have been taken into
consideration. No warnings are given for Service Manual 7
situations arising from unintended usage of the
system components and tools.

Spare Parts Catalogue 8

Marine & Diesel Equipment

Printed 2017
Alfa Laval reserves the right to make changes at any time without prior notice.
Any comments regarding possible errors and omissions or suggestions for improvement of this
publication would be gratefully appreciated.
Copies of this publication can be ordered from your local AlfaLaval company.
Published by: : Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden
Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00
Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40

© Alfa Laval Tumba AB


1 PureBallast 3.1 System
manual

The PureBallast 3.1 is available in several sizes, defined by the system’s max treatment rated
capacity (TRC). The TRC is included in the system name and the title of each system manual.

The basic document describing the system is the connection list, and the therein stated flow chart.
Those documents are included in the system manual, chapter 6, Installation description and
drawings.

The tables in this document lists the PureBallast systems with reference to the system manual
describing them and the connection list and flow chart defining them.

There are two versions of PureBallast. The USCG version use flow control to be compliant with
USCG legislation. The USCG HP (high performance) have double reactor capacity which allows
treatment at full capacity at all time.

1.1 Manual compilation


PureBallst system Manual no. Connection list Flowchart
PureBallast 3.1 250 USCG 9028181 02 9025976 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 300 USCG 9028183 02 9025978 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 500 USCG 9027431 02 9025980 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 600 USCG 9028186 02 9025982 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 750 USCG 9028188 02 9025984 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 1000 USCG 9028195 02 9025986 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 1200 USCG 9028197 02 9025988 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 1500 USCG 9028218 02 9025989 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 2000 USCG 9028220 02 9025991 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 3000 USCG 9028223 02 9025993 9025600

PureBallst system Manual no. Connection list Flowchart


PureBallast 3.1 250 USCG HP 9028182 02 9025977 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 300 USCG HP 9028184, 02 9025979 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 500 USCG HP 9028185 02 9025981 9025598
PureBallast 3.1 600 USCG HP 9028187 02 9025983 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 750 USCG HP 9028189 02 9025985 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 1000 USCG HP 9028196 02 9025987 9025599
PureBallast 3.1 1500 USCG HP 9028219 02 9025990 9025600
PureBallast 3.1 2000 USCG HP 9028221 02 9025992 9025601
PureBallast 3.1 3000 USCG HP 9028224 02 9025994 9025602

Book No.9028378 02, rev 0 1


1.2 Main component makers 1 PureBallast 3.1 System manual

1.2 Main component makers


Reference is made to flow chart 9025598, 9025599, 9025600, 9025601 and 9025602.

Flowchart
Component Manufacturer Model (Size according to connection list)
legend
Filter:
Automatic ACB-xx-yy, 20 µm mesh (xx=935 – 9200, yy=
self-cleaning Filtrex DN200 - DN600)
filter
PT201-71
Pressure sensor Jumo MIDAS S07
& -72
UV reactor
UV reactor, 300 or,
UV reactor Wallenius Water UV reactor, 600 or,
UV reactor, 1000
Medium pressure UV lamp, 3 kW for UV reactor
UV lamp 170, 300 and 600
Wallenius Water
Medium pressure UV lamp, 6 kW for UV reactor
1000
Lamp sleeve Wallenius Water Synthetic Quartz 9000738 02
UV-TECHNIK, SUV 20.2 Y2 C 40° 1000 W/m² or,
QT201-50 UV sensor IL Metronic SUV 20.2 Y2 C 40° 3000 W/m² for UV reactor
Sensortechnik GmbH 1000
Temperature, Bimetal Temp. Switch 60.8301
TS201-60 JUMO
switch
Thermometer, Dtrans Temp. probe 90.2815
TT201-33 JUMO
resistance
Vibration limit
LS201-29 PEPPERL+FUCHS Vibracon LVL-A7
switch
- Ifm IN5225, Inductive pos. sensor
V201-19 & -Air Torque Spa AT range, Actuator
Valve
-20
-ARI Armaturen ARI –GESA, Lugged valve
Valves:
- Siemens SIPART PS2, Positioner
Flow control - Air Torque Spa AT range, Actuator
V201-8
valve
- ARI Armaturen ARI –GESA, Lugged valve
V201-3, Filter inlet, outlet, - Rotech ALB ACR3.., Pos. switch box
-9, -32 & by-pass, & Start - Air Torque Spa AT range, Actuator
V403-35 up cooling valve - ARI Armaturen ARI –GESA, Lugged valve
Filter backflush - Air Torque Spa AT range, Actuator
V309-1
valve - ARI Armaturen ARI –GESA, Lugged valve
- Rotech ALB ACR3.., Pos. switch box
- Air Torque Spa AT range, Actuator
V212-31 By-pass valve
- Rotork ILG-D series, Handwheel
- ARI Armaturen ARI –GESA, Lugged valve
Flow meter:
Endress+Hauser Promag 50W1F,
FIT201-1 Flow transmitter
or Siemens Sitrans F, Magflo MAG 5100W
System pressure Transmitter:

2 Book No.9028378 02, rev 0


1 PureBallast 3.1 System manual 1.2 Main component makers

Flowchart
Component Manufacturer Model (Size according to connection list)
legend
Flowchart
Component Manufacturer Model
legend
Pressure
PT201-16 JUMO MIDAS S07
transmitter
Cleaning in Place (CIP) unit:
CIP cleaning
Alfa Laval 595087
module
CIP cleaning
Alfa Laval Alpacon Descalant Offshore
liquid
Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC):
Lamp Drive
Alfa Laval LDC 3.1
Cabinet
Control Cabinet:
Control Cabinet Alfa Laval CC 3.1

Book No.9028378 02, rev 0 3


Chapter: 1. Safety
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00

Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40


This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 5

2 Safety information 7
2.1 General safety information 7
2.2 Specif c safety information 7
2.3 Personnel requirements 9
2.4 Warning signs used in the manual 9

3 Environmental issues 11
3.1 Unpacking 11
3.2 Other materials 11

3
1 Introduction

This chapter contains general safety and environmental information, personnel requirements and
explanations of symbols used for the PureBallast system.

Book No.9028188 02 5
1 Introduction
2 Safety information

This section contains safety information. This information must be read and understood before the
system is installed, operated and maintained.

2.1 General safety information


The following general safety information apply:

• The PureBallast system is not Ex proofed and must not be installed in areas where an explosive
atmosphere may occur.
• Use the equipment only for the purpose and parameter range specified by Alfa Laval.
• Use only Alfa Laval genuine spare parts.
• Always read and follow the documentation that is included in shipment of components and
spare parts regarding handling, safety and disposal.
• Mobile cell phones must not be switched on within an area of 1 meter from an open cabinet door.
• Before installation, read applicable sections in chapter 6. Installation instruction and drawings.
• Before operation, read the Preparations and conditions section for applicable instructions in
chapter 3. Operating instructions and control system description.
2.2 Specif c safety information
The following safety information apply for the areas and components below. This information is also
stated in the Preparations and conditions section for applicable instructions.

Maintenance safety items

• Before maintenance, read the Preparations and conditions section for applicable instructions in
chapter 7. Service manual. Essential safety information is stated before instruction to routines
that might involve any danger.
• Before maintaining the PureBallast system, the following valves must be locked in closed
position: V201-3, V201-9, and V201-8.
• Components must be lifted using correct lifting tools (such as a fork-lift truck, a crane) and tackle
with a load capacity greater than the weight of the component. See the Technical data section
on page for information about weight. Any complementary lifting instructions must be followed.
• Always disconnect the PureBallast system from the power supply before disassembling, and
secure it from being switched on.
UV reactor safety items

Book No.9028188 02 7
2.2 Specific safety information 2 Safety information

• UV lamps and quartz sleeves are fragile and can easily become damaged. Exercise great
care when handling them. Do not apply vibrations or shock to the UV lamp. This can cause
breakage and shorten lamp life. Broken glass/quartz can also cause severe cuts. Always use
protective eye glasses and clean cotton gloves when handling UV lamps and quartz glass
sleeves. See Material data sheet / UV lamp in chapter 6.
• UV lamps are stored according to local regulations and information in chapter 6, section Storage
and long term decommissioning.
• Before installation, check that the UV lamps and quartz sleeves are not broken.
• Depressurize reactors and allow equipment to cool down completely before disassembling. Hot
water may escape from the reactor when removing the drain plug.
• Never handle UV lamps before they are completely cooled down. A hot UV lamp is under
high internal pressure, and the risk of bursting exists. A hot lamp could also cause a burn
if it is touched.
• The reactor must not be under pressure when dismounting the UV lamps.
• UV lamps radiate ultraviolet radiation when lit. Only operate the UV lamp when correctly
installed inside the reactor with end caps properly closed.
• UV lamps contain a small amount of mercury (less than 0.2 grams per lamp) and must be
handled and disposed of with care. Used lamps UV can be handled and disposed of in the same
way as fluorescent lamps. Please refer to national regulations. If a UV lamp has accidentally
been broken, mercury could be spilt. Remove mercury with a special tool such as a syringe
(or use pure sulphure to bind the mercury for easy collection).

• Do not allow mercury to come in contact with your eyes or skin. Do not inhale mercury fumes.
• Free mercury must be kept in an airtight bottle, and must be disposed of according to
national regulations.
• In case of having inhaled mercury fumes, consult a doctor and follow medical instructions.
• Operation and/or manual start of the UV lamps is only allowed when there is water in the reactor
(indicated by level switch LS201-29), and the water temperature is below 60 °C. Improper
operation could seriously damage the equipment and injure personnel.
• Manual operation of LPS, may only be performed after cable connection. If not hazardous
situation may arise which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
• Before maintenance of the LDC: Switch off the PureBallast system and disconnect it from the
power supply. The LDC contains a fan, which can cause injury if in operation.
Flow meter safety items

• Potential hazards / Grounding: The flow meter shall be grounded.


Valve safety items

• Actuators must not be pressurized at any time during installation as it may result in injury.
• Lock valve in closed position before maintenance.
CIP safety items

• CIP liquid: Risk for eye and skin irritation. Avoid contact with eyes and wear protective
gloves. Follow general rules when handling of cleaning agents regarding ventilation, personal
protection etc.
• Before disassembling the pump, the pneumatic hoses must be disconnected, and the extension
pipe must be removed and blocked.
• Always wear protective eye glasses and gloves while working on the pump.

8 Book No.9028188 02
2 Safety information 2.4 Warning signs used in the manual

• See Safety data sheet / CIP liquid in chapter 6.


Ancillary component safety items

• Control panels may only be cleaned when set in wipe mode. This is to prevent unintended
functions from being triggered by buttons pressed during cleaning.
• Temperature switch, temperature transmitter and level switch. The external surface may be hot.
Care must be taken to avoid possible burns.
2.3 Personnel requirements
The PureBallast system must be operated, installed, maintained and repaired by persons trained for
respective type of work. All persons using and working with the system must know the emergency
stopping procedures.

Personnel installing, maintaining or repairing components must be of one of the following categories:

• Skilled person: A person with technical knowledge or sufficient experience to perform


the tasks at hand and to enable him or her to perceive risks and to avoid hazards which
electricity/mechanics can create.
• Instructed person: A person adequately advised or supervised by a skilled person to enable
him or her to perceive risks and to avoid hazards which electricity/mechanics can create.
• Alfa Laval service engineer: A person with knowledge about the PureBallast system. Alfa
Laval service engineer can set parameters and repair intrinsically safe apparatuses.
In some cases special skilled personnel may need to be hired, like electricians and others. In some
of these cases the personnel has to be certified according to local regulations with experience of
similar types of work.

2.4 Warning signs used in the manual

NGE R
! DA
DANGER indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

NG
WARNI
!
WARNING indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

ON
CAUTI
!
CAUTION indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate injury.

Book No.9028188 02 9
2.4 Warning signs used in the manual 2 Safety information

NOTE

NOTE indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in property damage.

10 Book No.9028188 02
3 Environmental issues

This section contains general rules regarding environmental issues. However, local rules and
regulations should be consulted for detailed handling of each material.

3.1 Unpacking
• Packing material consists of wood, plastics, cardboard boxes and in some cases metal straps.
• Wood and cardboard boxes can be reused, recycled or used for energy recovery.
• Plastics should be recycled or burnt at a licensed waste incineration plant.
• Metal straps should be sent for material recycling.
3.2 Other materials
• Rubber and plastics should be burnt at a licensed waste incineration plant. If not available they
should be disposed to a suitable licensed land fill site.
• Metal parts should be sent to a licensed handler for material recycling.
• Seal rings should be disposed of in a licensed land fill site. Check the local regulations.
• Worn out or defected electronic components should be sent to a licensed handler for material
recycling.
• The operator panel contain the following components with substances that might be hazardous
to health and the environment: lithium battery, electrolytic capacitor and display. They shall
be recycled according to local regulations.
• Used lithium batteries from the control unit are considered hazardous waste and should be
disposed of accordingly.
• Used UV lamps can be handled and disposed of in the same way as fluorescent lamps. Please
refer to national regulations.
• Used quarts sleeves should be disposed of as ordinary glass.

Book No.9028188 02 11
Chapter: 2. System description
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40

This publication or any part there of may not be


reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 5
1.1 Components overview 6
1.1.1 Item numbers 7

1.2 System overview 7


1.3 Abbreviations 7

2 Process overview 9
2.1 IMO and USCG mode 9
2.1.1 When to use the different modes 9
2.1.2 Flow control and power optimization 9

2.2 Start-up 12
2.3 Ballasting 13
2.3.1 Backflush 14
2.3.2 Ballast after-treatment (CIP) 15

2.4 Deballasting 16
2.4.1 Deballast after-treatment (CIP) 16

2.5 Tank stripping 17


2.5.1 Stripping after-treatment (CIP) 17

2.6 Ballast water handling in the event of


malfunction 18

3 System components description 19


3.1 UV reactor 19
3.1.1 UV reactor working principle 19
3.1.2 UV reactor description 20

3.2 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC) 21


3.2.1 LDC working principle 22
3.2.2 LDC description 22

3.3 Filter 24
3.3.1 Filter working principle 24
3.3.2 Filter description 24
3.3.3 Backflushing for different dirt loads 27

3.4 CIP (cleaning-in-place) module 29


3.4.1 CIP working principle 29
3.4.2 CIP module description 29

3
3.5 Control cabinet and control system 30
3.5.1 Control system 31
3.5.2 Main control panel 31
3.5.3 Remote control panel (optional) 32
3.5.4 Remote interface (optional) 33

3.6 Main valves 33


3.7 Flow meter 34
3.8 Pressure monitoring device 34
3.9 Sampling devices 34

4
1 Introduction

This contains general information about the PureBallast system and its components.

Book No.9028188 02 5
1.1 Components overview 1 Introduction

1.1 Components overview


The key components in PureBallast are shown below.

2 System overview Filtrex

Example of layout with 1 UV reactor.

1. Control cabinet
2. Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)
3. CIP (cleaning-in-place) module
4. UV reactor
5. Ballast water outlet
6. Control valve
7. Flow meter
8. Sampling point
9. Filter
10. Ballast water inlet

Not in illustration:

• System bypass valve


• Pressure monitoring device

6 Book No.9028188 02
1 Introduction 1.3 Abbreviations

1.1.1 Item numbers


System components are identified by unique item numbers, for example “FIT201-1” for the flow
transmitter installed before the UV reactor.

1.2 System overview


The PureBallast system is an integral part of the vessel’s ballast water system, on the discharge
side of the vessel’s ballast water pumps. During ballast operation, the water is led through the filter,
which removes larger particles and organisms, and then to the UV reactor, where the water is
treated with UV light. During deballast, the water is led the same way, but the filter is bypassed.

The UV lamps are powered by the LDC (via LPSs, lamp power supplies). The UV reactor has
one dedicated LDC.

Flow is monitored by the flow meter and regulated by the control valve. The control valve also
regulates pressure during backflushing of the filter.

The UV reactors are cleaned using the CIP (cleaning-in-place) module, which first rinse the UV
reactor with fresh water, and then circulates CIP liquid through the UV reactor. At the end of the
process the UV reactor and thefilter (filter preservation) is filled with fresh water from the CIP.

The complete system and ongoing processes is controlled and monitored from the control cabinet.
Control can also be performed from remote control panels and the ship’s ISCS, via the remote
interface.

The bypass valve makes it possible to bypass the entire system, for example to secure ballast
operation if the system is not functioning. The valve is controlled from the ISCS (integrated ship
control system).

1.3 Abbreviations
The table below is a list of abbreviations used in this manual.

Abbreviation Explanation

AOT reactor Previous name for UV reactor. AOT stands for Advanced oxidation
technology.

Atex EU directive “Appareils destinés à être utilisés en ATmosphères


EXplosivles”

CIP Cleaning in place

CIP module Cleaning in place module. Performs the CIP process.

DIN Deutche Institut für Normung

EN Standard according to CEN (European Committee for


Standardization).

Book No.9028188 02 7
1.3 Abbreviations 1 Introduction

Abbreviation Explanation

Ex Explosion-proof

I/O Input/output (Describes a program or device handling data)

IACS International Association of Classification Societies

IECEx International Electrotechnical Commission Explosive

ISCS Integrated ship control system

IMO International Maritime Organization

JIS Japanese Industrial Standard

LED Light emitting diode

LDC Lamp drive cabinet.

LPS Lamp power supply

MCB Motor circuit breaker

PLC Programmable logical controller (PureBallast control system)

USCG United states coast guard

UV Ultra violet

UV reactor The main component, where the water is treated using UV light.

UVR UV reactor

8 Book No.9028188 02
2 Process overview

This section gives an overview of the main processes performed by PureBallast. In the flow chart
illustrations, involved pipes are marked in bold.

2.1 IMO and USCG mode


The PureBallast have two process modes: IMO mode and USCG mode.

These different modes set the system to run to be compliant with the authorities in USA (USCG
mode) and the ones who have ratified the IMO convention (IMO mode). In USCG mode, the
water is treated with a higher UV dose, to make the treatment compliant with the testing method,
today, required by the laws in USA.

2.1.1 When to use the different modes


USCG mode

When trading to ports in US waters, all water in tanks intended to be discharged in US water, shold
be treated in USCG mode.

USCG mode should, as minimum, be used:

• Before entering US waters: Treatment of all ballast water in the tanks during ballasting.
• Within US water: Treatment of the ballast water during deballasting.
IMO mode

IMO mode is used when trading to ports in the rest of the world.

2.1.2 Flow control and power optimization


To ensure full treatment of the water, allowed flow and power to the lamps are controlled depending
on how clean the water is. Clean water (high UV intensity) allows high flow and low lamp power, and
dirty water requires lower flow and higher lamp power to treat the water according to requirements.

The illustration below show flow control and power optimization depending on the UV intensity,
together with the compliant limit.

Book No.9028188 02 9
2.1 IMO and USCG mode 2 Process overview

IMO mode

UVI_IMO1000

USCG mode

UVI_USCG1000

Compliant limit: When UVI falls below compliant limit, the operation continues but does not fulfill
the type approval certificate. A warning and a common alarm is issued and a log is written to the
event log. The operator must take action according to the ballast water plan to stop the operation or
to continue operation and not comply with type approval certificate.

2.1.2.1 Flow control

In USCG mode, the flow is regulated to be as high as possible to fully treat the water. Between UVI
value a and b, the flow is regulated be between 50 % and 100 % of full flow capacity. The higher
UVI value (cleaner water) the the higher flow.

10 Book No.9028188 02
2 Process overview 2.1 IMO and USCG mode

In IMO mode, the flow is always 100 % above compliant limit. But when UVI falls below the
compliant limit, the flow is decreased so that the treatment shall correspond to the type approval
requirements. Maximum reduction is 50 %.

2.1.2.2 Power optimization

The purpose is to save power by dimming the lamps to minimum power required to fully treat the
water. Power is regulated when the UVI in the water is between c and d (see graph above). The
power output is regulated between 50 % and 100 % of full power.

2.1.2.3 Power optimization during special


conditions

• Start-up and the first two minutes of ballast/deballast: The UV lamps are lit to 100 % to ensure
treatment before values from the UV sensor are stable.
• Pause: UV lamps are dimmed to 50 % during pause and lit to 100 % for two minutes when
process is resumed.
• Stop: UV lamps are lit to 100 % for 10 seconds before they are stopped. This will prolong
the life of the lamps.
• Stripping: The lamps are lit to 100 % during the complete stripping process. This to have an
efficient treatment of the deballast water when it is mixed with the driving water, which has
not been treated at ballast.
• Low UV intensity: See Flow control above.
• Broken UV lamp: See Operation with broken UV lamp below.

2.1.2.4 Operation with broken UV lamp

If a UV lamp breaks, the ongoing process continues but does not fulfill the type approval certificate.
The flow is decreased to 80 % in IMO mode or 50 % in USCG mode of max flow and the UV
lamps are lit to 100 %. This is done so that the treatment shall correspond to the type approval
requirements. A warning and an additional common alarm is issued and a log is written to the
event log.

If a lamp breaks during operation, the operator will have to decide to stop the operation or to
continue operation and not comply with type approval certificate. After process is finished, it will not
be allowed to start a new process untill the broken lamp has been changed.

Book No.9028188 02 11
2.2 Start-up 2 Process overview

2.2 Start-up
Ballasting and deballasting begins with a start-up phase. There must be available power for
the system. If power management is integrated, this will be confirmed automatically. If power
management is not integrated, this is confirmed manually.

During start-up, the UV lamps are warmed up for 90 seconds. Cooling water is pumped through the
UV reactor to secure that the UV lamps are not overheated. The temperature transmitter and level
switch secure that there is water in the UV reactor and that the UV lamps are sufficiently cooled. If
not, an alarm is issued and the system is shut down.

2 Startup Filtrex

Ballast and deballast start-up

12 Book No.9028188 02
2 Process overview 2.3 Ballasting

2.3 Ballasting
After the start-up, when the lamps are ready, the operator is requested to start the ballast pump.
The ballast water is pumped from the sea chest to the filter, that removes larger particles and
organisms. This also reduces the amount of sediment build-up in the ballast water tanks. The
organisms and sediments caught in the filter is flushed overboard via regular filter backflush
operations. The water is finally led to the UV reactor, which produces radicals and UV light that
breaks down and neutralize the organisms.

2 BallastFiltrex

Ballasting

Book No.9028188 02 13
2.3 Ballasting 2 Process overview

2.3.1 Backf ush


To keep the filter clean, it is automatically backflushed. The backflush is performed during ongoing
process without interrupting the ballasting process. When a ballast operation is stopped, a
backflush is performed before the system comes to a full stop. The water used for backflushing is
returned to the sea directly at the ballasting site.

2 BackflushFiltrex

Filter backflush

14 Book No.9028188 02
2 Process overview 2.3 Ballasting

2.3.2 Ballast after-treatment (CIP)


After a ballast operation, a cleaning-in-place (CIP) process should be performed to clean the UV
reactor. This process can either be performed immediately after a ballast operation or within 30
hours after. Note, that it is possible to perform new processes during these 30 hours. A CIP
process takes about 25 minutes , if default parameters are used.

We recommend that a CIP process is performed within the same ecological zone or in international
waters (200 nautical miles from the base line). This will avoid untreated water from the UV reactor
and the filter to enter a different ecological zone.

First, the UV reactor is rinsed with fresh water. Then the cleaning-in-place (CIP) module circulates
a biodegradable solution through the UV reactor to remove seawater scaling. After the cleaning is
finished, the UV reactor is filled with fresh water to preserve the UV reactor and prevent scaling,
algae growth etc. Finally, the filter filled with fresh water to prevent scaling and algea growth. The
cleaning liquid is reused between the cleaning operations.

2 CIP Filtrex

CIP circulation during CIP process

Book No.9028188 02 15
2.4 Deballasting 2 Process overview

2.4 Deballasting
After the start-up, when the lamps are ready, the operator is requested to start the ballast pump.
The water passes through the UV reactor, but the filter is bypassed since the water has already
been filtered during ballasting. The reason for treating the water a second time during deballasting
is to secure that the treatment is fully effective. The minor part of the organisms, which were only
injured during ballast, will be rendered totally harmless during the deballast.

The process flow and power optimization are controlled in the same way as during ballasting.

2 DeballastFiltrex

Deballasting

2.4.1 Deballast after-treatment (CIP)


After deballast operation, a cleaning cycle is performed to clean the UV reactor. It is performed
in the same way as described for the ballasting process. If only deballast operations has been
performed since the last CIP process, the filter does not need to be filled with fresh water at the end
of the cycle, since the filter has not been used.

16 Book No.9028188 02
2 Process overview 2.5 Tank stripping

2.5 Tank stripping


Stripping can be performed to empty the ballast tanks.

After the start-up, when the lamps are ready, the operator is requested to start a stripping pump.
Pump used can either be a dedicated stripping pump or a ballast water pump. The flow controll is
controlled to be 1/3 of certified flow but power optimization is not active. Number of UV reactors
used during stripping is set in a parameter, to adapt to lower flow during stripping.

If a stripping eductor (not part of Alfa Laval’s scope of supply) is used it must be installed before the
PureBallast system. Minium flow for deballast water includes the driving water.

Also, the water used in the stripping process, must be filtered from particles larger than
approximately 5 mm. The sieve is not part of Alfa Laval’s scope of supply. Procedures to dispose
of sediments from the sieve must be included in the vessel’s ballast water management plan. See
also chapter 3. Operating instructions and control system description, section Stripping.

2 StrippingFiltrex

Stripping

2.5.1 Stripping after-treatment (CIP)


After stripping operation, a cleaning cycle is performed to clean the UV reactor. It is performed
in the same way as described for the ballasting process. If only stripping operations has been
performed since the last CIP process, the filter does not need to be filled with fresh water at the end
of the cycle, since the filter has not been used.

Book No.9028188 02 17
2.6 Ballast water handling in the event of 2 Process overview
malfunction

2.6 Ballast water handling in the event of malfunction


PureBallast is equipped with a bypass valve. The valve can be used in case of emergency to
secure the ship, by allowing ballast water operations (ballast, deballast and internal transfers)
without involving the ballast water treatment system. The valve is controlled by the ISCS, not
PureBallast’s control system, but all bypass valve activities are logged in the event log. Such valve
is required by the International Convention for the Control and Management of Ship’s Ballast
Water and Sediments 2004.

If the system malfunction in connection with general cargo operation, ballast and deballast
operations should be avoided.

The procedures concerning emergency and malfunction of the ballast water treatment system
should be implemented in the ships Ballast water management plan.

18 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components
description

This section gives an introduction to the most important PureBallast system components and
their functions in the system.

3.1 UV reactor
The main part of PureBallast is the UV reactor in combination with a lamp drive cabinet (LDC)
giving power to the UV lamps in the UV reactor. The LDC does not need to be placed in close
relation to the UV reactor.

3.1.1 UV reactor working principle


The main treatment process take place inside the UV reactor, where the UV light inactivates the cell
DNA to prevent regrowth of organisms. The UV light also generates radicals. The radicals are
extremely reactive and react instantaneously with micro organisms and other organic contaminants
destructing their membranes. The radicals are extremely short-lived and exist only for some
milliseconds. This means that they will only exist inside the UV reactor. The quantity of radicals
produced in the reactor is sufficient to treat the water as it passes through the reactor.

2 10_2_1_1 Cell

Destruction of cell membranes

1. Radical
2. Cell membrane

Book No.9028188 02 19
3.1 UV reactor 3 System components description

There are no chemical substances added to the process, and there are no toxic residuals created.
Since the water is not affected chemically there are no environmental impact, and the process does
not influence corrosion in any way.

3.1.2 UV reactor description


The UV reactor consist of the reactor, sensors and valves for ballast water, fresh water and CIP
liquid, as shown in the illustration below. The UV reactor accommodates 16 medium-pressure
UV lamps (6 kW each) powered from the lamp drive cabinet (LDC). The UV lamps are enclosed
in individual quartz-glass sleeves.

The UV lamps get very warm, so they must be cooled whenever they are lit. To secure that there is
water in the reactor when the lamps are lit, each reactor is equipped with a level switch. The level
switch also secures that enough CIP liquid is pumped into the reactor during the CIP process. To
secure that the lamps are adequately cooled by the ballast water, each UV reactor has a threefold
heat protection:

• The temperature transmitter sends information to the control system. The UV reactor is shut
down at 60 °C.
• The temperature transmitter sends information to a safety relay in the LDC. The UV reactor is
shut down at 62.5 °C.
• The temperature switch automatically shuts down the UV reactor at 65 °C.
A UV sensor monitors the UV lamp efficiency in relation to the water transmittance inside the UV
reactor. Based on this input, the power to the UV lamps are regulated between 50 and 100 % of full
capacity. The UV lamps will be dimmed to lowest possible level, where they are still effective.

Note, that the lamps are always lit with full effect during start-up and the first two minutes of full
ballast to secure full efficiency independent of transmittance. The lamps are also turned up to full
effect for 10 seconds before stop and normal shut down. This method will prolong the UV lamp life
time.

The illustration below show the main components for the UV reactor.

20 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.2 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

2 reactor module Obe

UV reactor

1. Ballast water outlet valve


2. CIP liquid outlet valve (actuator indicated)
3. Level switch
4. Junction box
5. UV lamp cap (UV lamp and quartz sleeve inside)
6. Access hatch
7. CIP liquid / fresh water inlet valve and reactor
drain valve (actuator indicated)
8. Ballast water inlet valve (actuator indicated)
9. UV sensor
10. Junction box
11. Cooling water outlet valve
12. Ballast water outlet valve actuator (actuator
indicated)

3.2 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)


The lamp drive cabinet gives power to the UV reactor.

Book No.9028188 02 21
3.2 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC) 3 System components description

3.2.1 LDC working principle


UV reactor is connected to a lamp drive cabinet (LDC) containing lamp power supplies (LPS), each
feeding with power. The LPS also monitors the function of each UV lamp and takes action if
a fault occurs. Lamps on the cabinet indicates if power is on, UV lamps are lit and if the cabinet
needs to be reset after a shutdown or power off.

3.2.2 LDC description


The LDC is equipped with a cooling system to maintain correct operating temperature in the LDC,
using low-temperature cooling water. The cooling water flow is constant, but the fan is regulated
based on heat inside the cabinet. When lamps are lit, the fan starts at 30 % of full effect. When
the temperature reaches 40°, the fan starts to regulated between 30 % and 100 %, according to
parameter settings based on input from the temperature transmitter in the LDC.

The humidity in the cabinet is monitored by a liquid sensor. If a leakage from the heat exchanger
is detected, a warning is issued, the reactor is shut down and the cooling water inlet valve to
the LDC is shut.

The LDC can be placed up to 150 meters (cable length) from the UV reactor. The main breaker
cut the power to the LDC and the UV reactor.

22 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.2 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

2 LDC

LDC with one door removed.

1. Fan
2. Heat exchanger
3. Lamp power supplies (LPS)
4. Fuses
5. Cooling water inlet and outlet
6. Main breaker
7. Status lights and reset button

Book No.9028188 02 23
3.3 Filter 3 System components description

3.3 Filter

3.3.1 Filter working principle


The filter fully automatic self-rinsing component, equipped with a filter element to remove particles
and organisms from the ballast water flow. The ballast water is lead through the filter, and filtered
particles are trapped in the filter. The filter is entirely controlled from the PureBallast control system.

3.3.2 Filter description

2 FilterFiltrex

1. Geared motor
2. Relief valve
3. Backlflush outlet
4. Backflush pump
5. Drain plug
6. Ballast water inlet
7. Adaptor plate to change flange standard and/or
diameter (in some systems)
8. Junction box (Not included in the skid version
of PureBallast)
9. Ballast water outlet

24 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.3 Filter

To secure efficient filtration, the filter performs a self-rinsing backflush operation at time set intervals
or when triggered by indication of dirt in the filter. Pressure drop over the filter is monitored by
pressure transmitters on the filter inlet and outlet. Dirt is detected by an increased differential
pressure drop caused by particles in the filter. When the differential pressure reaches a parameter
set value, an automatic backflush operation starts.

The backflushing does not interrupt the filtration process, since only a part of the filter element area
is cleaned. The areas that are not cleaned at a specific time continues the filtration of the ballast
water. It is also possible to start backflush manually from the control system.

Book No.9028188 02 25
3.3 Filter 3 System components description

Step 1: Filtration
The water enters from the inlet flange (A) and flows through a
pre-filter and then through the filter element (1) from the inside to
the outside. The filtered dirt is trapped on the inside of the filter
element. The filtered water passes the chamber (D) and out from
the filter through the outlet flange (B) and is lead to the UV reactor.

During filtration, the filter operates as a static filter, there are no


moving parts and the motor (2) is not running and the nozzle (3) is
standing still.

A. Inlet
B. Outlet
D. Chamber
1. filter element
2. Motor
3. Nozzle (standing still during filtration)

2 FilterFiltrationFtrx

Step 2: Backf ush

At backflush, the motor (2) starts to drives the nozzle (3). At the
same time, the backflush valve (6) opens.

The nozzle rotates inside the filter element. The dirt on the inside
of the filter element (1) is cleaned by a high-efficacy backflush flow
in front of the nozzle. The backflush flow uses filtered water from
the chamber (D) to clean the filter from the outside to the inside.
The water, together with the dirt, is lead via the nozzle through the
duct (5) and out via the backflush valve (6).

All areas of the filter element that is not in front of the nozzle are
filtering the water as in step 1: The water flows from the inlet (A)
through the filter element and out through the outlet (B).

When the backflush is done (after approxemately 20 seconds), the


motor stops and the backflush valve is closed. The filter then goes
back filtration with full flow to the ballast tank (no flow used for
backflushing.

If a new backflush is triggered within 2 minutes (parameter p302),


the filter will perform a continuous backflush for 20 minutes
(parameter p303).

A. Inlet 2 FilterBackflushFtrx

B. Outlet
D. Chamber
1. filter element
2. Motor
3. Nozzle seen from the side (rotating during backflush)

26 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.3 Filter

6. Backflush valve

3.3.3 Backf ushing for different dirt loads


Below, the filter pressure drop over time (pfilter) is illustrated for different dirt load situations in the
filter. Different dirtload depends on the water condition, which means that “normal” condition
regarding filter backflush depends on the water conditions.

3.3.3.1 Low dirt load

In water with low dirt load, the backflush cycle is started by the time trigger (default: every 30
minutes). As long as the pressure is below the differential pressure trigger (0.50 bar), there is no
need for the pressure triggered backflush. See examples below.

6 Dirtload1 Filtrex

6 Dirtload2 Filtrex

3.3.3.2 Medium dirt load

In more dirty waters the backflush cycle will be triggered when pfilter reaches 0.5 bar, which indicates
dirt in the filter.

After each backflush, the backflush timer is reset. The filter will be backflushed again after 30
minutes or when ∆pfilterreaches 0.5 bar, whichever comes first.

In the example below, three backflushes are triggered due to high differential pressure over the filter.
After that, there is not so much dirt build up, so the next backflush is performed after 30 minutes.

Book No.9028188 02 27
3.3 Filter 3 System components description

6 Dirtload3 Filtrex

3.3.3.3 Heavy dirt load

In conditions with heavy dirt load, the system can perform continuous backflushes to keep the filter
clean. If the filter preforms one backflush, and the differential pressure trigger a new backflush
within a parameter set time, the filter will perform continuous backflushes for a parameter set time
to clean the filter thoroughly. After the continuous backflush time, a check is made to make sure
that the differential pressure is below 80 % of the backflush trigger pressure. If not, the backflush
continues until this is true.

Also, the 0.5 limit might be exceeded. In this case the self rinsing cycle will run continuously
until the problem is solved and the pressure has returned below 0.5 bar. It is OK that the flow
momentarily fluctuates in an irregular curve, but it is important that the curve stabilizes.

In the example below, a series of backflushes are performed (approx. every 4 minute). After that
the pressure rises above 0.5 where the filter is backflushed constantly. After that, the normal
control is resumed, where thefilter backflush is triggered by pressure (2 times) or by time (last
backflush in the example).

6 Dirtload4 Filtrex

3.3.3.4 Long term dirt build-up

Over time, the filter element will undergo a long term build-up of particles that are not removed
by backflushing. One effect of this is that “normal” pressure will increase over time. Therefore,
the maintenance schedule state that the filter element shall be inspected and manually cleaned
once a year.

The extent of the long term dirt build-up is dependent on the water conditions. In the great majority
of cases this will not cause any problems – cleaning once a year is enough. But in exceptional
cases (vessels trading very muddy waters) it might be necessary to clean the filter element more

28 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.4 CIP (cleaning-in-place) module

often. If the pressure triggered backflushing is performed with short intervals, we suggest that the
filter element is manually cleaned more often than once year.

3.4 CIP (cleaning-in-place) module

3.4.1 CIP working principle


To ensure full performance in PureBallast, an automatic cleaning cycle is performed after ballast
and deballast operation. The purpose is to keep the quartz sleeves covering the UV lamps and the
UV sensor clean, to maximize the effect of the UV lamps, and thereby treatment efficiency.

During a cleaning cycle, the CIP module rinse the reactor with fresh water and circulates a CIP
liquid through the UV reactor. The low-pH CIP liquid removes scaling, calcium chlorides, metal ion
build-up and chemical fouling on the lamps’ quartz glass sleeves. After finished cycle, the liquid
is returned to the CIP module tank; the CIP liquid is reusable for a great number of cycles. The
sequence is finalized by filling the UV reactor with fresh water. A backflow preventer secures
that no CIP liquid is mixed with the fresh water.

3.4.2 CIP module description


The CIP module consists of a tank where the CIP liquid is stored between usage. The pumps and
valves integrated in the CIP module are controlled by the valve block.

To secure that there is enough CIP liquid for the process, the level switch in the reactor indicates
when it is filled with CIP liquid. To prevent intrusion of water in the fresh water system, a backflow
preventer is used in the CIP module.

The CIP module is equipped with two membrane pumps:

• Pump P320-1 circulates the CIP liquid in the UV reactor and fills it with fresh water.
• Pump P321-5 drains water (sea and fresh water) overboard from the reactor, via the drain line.

Book No.9028188 02 29
3.5 Control cabinet and control system 3 System components description

2 CIP module

CIP module

1. Deaeration valve
2. Valve block
3. Regulator
4. Pump (CIP liquid)
5. Backflow preventer
6. Pump (reactor drain)
7. Tank for CIP liquid

3.5 Control cabinet and control system


The control cabinet is used to control and monitor the entire system, via the built in main control
panel. It is also used to communicate with the the vessel’s systems and components, if integrated.
The cabinet is equipped with an emergency stop button, an audible and visible alarm indication and
USB ports for software upload and log file export.

The control cabinet functions as a single point of contact for signal cables to and from the vessel.
Examples of integration: Remote interface integration and power management system (PMS).
Remote interface will allow control of PureBallast from the vessel’s ISCS and PMS integration will
allow automatic verification that there is enough power to run an operation. If not integrated, the
operator must verify this manually. Also integration with other external components (not part of Alfa
Laval’s scope of supply), such as GPS or booster pumps, are done to the control cabinet.

30 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.5 Control cabinet and control system

2 CC

Control cabinetpanel.

3.5.1 Control system


The control system is used to set parameters, operate and monitor the PureBallast system. The
control system continuously monitor PureBallast (sensors, communication and PLC status), both
during operation and in standby mode. Any deviation is either communicated to the operator or
handled automatically, based on parameter settings. Safety risks are always handled automatically.

The control system store all alarms and relevant events for at least 24 months. The memory has
a vast safety margin but when it is full, data will be deleted starting with the oldest logs. Logged
information can be exported to a USB memory stick.

There are three alternative ways to monitor and control PureBallast: Main panel, remote control
panel (optional) and remote interface (optional).

If two PureBallast systems are installed on a vessel, two control systems are needed.

3.5.2 Main control panel


The main control panel in mounted in the control cabinet, and it is included in the standard
installation of PureBallast. It is installed in the engine room. The main control panel handles
every aspect of the control system. It allows the operator to monitor the system, to operate it
manually and automatically, and to set parameters. Please note that some of the operations are
password-protected.

Book No.9028188 02 31
3.5 Control cabinet and control system 3 System components description

2 CC

Control cabinet with main control panel

3.5.3 Remote control panel (optional)


As an option, it is possible to install one or two additional panels to be placed in locations from
where ballast operations are performed. The remote control panel functions in the same way as
the main control panel, and it allows same operations. The remote control panel is delivered with
a mounting plate for installations in wall, worktop etc. It can also be ordered wit an IP protective
back cover for installation on a stand or such.

2 RCP

Main control panel with integrated remote control panels.

32 Book No.9028188 02
3 System components description 3.6 Main valves

3.5.4 Remote interface (optional)


As an option, the control system can be integrated with the vessel’s ISCS via modbus. This allows
monitoring and operation of PureBallast from the ISCS’s graphical user interface.

Note that Alfa Laval does not supply the graphical user interface to handle PureBallast in the
ISCS, only the means to enable the integration.

2 RI

PureBallast control system’s main control panel integrated with the ISCS. The interface is only an example.

3.6 Main valves


The main valves in the system are:

• Inlet valves: The inlet valves directs the water flow from the vessel’s ballast water system into
the PureBallast system. Different valves are used during ballast and deballast.

- System and f lter inlet valve (201–3): Inlet valve to PureBallast during ballast. The valve
directs the water flow through the PureBallast filter.
- Filter outlet valve (V201–32): The valve directs the water flow from the filter to the UV
reactor during ballast.
- Inlet valve (201–9): Inlet valve to PureBallast during deballast. The valve directs the water
to PureBallast, but bypass the filter, since the water was filtered during ballasting.
• Control valve (V201–8): The valve have the following functions:

- Automatic regulation to maintain flow during operation so it does not exceed selected
certified maximum flow. Regulation is based on input from the flow meter.
- Automatic regulation to maintain pressure needed to perform backflush of the filter.
Regulation is based on input from the pressure transmitter.
- Outlet valve from the PureBallast system to the vessel’s ballast water system after treatment.

Book No.9028188 02 33
3.9 Sampling devices 3 System components description

• PureBallast bypass valve (V212–31): Makes it possible to completely bypass the PureBallast
system. The valve is solely operated from the ISCS, but the valve positioning is (and must be)
indicated in the PureBallast control system. When PureBallast is bypassed, an event is written
to the event log. The valve is equiped with a handwheel for manual operation. The component
is optional to be included in Alfa Laval’s scope of supply.
• Cooling water inlet valve (V403-35): Supplies cooling water to the reactor to secure cooling of
the lamps and prevent overheating during start-up.
3.7 Flow meter
The flow meter (FIT201–1) monitors the process-flow during operation. It has two main functions:

• It monitor that the flow within the PureBallast system does not exceed its certified flow. If the
certified flow is exceeded a warning is issued.
• Via the flow transmitter, mounted on the flow sensor, it sends valuable data to the PureBallast
control system, where it is displayed. Example of information: Current flow and data about
total amount of treated ballast water.
The flow meter consists of two main parts: A flow sensor, which is a pipe with four electrodes
detecting the flow. On top of the pipe, the flow transmitter housing is mounted. The flow transmitter
monitors the flow and transmits the information to the PureBallast control system.

3.8 Pressure monitoring device


The pressure monitoring device is a manifold that includes the following components to monitor
and handle pressure in the system:

• Pressure transmitter(PT201-16): Send current pressure information to the control system. The
control system use the information to take actions accordingly, for example issue warnings, shut
down the system or adjusting the control valve to obtain optimal pressure during filter backflush.
• Pressure gauge (PI201-18): Analogue displayed of current pressure.
• Needle valve (V201-15): Enables connection of external instruments for calibration.
• Safety valve (RV201): Relief of over pressure.
3.9 Sampling devices
The two sampling devices (Q201.1 and Q201.2) make it possible to take water samples to test the
water. One sampling device is installed before the water is treated and one after the water is
treated. This enables comparative tests of treated and untreated water. The component is optional
to be included in Alfa Laval’s scope of supply.

34 Book No.9028188 02
Chapter: 3. Operating instructions and control system description
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40
This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 7
1.1 Preparations and conditions 7
1.1.1 Stripping 7
1.1.2 Heeling (internal transfer) 8
1.1.3 Ballast water handling in the event of malfunction 8
1.1.4 Contamination avoidance 8
1.1.5 Pipe cleaning using PureBallast 9

2 Introduction to the control system 11


2.1 Login levels 11
2.2 Control of PureBallast 12
2.2.1 Remote control panels (option) 12
2.2.2 Remote interface (option) 12

2.3 Overview of the screen 14

3 Detailed page descriptions 19


3.1 Page 1.1 – Overview 19
3.1.1 Status box 19
3.1.2 Flow chart 21

3.2 Page 1.2 – UVR and f ow selection 23


3.2.1 Flow selection 23
3.2.2 UVR selection 24
3.2.3 Status 24

3.3 Page 1.3 – CIP status 25


3.3.1 CIP status 26
3.3.2 UVR information 26
3.3.3 CIP module information 27

3.4 Page 1.4 – Power request 28


3.4.1 Power management status display 28
3.4.2 Power management simulation and faultfinding 29
3.4.3 Function buttons 30

3.5 Page 2.1 – Alarm list 31


3.5.1 Alarm list 32
3.5.2 Function buttons 32

3.6 Page 2.2 – Alarm history 33


3.7 Page 3.1 – Trend (15 min) 34
3.7.1 Diagram area 35
3.7.2 Component area 35
3.7.3 Function buttons 36

3
3.8 Page 3.2 – Trend (1 h) 37
3.9 Page 3.3 – Trend (1 h) - TT201-33 37
3.10 Page 3.4 – Trend (1 h) - TT401-2 37
3.11 Page 3.5 – Trend (1 h) - Power
optimization 37
3.12 Page 3.7 – Trend (15 min) - External feed
optimization 37
3.13 Page 4.1 – System info 39
3.14 Page 4.2 – PLC controller I/O 42
3.15 Page 4.3 – Operation timers 43
3.16 Page 4.4 Operation timers UVR 45
3.17 Page 4.5 – Remote interface 1 46
3.18 Page 4.6 – Remote interface 2 47
3.19 Page 4.7 – Log box 1 48
3.20 Page 4.9 – LPS overview 49
3.21 Page 5.1–5.7 – Parameter pages 51
3.22 Popup windows 51
3.22.1 UVR popup 51
3.22.2 Filter popup 56

4
4 Operating instructions 59
4.1 Log in 59
4.2 Perform ballast 59
4.3 Perform deballast 61
4.4 Perform tank stripping 62
4.5 Pause ballast / deballast / stripping 64
4.6 Heel (internal transfer) 64
4.7 Backf ush f lter manually 65
4.8 CIP clean UV reactor after ballast /
deballast / stripping 65
4.9 Attend to alarms 66
4.10 Shut down and deactivate system 68
4.11 Reset system after shut down 69
4.12 Operate components manually 70
4.13 Operate UV lamps manually 71
4.14 Set ship specif c component ID 72
4.15 Export control system event log f les 73
4.16 Backup control system settings 75
4.17 Restore control system settings 75
4.18 Set control panel IP address 76
4.19 Set remote control panel
communication 77
4.20 Set remote interface communication 79
4.21 Test remote interface communication 79
4.22 Simulate power request 81
4.23 Set default parameters 82
4.24 Update control system softwares 82
4.25 Calibrate the control panel’s touch
screen sensibility 82
4.26 Fine tune f ow control 83
4.26.1 Calibrate pressure controlled regulation 83
4.26.2 Calibrate external feed control (optional) 85

5
5 List of logged information 87
5.1 Event log 87

6 Detailed process description 93


6.1 Standby mode 93
6.2 Ballast process 94
6.2.1 Ballast start-up 94
6.2.2 Full ballast 95
6.2.3 Filter backflush 95
6.2.4 Pause ballast (Heeling mode) 97
6.2.5 Stop ballast 98

6.3 Deballast process 98


6.3.1 Deballast start-up 99
6.3.2 Full deballast 100
6.3.3 Pause deballast (Heeling) 101
6.3.4 Stop deballast 102

6.4 Stripping process 102


6.4.1 Stripping start-up 103
6.4.2 Full stripping 104
6.4.3 Pause stripping 105
6.4.4 Stop stripping 106

6.5 CIP process 107


6.5.1 Start CIP 107
6.5.2 Drain ballast water 108
6.5.3 Fresh water filling 108
6.5.4 Fresh water draining 108
6.5.5 CIP cleaning 109
6.5.6 CIP draining 109
6.5.7 Fresh water filling 109
6.5.8 Repeat 110
6.5.9 Filter preservation 110

6.6 Manual mode 110

6
1 Introduction

The control system is used to operate and monitor the PureBallast system. It also contains
functions for setting parameters, saving log files etc.

This chapter describes the control system. It includes general description of the control system
pages, step-by-step instructions and a process description with detailed information about the
components (valves, motors, pumps etc) involved in each step of respective process.

The following control system related information is given in other chapters of the manual:

• Parameters are described in chapter 4. Parameters.


• Alarms and warnings including information about faultfinding and how to solve problems is
described in chapter 5. Alarms and faultfinding.
• Information about integrating the control system with the vessel’s ISCS and power management
is described in chapter 6. Installation description and drawings.
1.1 Preparations and conditions
• Make sure all documentation is available, read and understood before start.
• Both ballast and deballast must be run through PureBallast to fully treat the water.
• Make sure that the flow is within defined flow range during operation (m3/h):
Ballast:165 → 750
Deballast: 100 → 1000
Stripping: 100 → 333 .

• During process, the control system requests that vessel valves are opened/closed. The
valves are outside the PureBallast system control. But the control system needs feedback
(opened/closed) during process. Status can either be confirmed manually in a popup or
automatically, if feedback signals are integrated via the remote interface option or via hard wire.
Please note:

- When overboard valves are requested to be opened/closed, this means that all valves
leading the flow from the PureBallast via one of the following pipes must be opened/closed:
201, 309 and 403 and 404. During CIP process, 460.1 must be opened.
• The input flow to the PureBallast system shall be as close as possible to the flow that has been
selected for an operation. This will reduce the stress and wear of the control valve.

1.1.1 Stripping
Stripping can be performed to empty the ballast tanks. The first time a ballast tank is stripped,
PureBallast must be bypassed.

The stripping process is basically the same as a deballast process with the following difference: A
stripping eductor (or a stripping pump) should be used to secure enough flow in the system.

Book No.9028188 02 7
1.1 Preparations and conditions 1 Introduction

We recommend that the driving water alone (without the ballast water flow from the tank) fulfils the
minimum flow requirement for deballast operation. This will minimize the risk of shut down due to
low flow when flow of ballast water is uneven.

1.1.2 Heeling (internal transfer)


Internal transfer of ballast water between tanks, for example during heeling procedures, does not
require the use of the PureBallast system. It is possible to perform heeling during standby ballast
or deballasting.

If external component signal for heeling mode is integrated between PureBallast and the vessel’s
ISCS, ongoing process will be paused and resumed automatically. The user is notified of started
and stopped heeling via warnings, and the event is logged.

If no external signal is integrated, the ongoing process must be paused manually. During pause,
cooling water is flushed through the UV reactor to cool the UV lamps. After completed heeling,
the operator must resume the paused process.

1.1.3 Ballast water handling in the event of malfunction


If the ballast water treatment system malfunctions, follow the procedures stated in the ship’s ballast
water management plan. This is valid both if the system malfunctions, for example mechanical
problems, or if full treatment cannot be guaranteed, for example a lamp failure or low UV intensity.
General recommendations are given below.

PureBallast is equipped with a bypass valve. The valve can be used in case of emergency to secure
the ship, by allowing ballast water operations (ballast, deballast and internal transfers) without
involving the ballast water treatment system. The valve is controlled by the ISCS, not PureBallast’s
control system, but all valve activities are logged in the event log. Such valve is required by the
International convention for the control and management of ship’s ballast water and sediments 2004.

If the system malfunction in connection with general cargo operation, ballast and deballast
operations should be avoided. Note that the system requires treatment both during ballast and
deballast.

If untreated water is pumped to a ballast tank, this water shall primarily be discharged to a reception
facility. When this is not possible, other discharge possibilities must be agreed with the port state
responsible for the waters where the ship is sailing and most importantly be agreed with the flag
state administration of the ship; the procedures concerning emergency and malfunction of the
ballast water treatment system should be implemented in the ships Ballast Water Management
Plan which must be approved by the flag state administration.

1.1.4 Contamination avoidance


If PureBallast is installed correctly, maintained and always used for ballast and deballast operations
according to the system manual, the ballast water will be treated according to the requirements of
the ballast water convention.

However, in some cases there is a risk that treated ballast water is contaminated by untreated
water, i.e. there are living organisms in the water. Those risks are described below, together
with suggested measures to solve the problem. Consider to include solutions in the ballast water
management plan.

8 Book No.9028188 02
1 Introduction 1.1 Preparations and conditions

Even a very small amount of water, a few hundred liters, can contaminate a ballast tank and cause
non compliance during a compliance test. It is therefore important that PureBallast is always
used when water is taken in and discharged.

1.1.4.1 Process not compliant with certif cate

If ballast/deballast is not performed in a correct way, there is a risk that there will be not fully treated
water in the pipes and the tanks.

A process is not compliant if a ballast/deballast is performed with

• PureBallast bypassed (Alarm A33, 66, 67 and 68)


• higher flow rate than certified flow (Warning W12)
• not cleaned UV reactor (Warning W140)
• one or more non-functioning lamp (Warning W130, W131)
• UV intensity lower than limit stated in the type approval certificate (Warning W151, W152,
W154).
Solution

To solve the problem: Make a complete exchange of the ballast water in the tanks by using
PureBallast at deballast and ballast at a location where ballast water exchange is accepted. Also
makes sure that dead end pipes are flushed during the process to get rid of all potentially untreated
water.

1.1.4.2 Other problems


Leaking valves Leaking valves can lead to contamination, if there is untreated water
present in the piping.
Heeling Internal transfer between tanks can contaminate tanks, if untreated
water is present in the piping.
Sediment in tanks Tank sediment is a breeding ground for organisms. Therefore it is
important to review the vessel’s ballast water management plan
regarding frequency of sediment removal.

1.1.5 Pipe cleaning using PureBallast


In some vessels, the applicable class society may require means and procedure for flushing
ballast pipes with treated water, to clean them from untreated water. This procedure should be
implemented in the ships Ballast water management plan.

In PureBallast, a deballast process is run with the vessel’s ballast valves positioned so that the

• pump takes water from a ballast water tank with treated water and
• the water flow is directed either overboard or to another ballast tank.
Run the process for enough time so all water in the piping is treated. Time for this depends on pipe
size and length on board.

Book No.9028188 02 9
1.1 Preparations and conditions 1 Introduction
2 Introduction to the control
system

This section describes different login levels, overview of the system interface and how to navigate
and operate the control system.

2.1 Login levels


Different login level controls which information that is displayed and changeable. As an example,
pages used for commissioning purposes are hidden for normal operators.

Login level Pass- Authority


word

Guest N/A Default mode of control system. This level is not password protected.

• View all pages.

Operator aot • As Guest.


• Operate the system to perform daily routines, for example ballast
and acknowledge alarms.
• Full access to page 1.4 Power request.
• Download files and backup to a USB memory.

Advanced 2007 • As level Operator.


operator
• Operate equipment in manual mode.
• Access to set parameters, with exception from critical parameters.
See chapter 4. Parameters for information.
• Full access to page 4.3 Operation timers and 4.4 Operation timers
UVR.

AlfaLaval N/A Full access. Password only available for Alfa Laval personnel.

• Full access to all parameter pages.


• Full access to force I/O in page 4.2 PLC controller I/O.
• Full access to make settings for remote control panels and remote
interface in page 4.1 System info and 4.5/4.6 Remote interfaces 1
and 2.

Book No.9028188 02 11
2.2 Control of PureBallast 2 Introduction to the control system

2.2 Control of PureBallast


PureBallast can be monitored and controlled in three ways: Main control panel, remote control
panel (optional) and remote interface (optional). The system can only be controlled from one
place at a time.

The information below is only valid if remote control panels and/or remote interface is installed.

2.2.1 Remote control panels (option)


PureBallast can only be controlled from one control panel at a time.

To switch command from one panel to another, you log in to the new panel. This is only possible by
using the same or higher login level as used in the active control panel. When control is about to be
changed from one panel to another, the following will happen:

• The inactive control panel will display a popup message informing that another control panel is
active (some one else is logged in). The popup gives the alternative to cancel or to continue. If
continue is chosen, control is swithced from the first panel to the new panel.
• The active panel will display a popup message informing that another the panel is inactive
and that control is taken by another panel.
On each control panel it is possible to see which panel that is active and which login level that is
used. A panel alias can be entered to clarify where the panel is installed, for example pump room,
bridge etc. See instruction Set control panel IP address on page 76. This information is visible in
the upper right corner of the system according to syntax: login level@control panel.

“Login level” can be: Guest, Operator, Advanced operator or AlfaLaval.

“Control panel” can be:

• 192.168.0.10 (Master) = Main control panel


• 192.168.0.11 = Remote control panel 1
• 192.168.0.12 = Remote control panel 2

3 ActivePanel

Example: Operator logged in at remote control panel with alias “Bridge”.

2.2.2 Remote interface (option)


If the remote interface option is used, PureBallast can be controlled from the vessel’s ISCS.

It is only possible to switch command between control panel and ISCS from a PureBallast control
panel. This is done by using the Local and Remote buttons, when logged in as Operator or higher.
Control status (local or remote) is indicated by a green light under the button that corresponds to
the system currently in command. In the ISCS, control status can be indicated by using the status
signal dedicated to this. It is recommended that this signal is implemented in the ISCS.

12 Book No.9028188 02
2 Introduction to the control system 2.2 Control of PureBallast

When remote interface is activated, PureBallast can only be controlled from the ISCS. It possible
to access the same pages and perform the same operations from the ISCS as for login level
Operator (to the extent that the systems are integrated. However, the following two tasks can only
be performed from a (any) control panel: Set parameters and switch control between control
panel(s) and ISCS.

When remote interface is activated, the panel(s) can only be used to monitor the system, export log
files and switch control between PureBallast control panel(s) and ISCS.

The PureBallast system manual does not give any information about how to run PureBallast from
the remote interface. This is due to the fact that the remote interface is custom-made. Please
refer to the vessel specific manual.

2.2.2.1 Conditions for remote interface control


of PureBallast

PureBallast can be operated from ISCS when the conditions below are met:

Installation and settings

• The remote interface must be correctly installed, according to Remote interface implementation
guide.
• Remote interface must be activated (parameter p132) and communication settings must be
correct (parameter p700 – p704).
• The Test mode button must be deactivated (no checkmark on the button) in control system
page 4.5 Remote interface 1.
• Remote control must be activated. Check that the green lamp is lit under the Remote button
on the control panel. If not, press the button. The system must be in Standby mode to toggle
between local and remote operation.
Operation

• Heartbeat is updating. See that address 06 and 77 are updating in control system page 4.5
Remote interface 1.
• There must be no active alarms for the UV reactors to be used during operation. Always check
the alarm list (page 2.1 Alarm list in the control system) before operation.
• The UV reactor must be in standby mode.

Book No.9028188 02 13
2.3 Overview of the screen 2 Introduction to the control system

2.3 Overview of the screen


This section describes the PureBallast control system screen layout and navigation.

The control system use a touch screen, where you tap the screen to “click” or drag objects. Do not
use sharp objects to touch the screen. When the screen is left idle it will go to screensaving mode.
Time is set in page 4.1 System info. The screen is activated again by touching it once. The touch
will not activate any button that might be placed where you touch.

The illustration below shows the main areas and function buttons on the screen.

3 1.1 USCG

Control system screen showing the main overview page.

Login menu: Expanding menu with login fields.

Tabs: The top and side tabs are used to choose which page to display in the screen. Pages are
referred to as a number and a name, for example 2.1 Alarm list. The first number refers to selected
top tab, counted from left to right. The second number refers to selected side tab, counted from top
to bottom. Selected tabs are indicated by a white color.

Top tabs: Contain the main function areas of the control system: Overview, alarm lists, trend
indication, system information and parameters.

Side tabs: Contain sub pages for the area selected in the top tab. Available side tabs change
depending on which function area that have been selected in the top tab.

Popup windows: Are used to display or enter detailed information. It is possible to move a popup
by touching the name bar and drag it. A popup is closed either by touching confirming entered
information by touching a function button (OK, Conf rm, etc.) or the X icon in the top right corner
(data is not saved).

14 Book No.9028188 02
2 Introduction to the control system 2.3 Overview of the screen

Data entry f elds: A white field indicates that it is possible to enter data. When the field is touched,
a keyboard is displayed, which is used to enter information. Enter data is confirmed by touching the
Enter button. To close the keyboard without saving data, touch the Esc button.

Tables: Individual table rows, for example an alarm, can be selected by pressing them. Column
widths can be adjusted. Press the column border in the head area and hold the finger on the screen.

Function buttons: Function buttons are used for main processes and control of the system. They
are placed att the bottom of the screenare and are always visible, but only available when colored
dark blue. Some buttons are dependent on parameters. For example, the Remote and Local
buttons are only visible if remote interface is activated.

Status indication – Button color: The buttons appear in different colors, indicating status:
Blue The function is enabled.

Blue with The function is activated.


checkmark

Grey The function is disabled, for example if higher login level is required for the
function.

Status indication – Button light: After a function button is pressed, a light under the button is lit
to indicate status for the activated function:

Green Command is active.

Yellow Command will be processed when possible in the data work flow.

Yellow, blinking Command is paused.

Function button description

Button Description

Start ballast process.

Resumes paused process.


3 BallastBut

Start deballast process.

Resumes paused process.


3 DeballastBut

Stop current process.

3 StopBut

Start tank stripping process.

Resumes paused process.


3 StripBut

Book No.9028188 02 15
2.3 Overview of the screen 2 Introduction to the control system

Button Description

Pause ballast, deballast or stripping process. This is only possible during


full ballast or full deballast. The button can be hidden, using parameter
p137. Allowed length of a pause is parameter set (p138). After defined
3 PauseBut time, the paused process is stopped.

To resume a paused process, press the function button Ballast, Deballast


or Strip depending on which process that was paused.

Start CIP process.

3 CIPbut

Activate operation from control panels, instead of remote interface (if option
is used). The button is only enabled in standby mode.

3 LocalButton

Activate operation from remote interface (if option is used), instead of


control panels. The button is only enabled in standby mode.

3 RemoteBut

Sets the control system in manual mode, which enables manual operation
of the system and its components. When activated, the light flashes yellow.
The button is displayed for login level Advanced operator or higher. For
3 EnableManual detailed information see Manual mode on page 110.

Disable the touch screen function for 10 seconds to make it possible to


clean the screen without the risk of starting a process or changing a setting.

3 WhipeBut

Activate night light for the panel. Night light makes the panel less bright.
Toggles between night light and day light.

3 NightBut Degree of brightness, is set in the Night light level field in page 4.1 System
info.

Contains calculator, Notepad and print function.

To print a screen image to USB: Insert a USB memory in USB panel


port on the cabinet door. Press Utilities, and then Print to save a screen
3 Utilities
image to USB.

16 Book No.9028188 02
2 Introduction to the control system 2.3 Overview of the screen

Button Description

Sets the control system in IMO mode, which activate operation in


accordance with IMO requirements.

IMObut

Sets the control system in USCG mode, which activate operation in


accordance with USCG requirements.

USCGbut

Status indication – Alarms and warnings

Alarms and warnings for components are displayed in the flow chart and popups:

Active alarm.

3 Alarm

Active warning.

3 Warning

Book No.9028188 02 17
2.3 Overview of the screen 2 Introduction to the control system
3 Detailed page descriptions

This section describes the pages used for operation. Note that this section does not cover the
parameter pages. Please refer to chapter 4. Parameters.

3.1 Page 1.1 – Overview


The page displays an overview of the system, overall status and detailed information regarding
the components.

The main areas are the Status box and the Flow chart.

3 1.1 USCG

Control system screen showing the main overview page.

3.1.1 Status box


The status box display current status for the PureBallast system. The information is updated
continuously. To see accumulated operation runtime for the components, see page 4.3 – Operation
timers.

Book No.9028188 02 19
3.1 Page 1.1 – Overview 3 Detailed page descriptions

The following status information is displayed:

Status information (unit) Description

Process and sub process Process: Ongoing process. Can be standby, ballast, deballast
and CIP.

Sub process: Sub steps of ongoing process, for example


“Start-up” during Ballast process.

Time Remaining time for the ongoing sub process in the upper right
corner.

Processed volume (m3) Amount of water processed during ongoing process. Value
remain until next process is started.

Power consumption (kW) Power consumption for ongoing process.

Certif ed f ow (m3/h) Certified flow (m3/h) selected for operation. The information is
updated after the warm up time has passed and a UV reactor
is used for process. This is also the flow the system is aiming
to keep.

Current f ow (m3/h) Water flow in the system, indicated by flow transmitter FIT201-1.
The system aims for the selected flow minus parameter p111
Undershoot certified flow, which can be set as a safety margin.

Flow selection Flow (m3/h) selected for operation.

Flow can be selected manually or automatically:

• Automatically: Activate the Auto button (checkmark). Flow


will always be selected.
• Manually: Deactivate the Auto button (no checkmark).
Flow is selected using the + button.
Note: Before first operation after power off or shutdwon,
flow must be selected using the + button.

Ballast pump Status indication for balast water pump (not part of Alfa Laval’s
scope of supply).

Status indication

3 PumpReq
Green, blinking = Request sent. Popup message “Confirm
ballast pump started” is displayed. (The popup is not displayed
if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

Green = Feed back that pump is running, either via hard wired
feedback, remote interface or the confirmation popup.

Grey = No request sent (not running).

Overboard valve(s) Status indication for overboard valve(s), and other relevant
valves for the process (not part of Alfa Laval’s scope of supply).

20 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.1 Page 1.1 – Overview

Status information (unit) Description

Status indication

Green, blinking = Request sent. Popup message message


3 OBvalveReq “Confirm overboard valve open” is displayed. (The popup is
not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the
control system.)

Green = Feed back that valve is open, either via hard wired
feedback, remote interface or the confirmation popup.

Grey = Closed.

3.1.2 Flow chart


The flow chart display a schematic overview of the PureBallast system and its components.

Relevant information regarding ongoing process and component status can be monitored directly
in the flow chart. Flow in pipes is indicated by coloring of the pipes and component status are
displayed by color indications. Pressure, flow and control valve opening percentage are displayed
directly on component.

Detailed information about components can be monitored in popups (by tapping the component):
UV reactor see page 51; filter see page 56. CIP open page 1.3 CIP status, see page 25). The popup
contain status for sub components, for example valves, motors and UV lamps in the UV reactor.

UVR cooling water pump (P403–1) is only displayed if it is used and activated in the parameter
pages.

In manual mode (login level Advanced operator or higher) it is also possible to operate components
manually: If a component is pressed, a popup window is displayed from which the component
can be operated.

Status indication – Component color:

Component status is indicated by a colored frame:

Pipes Pipe and flow status. Flow in pipe is indicated as below:

Status indication

Blue = Fresh water or sea water, when flow goes sea-to-sea.

Green = Ballast and deballast flow.

Yellow = CIP liquid.

Mixed colors = Mixed water, for example ballast water and fresh water.

Book No.9028188 02 21
3.1 Page 1.1 – Overview 3 Detailed page descriptions

Valves and Status indication


pumps
Green, blinking = Travelling / starting

Green = Open / running

Grey = Closed / not running.

Red, flashing = Active alarm for the component.

It is also possible to enter ship specific ID for a component. The ID will be


visible in page 1.1 Overview and popups for the components. See instruction
Set ship specific component ID on page 72

Status information for bypass valve(s) V212–31 and external bypass valves
(not part of Alfa Laval’s scope of supply). These valves are operated from the
ISCS, due to safety reasons.

External bypass is only visible if parameters (p163–p165) for external bypass


valves are activated.
3 CV and Bypass icon

Status information for backfllush pump P309–1 (optional). Only visible if


parameter p318 is activated.

3 P309

The component is operated manually in manual mode.

3 Manual1

22 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.2 Page 1.2 – UVR and flow selection

3.2 Page 1.2 – UVR and f ow selection


The page is used to select UV reactors or flow for ballast and deballast and to increase (only
possible in ballast) or decrease flow during ongoing operation. It is also possible to select specific
UV reactors to be used during process, or to change UV reactor during an ongoing process.

This page is only relevant if more than one UV reactor is installed.

Normally, flow is handled from page 1.1 Overview, and this page is used during commissioning and
faultfinding when it is necessary to start individual UV reactors.

The main areas of the page are the Flow selection, UVR selection and Status.

3 1.2 USCG

3.2.1 Flow selection


Function in the same way as flow selection in page 1.1 Overview.

Book No.9028188 02 23
3.2 Page 1.2 – UVR and flow selection 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.2.2 UVR selection


The area displays a table with installed UV reactors with status information. If more than one UV
reactor is installed, it is possible to choose individual UV reactor for process in standby (if the Auto
button is deactivated) or during process (regardless of Auto button mode).

The following information is displayed:

Elements Description

Modify button Enables active selection of individual UV reactors. When pressed, the
buttons for respective UV reactor turns blue and are possible to use.

UVR 1, 2, 3 button One row for respective installed UV reactor with current status indicated
in the columns.

UVR button: Press the button to select or deselect. A checkmark on the


button indicates selected. The flow setpoint for the number of UV reactors
selected are updated in the Flow selection area.

Status indication:

Selected: Grey = Not selected. Green = Selected.

Ready: Grey = Not ready. Green = Ready for process.

Alarm: Grey = No alarm. Red = Active alarm.

Apply button Apply the new setpoint to be used for process.


Note: If ballast flow is lower than deballast flow (parameter p315), the
higher value is displayed until the Ballast button is pressed.

3.2.3 Status
The area displays current status for the flow:

Elements Description

Current f ow Ballast water flow in the system, indicated by flow transmitter FIT201-1.

Certif ed f ow Maximum allowed flow as set in Flow setpoint or limited by the number of
UV reactors selected in UVR selection popup. If a smaller filter is installed,
the ballast flow can be lower than the UV reactor capacity.

The information is updated after the warm up time has elapsed and a UV
reactor is used for process. (Before that it is not used for treatment, and
therefore not part of the certified flow.)

24 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.3 Page 1.3 – CIP status

3.3 Page 1.3 – CIP status


The page is used to display CIP status for all UV reactors and status for the valves and motors in
the CIP unit. The page can either be opened by selecting the tab or by tapping the CIP module in
page 1.1 Overview.

3 1.3 USCG

The following information is displayed:

Book No.9028188 02 25
3.3 Page 1.3 – CIP status 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.3.1 CIP status


The area displays status for the following pieces of information:

Row Content

Process and sub Process: Ongoing process. Can be standby, ballast, deballast and CIP.
process
Sub process: Sub steps of ongoing process, for example “Start-up” during
Ballast process.

3.3.2 UVR information


The area displays CIP status for respective installed UV reactor:

Row Content

UV Each row display CIP status for every installed UV reactor

Filter preservation This row indicate status and time for the filter preservation process, that
starts after completed CIP. During filter preservation, the CIP fills the filter
with fresh water for preservation purpose.

Total Total estimated time for a complete CIP process including filter preservation.

Column Content

CIP error Red square: Indicates that there is an active alarm for the component.
Check alarms on page 2.1 – Alarm list.

CIP CIP status for each UV reactor.

Status indication

Yellow = CIP required. During ongoing CIP process, yellow indicates that
the UV reactor is waiting for CIP process to start.

Yellow, blinking = CIP process ongoing.

Green = CIP completed.

White = CIP required, but cannot be performed, due to active alarm on


the UV reactor.

Status Same information as column CIP, but spelled out.

26 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.3 Page 1.3 – CIP status

Column Content

Estimated time Time remaining CIP time. If CIP process has not been started, total time is
displayed. During CIP process, the time is counting down continuously.

The CIP process takes about 25 minutes , if default parameters are used.

Required CIP Time before a CIP process must be performed after ballast or deballast.
countdown The time disappears when the CIP process is ready. Time is displayed for
the UVR with shortest time left to required CIP.

3.3.3 CIP module information


The area displays a schematic illustration of the CIP module, with status for for the valves and
motors. For status indications, see Status indication – Component color in section Flow chart
on page 21.

Book No.9028188 02 27
3.4 Page 1.4 – Power request 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.4 Page 1.4 – Power request


The page is used to handle power management. The page have two functions: Display power
status and test power management signals.

3 1.4 USCG

3.4.1 Power management status display


If the control system is set in normal mode, the page is used to display power management status.

Column Content

Process and sub Process: Ongoing process. Can be standby, ballast, deballast and CIP.
process
Sub process: Sub steps of ongoing process, for example “Start-up” during
Ballast process.

Max power Maximum power consumption for the number of selected UV reactors. The
consumption value is updated when a process is started.

Measured power Power consumption during process. Value calculated based on number
consumption of used UV reactors.

28 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.4 Page 1.4 – Power request

Power status

Column Content

Power Each row represent a number of UV reactors to be used in a process.


Requests can be combined to send request for 3 UV reactors.

1 UVR: Request power for 1 UV reactor.

2 UVRs: Request power for 2 UV reactors.

The requested power is calculated as the number of UV reactor times


defined power consumption for one UV reactor.

Common power: Request maximum power, enough to run all UV reactors


installed, even if all UV reactors are not used.

Request Indication alternatives: “Requested” or “Not requested”.


(Output signal from
PureBallast) Indicates if power request has been sent to the ISCS.

Pure Ballast always asks for power before the UV lamps are lit during ballast
or deballast start-up. When a request has been sent, the vessels power
management performs a power check before the generator is started.

Manual mode: Indicates if a simulated request signal is sent.

Granted Indication alternatives: “Yes” or “No”.


(Input signal to
PureBallast) Indicates if power request has been granted from the ISCS. Pure Ballast
will not consume significant power until the requested power is granted.

Manual mode: Indicates if a simulated granted signal is received.

Status Indication alternatives: “Running” or “Not running”.


(Output signal from
PureBallast) Indicates if power running signal is sent to the ISCS for respective number
of UV reactors. This means that the UV reactor is started and is consuming
power.

Manual mode: Indicates if a simulated running signal is sent.

Power Power consumption for ongoing process.


consumption
If individual rows have been selected, the value is the sum of the number of
UV reactor for the request times the set power consumption per UV reactor.

If Common power has been selected, the value is 100 kW.

3.4.2 Power management simulation and faultf nding


If the control system is set in manual mode, the page is used to simulate output from PureBallast to
the power management system during commissioning preparation.

Book No.9028188 02 29
3.4 Page 1.4 – Power request 3 Detailed page descriptions

The page can also be used to troubleshoot the power management system integration by sending
and checking each signal.

3.4.3 Function buttons


The following function buttons are available and displayed when manual mode is activated:

Buttons Content

If manual mode is activated, a hand icons are displayed on the page.


Press the hand icon to make it possible to send simulated request or
granted signal manually.
3Manual1

Request Press to manually simulate request for a power step. The button is
displayed for login level Advanced operator or higher.

Set run Press to manually simulate run signal for a power step. The button is
displayed for login level Advanced operator or higher.

30 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.5 Page 2.1 – Alarm list

3.5 Page 2.1 – Alarm list


The page display active alarms and warnings. When an alarm/warning is inactive and
acknowledged, it is moved to page 2.2 Alarm history.

Alarm type can be of two types:

- A = Alarms stop the ongoing process, which can be restarted after the problem has been
attended to.
- W = Warnings are notification of a status change, request for action or a problem that must be
attended to. Warnings allow the process to continue.
For detailed information about alarms and warnings see chapter 5. Alarms and faultfinding.

3 2.1 USCG

The main areas of the page are the Alarm list and the Function buttons:

Book No.9028188 02 31
3.5 Page 2.1 – Alarm list 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.5.1 Alarm list


The following information is displayed for each alarm (row):

Column Content

Text Descriptive alarm text written as: Area-Alarm type AlarmID Alarmtext.
Example: UVR2 A138 Error in LDC cabinet.

Active time The time alarm was activated.

Acknow- The time the alarm/warning was acknowledged. The alarm/warning remains
ledged time in the alarm list until the causing condition is resolved. For example a high
temperature alarm will remain visible, until the temperature is below the limit
value for the alarm/warning.

Status indication – Alarm color

The table below shows status indication for alarms and warnings in the alarm list.

Red Alarm = active

Pink Alarm = acknowledged, but still active

Orange Warning = active

Yellow Warning = acknowledged, but still active

3.5.2 Function buttons


The following function buttons are available:

Button Function

Ack selected Acknowledge selected alarm (row). Press a row to indicate it, and press the
button to acknowledge it.

Ack all Acknowledge all active alarms.

32 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.6 Page 2.2 – Alarm history

3.6 Page 2.2 – Alarm history


The page display a list of inactive, previously acknowledged alarms.

3 2.2 USCG

The following information is displayed:

Column Content
Text Same as in Page 2.1 Alarm list.

Active time Same as in Page 2.1 Alarm list.

Acknowledged Same as in Page 2.1 Alarm list.


time

Normal time The time the value that caused the alarm returned to normal.

Book No.9028188 02 33
3.7 Page 3.1 – Trend (15 min) 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.7 Page 3.1 – Trend (15 min)


The page is used to display trend curves for basic data in the system. This page display trends
with a update frequency (sample time) of 2 seconds and the time span for trends displayed on the
screen is 15 minutes. Trend curves are saved in the trend history for 2 hours, and are then deleted.

This page is useful for analyzing processes, for example backflushes.

3 3.1 USCG

Trends can be plotted for the following components (identified by item number) and key values:

Component / Unit Description


Key value

Filter diff. pressure Bar Differential pressure over filter, indicated by pressure
transmitter 201–71 and 201–72.

V201–8 % Control valve open, percent.

PT201-16 Bar System pressure, indicated by the pressure transmitter.

V309-1 Status Filter backflush valve opened or closed.

FIT 201-1 m3 h System flow, indicated by the flow meter.

External feed % External feed signal, to request increased/decreased flow


from external ballast water pump/valve.

34 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.7 Page 3.1 – Trend (15 min)

3.7.1 Diagram area


In the diagram area, trend curves are displayed for one or more components. Components
available for plotting is displayed at the bottom of the screen. Trend curves can be activated or
inactivated for respective component.

The scale of the diagram:

X axis: The time interval is always 15 minutes.

Y axis: The scale and unit used for the Y axis is set in the Settings popup for respective component.
For details, see the Component area section below.

3.7.2 Component area


The following fields and buttons are available for each component in the component area:

Column Content / Function

Settings Press the button to make settings for the component’s curve. Settings are
button done in a popup.

3 TrendCurveSet1Nr

1: Press (not slide) the top right button to display or hide trend curve in the
diagram. A green I indicate displayed, and a grey O indicates not displayed.

2: Press the entry field to change start and stop value for the components Y
axis scale (when this component’s scale setting is used).

3: Press this button to use this component’s scale setting in the diagram.

4. Press the entry field to enter number of decimals in the component area, or
use the - - or ++ buttons to increase or decrease.

Book No.9028188 02 35
3.7 Page 3.1 – Trend (15 min) 3 Detailed page descriptions

Status Filled = Selected. Component values is plotted in the diagram,


indication in the same color as the icon.
3 TrendActive

Empty = Not selected. Component values is not plotted in the


diagram.
3 TrendInactive

Scale icon = The component scale setting is used in the


diagram’s Y axis. If several components have the same scale
3 TrendScale
setting, this icon is displayed for all these items.

Component Item number or name.

Value Current value for the component is displayed in the gray field. (This
corresponds to the diagram.)

If history mode is selected, historic value is displayed.

3.7.3 Function buttons


The following function buttons are available.

Buttons Content

Export long- Export trend curve history as a csv file. The file can be sent to Alfa Laval for
term trend advanced trouble shooting.
data to USB
Insert a USB memory in USB panel port on the cabinet door. Press Export
long-term data to USB button. Wait for the message “Exporting database
table …” to disappear. The file has been downloaded to the USB memory,
in a folder named DatabaseExport.

History mode Only available for page 3.1. Press the button to display this popup:

3 TrendCurveTime

Press one time unit (year, moth, day etc) and then press – or + to set time.

Real time Press the button to display current trend curve.

36 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.12 Page 3.7 – Trend (15 min) - External
feed optimization

3.8 Page 3.2 – Trend (1 h)


The page is used to display trend curves for basic data in the system. This page display trends
with a update frequency (sample time) of 15 seconds and the time span for trends displayed on the
screen is 24 hours. Trend curves are saved in the trend history for 2 hours, and are then deleted.

See page 3.1 Trend (15 min.) for information about function, fields and buttons.

3.9 Page 3.3 – Trend (1 h) - TT201-33


The page is used to display trend curves for water temperature in the UV reactor, indicated by
temperature transmitter TT201–33. This page display trends with a update frequency (sample
time) of 30 seconds.

See page 3.1 Trend (15 min.) for information about function, fields and buttons.

3.10 Page 3.4 – Trend (1 h) - TT401-2


The page is used to display trend curves for air temperature in LDC, indicated by temperature
transmitter TT401–2. This page display trends with a update frequency (sample time) of 30 seconds.

See page 3.1 Trend (15 min.) for information about function, fields and buttons.

3.11 Page 3.5 – Trend (1 h) - Power optimization


The page is used to display trend curves for data valid for the power optimization. This page display
trends with a update frequency (sample time) of 30 seconds.

See page 3.1 Trend (15 min.) for information about function, fields and buttons. See chapter 2.
System description, section Power optimization for details.

The following information is displayed:

• UVR UV setpoint: The UV intensity the system is aiming to attain by increasing or decreasing
power effect to the LPS controlling the dimming of the UV lamps. The setpoint is based on
actual transmittance and is updated every 15 seconds.
• UV measurement: Actual UV intensity (W/m2) measured by UV sensor QT201–50. If intensity
is lower or higher than needed, the power to LPS will increase or decrease to attain setpoint
for UV intensity.
• Power output: Actual LPS power to UV lamps. The power is adjusted to attain the setpoint for
UV intensity based on measured water transmittance. Output is adjusted based on input from
UV sensor QT201–50. Power can be 50–100 %.
3.12 Page 3.7 – Trend (15 min) - External feed
optimization
The page is used to display the trend curves for detailed data valild for the external feed.

Book No.9028188 02 37
3.12 Page 3.7 – Trend (15 min) - External 3 Detailed page descriptions
feed optimization

We recommend that page 3.1 is used to monitor external feed trend curves. This page is mainly
ussed for advanced trouble shooting.

The external feed is used to fine tune the control of the flow that comes to PureBallast. It works as
an addition to the flow controlled by the control valve (V201-8).

38 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.13 Page 4.1 – System info

3.13 Page 4.1 – System info


The page is used to display status information for the control system and the control panel. It is also
used to backup information and restore information from a backup.

3 4.1 USCG

The following information is displayed:

Section on page Description

HMI info CPU: Control panel’s usage of the central processor unit (CPU) in
percent of total capacity and temperature (°C). The control panel will
shut down when the CPU reaches 100 °C.

Used RAM: Control panel’s used random access memory (RAM) in


percent of total capacity and in kB.

Used storage: PLC flash card’s used storage in percent and MB.
Storage used for the event and alarm log.

iX version: N/A.

T15BR f rmware: Version of internal firmware for the control panel.

CAT control version: N/A.

PureBalalst HMI software version: Version of HMI software.

IP settings: Display current IP address for the panel.

Book No.9028188 02 39
3.13 Page 4.1 – System info 3 Detailed page descriptions

Section on page Description

Setup button: Opens popup to set IP address for the main panel and
the remote control panels (optional). Requires login level AlfaLaval.

HMI date and time UTC Date and time: Only used if GPS with RMC protocoll is not
connected to the control system. If so, time is retrieved from the
GPS. Requires login level Advanced operator.

Set button: Set time and date for the main control panel. Remote
control panels are updated with this time within 15 minutes after
syncronization.

Synchronize button: PLC is synchronized to use same date and


time as set in the control panel.

HMI Backlight Screen saver timeout: Defines time before the panel is set to
screen save mode. This is set individually per control panel.

Night light level: Defines percent of full light for the night light
mode. Night light is activated by the Night function button.

PLC Info CPU temperature (°C): Temperature of the central processor unit
(CPU) in the PLC.

PureBallast PLC sotfware version: Version of the PureBallast


PLC program.

GPS position: Shows current GPS position, if the control system


is connected to a GPS. This position is used in the event log. First
GPS field display position as decimal and second as position with
correct notation (degrees).

Control cabinet conf guration: Indicates if control of booster


pumps can be controlled from PureBallast control cabinet.
1: Pump started by signal from PureBallast control cabinet: Power
supply with over current protection relay and contactors and are
handled externally.
2: Pump completely controlled from PureBallast control cabinet:
Start signal and power supply with over current protection relays
and contactors from control cabinet. It is still possible to connect
pumps according to configuration 1.

Control cabinet configuration affect parameter p129, p130 and p310.

40 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.13 Page 4.1 – System info

Section on page Description

Backup and restore Settings to/from USB panel: Export and inport information to the
USB panel port on the cabinet door.

Backup button: The following information is saved in a folder named


“PureBallast Backup”:

• Parameter settings. File: Parameters.csv.


• Operating timers for UVR, UV lamps etc. File:
operatingtimers.csv.
• Settings for components in the trend curve pages. File:
ValueSaved.xml and ValueTrendLegend.xml.
• Settings for trend pages, e.g. min and max values for different
components. File: ValueTrendLegend.xml.
• Notpad.txt. Can be used to make notes for the backup.
Restore button: Restore all information from a USB backup to
the control system. See Backup above. This shall not be used to
restore parameter settings after software update. Requires login
level Advanced operator.

Parameters: Parameter restore.

Set default button: Set all parameter values to the default values.
Requires login level Advanced operator.

Export log f les Export button: Opens the Export log f les popup to export (copy)
event log files and alarm list.

For specific information about logged events, see section List of


logged information, Event log on page 87.

Remote control panels Remote control panels button: Open a popup used for setting IP
addresses for remote control panels (optional). See instruction Set
control panel IP address on page 76.

Requires login level AlfaLaval.

Book No.9028188 02 41
3.14 Page 4.2 – PLC controller I/O 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.14 Page 4.2 – PLC controller I/O


The page is used to display status for the PLC I/O modules and to control them manually.

Note that this page is only intended for Alfa Laval’s personnel and only visible and available for
login level AlfaLaval.

42 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.15 Page 4.3 – Operation timers

3.15 Page 4.3 – Operation timers


The page is used to display operation counters for the components indicted in the illustration.

3 4.3 USCG

The following information is displayed:

Row Unit

Accumulated ballast volume (FIT 201-1) m3 processed

Accumulated deballast volume (FIT 201-1) m3 processed

Control valve V201-8 total runtime Time opened in hours

LDC cooling booster pump total runtime (P401–1) Runtime in hours

Reactor cooling booster pump total runtime (P403–1) Runtime in hours

Filter backflush cycles Number of backflushes

Filter motor (M709–43) total runtime Runtime in hours

Filter backflush pump (P309) total rumtime Number of times opened

CIP pump P320-1 Runtime in hours

Book No.9028188 02 43
3.15 Page 4.3 – Operation timers 3 Detailed page descriptions

Row Unit

CIP pump P321-5 Runtime in hours

CIP: Number of cleaned UVRs. Number of cleaned UV reactors

Reset button: Reset to 0. If this is done each time the CIP


liquid is changed, it is possible to build up experience on how
many UV reactors it is possible to CIP before it is time to change
CIP liquid. Requires login level Advanced operator or higher.

44 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.16 Page 4.4 Operation timers UVR

3.16 Page 4.4 Operation timers UVR


The page is used to display operation runtime for UV reactors:

3 4.4 USCG

The following information is displayed:

UVR operation Total Lap time


timers

UVR 1–3: Total runtime for the UV lamps in Lap time for installed UV lamps, since
Lamps on respective UV reactor. the counter was reset after previous
reset at UV lamp change.

Reset button: Reset the value. Shall


be done after UV lamp change.
Requires login level Advanced
operator or higher.

UVR 1–3: LDC Total runtime for the LDC for


power on respective UV reactor.

Book No.9028188 02 45
3.17 Page 4.5 – Remote interface 1 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.17 Page 4.5 – Remote interface 1


This page is used to monitor data sent between PureBallast’s PLC and the vessel’s ISCS.

For detailed information about addresses, information and format, see chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings, section Remote interface integration (optional).

3 4.5 USCG

Function buttons Description

Test mode Activates test mode. Communication can be sent between the
ISCS and PureBallast’s PLC without actually affecting the control
system (start process etc). To send information, enter desired
digits in the entry field.

Active: Check mark on the button.


Deactivated: No check mark on the button.

46 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.18 Page 4.6 – Remote interface 2

3.18 Page 4.6 – Remote interface 2


This page is used to monitor UV reactor and LDC specific data sent from PureBallast’s PLC to the
vessel’s ISCS.

For detailed information about addresses, information and format, see chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings, section Remote interface integration (optional).

3 4.6 USCG

Book No.9028188 02 47
3.19 Page 4.7 – Log box 1 3 Detailed page descriptions

3.19 Page 4.7 – Log box 1


This page is used to administer and monitor the feedback from external components connected via
the log box (optional). The page is used for defining all individual combinations of signals that result
in a bypass or heeling. PureBallast use the input to write events to the event log and to trigger
correct actions based on if the vessel’s components constitute a bypass or heeling.

For detailed information, see the Log box installation guide.

3 4.7 USCG

The following information is displayed:

Column Content

Top f elds for administration

Conf guration Choose to define/view bypass or heeling configurations.


type

Conf guration Select configuration number by entering a number or using the arrow buttons.
nr Signal status and Configuration are displayed for selected configuration
number.

Save conf g Saves configuration information after a change.


button

Signal setting

48 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.20 Page 4.9 – LPS overview

Column Content

Top f elds for administration

Signal input Heading for input signal 1 – 32.

Signal status Indication of current status for signal 1 – 32.


Green light = Active signal.
No light = No signal.

Conf guration This is the definition of which signal that should be active to constitute a
bypass/heeling. Tap the checkbox to select or unselect it.

Selected = All selected signals, must be active for the configuration to


occur.Not selected = Not part of configuration.

3.20 Page 4.9 – LPS overview


This page is used to monitor detailed data for the lamp power supplies in the lamp drive cabinet. It
is intended for Alfa Laval’s personnel during advanced faultfinding. The number of LPSs displayed
corresponds to the number of LPSs installed per LDC.

3 4.9 Obe USCG

Book No.9028188 02 49
3.20 Page 4.9 – LPS overview 3 Detailed page descriptions

Column Content

LPS number Each row indicate status for each LPS.

Power Measured power output for UV lamp powered by the LPS.

Lamp on Status: Green = On. Grey = Off.

Ignition Status: Red = Failure to ignite UV lamp.

LPS OK Status: Green = OK. Red = LPS in fault state.

Lamp OK Status: Green = UV lamp lit and LPS is OK. Red = LPS in fault state.

Lamp open Status: Rec = No lamp, circuit open.

Voltage fault Status: Red = Too low incoming power to the LPS.

System fault General LPS error.

Air temp fault Status: Red = Temperature in LPS is higher than 45°C.

Heatsink fault LPS internal heat protection tripped.

Fan fault LPS fan broken.

50 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.22 Popup windows

3.21 Page 5.1–5.7 – Parameter pages


These pages are used to set parameters. See chapter 4. Parameters for detailed information.

3.22 Popup windows


This section describes the popup windows for the UV reactor, filter and CIP opened from page 1.1
Overview.

It is possible to lock a popup, so it remains open, even if you change page. Press the pin icon to
lock and unlock the popup.
Grey = Unlocked. Blue = Locked.

3 PopLock

3 PopLockBlue

3.22.1 UVR popup


The popup is displayed when the UV reactor is pressed in the flow chart. The popup displays status
values for the UV reactor and its related sub components.

In manual mode (login level Advanced operator or higher) it is also possible to operate components
manually. If the component is pressed, a popup window is displayed from which the sub
components can be operated. Operation of UV lamps in LPS control popup requires login level
Advanced operator. LDC cooling water pump (P401–1) is only displayed if it is used and activated
in the parameter pages.

UVR status: Status indication for the UV reactor: ”Stopped” or “Started”.

Book No.9028188 02 51
3.22 Popup windows 3 Detailed page descriptions

3 1.1. UVR popObe

The following information is displayed:UVR illustration

The following information is displayed:

Component Description

UV lamps Status indication:

Grey = Off.
Yellow = Starting.
Green = Started.

Sensor Status indication for UV reactor sensors:


indications
LS201–29/: Level switch indicates if the UV reactor is filled with water or not.
Status indication: Green = Filled. Red = Not filled.

TS201–60/: Temperature switch automatically shuts down the UV reactor


when the temperature reaches 65 °C.
Status indication: Green = OK. Red = Not OK.

QT201–50: UV sensor QT201–50 indicates UV intensity from the UV


lamps in the UV reactor.

TT201–33: Temperature indicator TT201-33 indicates current temperature


in the UV reactor.

Valves For status indications, see Status indication – Component color in section
Flow chart on page 21.

Water f ow Flow in pipes is indicated by coloring of the pipes.

52 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.22 Popup windows

LDC status

Component Description

Open the LPS control popup, which enables manual operation of individual
UV lamps. Requires login level Advanced operator to see the button and
3 LPSctrlbut
manual mode open the popup. See LPS control popup and instruction
Operate UV lamps manually on page 71.

Open the LPS status popup, which gives an overview of status for UV
lamps and LPSs.
3 LPS StatusBut

Fan speed Fan rotation in percent of full effect. Fan effect is based on need for cooling.

Air temperature Air temperature in the LDC cabinet indicated by TT401–2.

Water temperature Temperature of incoming cooling water to the LDC cabinet indicated by
TT401–1.

Heat exchanger Indicates if the valve for LDC cooling water (SV401–51) is open.
valve Status indication: Green = Open. No indication = Closed.

P401–1 Cooling Indicates if the LDC cooling water pump is running or not. The pump is
water pump running if the cabinet needs cooling, based on temperature.
Status indication: Green = Running. No indication = Not running.

Indicates if the leakage sensor LS1 is indicating whet condition in the


cabinet.
3 LDC LS1
Status indication: Grey = Dry. Red = Whet.

3.22.1.1 LPS control popup

The popup is used for to manually start the UV lamps in the UV reactor. See instruction Operate
UV lamps manually on page 71. The popup is displayed when the LPS control button is pressed
in the UVR popup. Requires login level Advanced operator to see the button and that manual
mode is activated to open the popup.

The UV reactor is equipped with 16 UV lamps. In each lamp drive cabinet (LDC) is 16 lamp power
supplies (LPS) that supplies power to one UV lamp each. The lamps can be operated individually in
manual mode.

DANGER
!
• Manual start of the UV lamps is only allowed (and possible) when there is water in the UV
reactor (indicated by level switch LS201-29), and the water temperature is below 60 °C. All
necessary items – cooling water flow, water temperature, and power management – must be
supervised and verified by the authorized trained personnel operating the system. Improper
operation of this function could seriously damage the equipment and injure personnel.

Book No.9028188 02 53
3.22 Popup windows 3 Detailed page descriptions

3 LPS control popObe

The following information is displayed:

Component Description

UVR number Information is displayed for the UV reactor selected in the UVR number
field.

Enables manual operation of the LPSs to light the UV lamps. The button is
displayed for login level Advanced operator or higher. The button enables
3 LPS Manual
manual lcontrol of UV lamps.

LPS 1–16 Press one button (1–16) to start or stop UV lamp 1–16 manually, controlled
by the LPS.

Status indication:

Blue with checkmark = Lit

Blue without checkmark = Off

Grey = Not selectable.

Start all LPS, and thereby all lamps for the UV reactor. Requires that the
Manual mode button is pressed.
3 LPS StartAll

Stops all LPS, and thereby all lamps for the UV reactor.

3 LPS StopAll

3.22.1.2 LPS status

The popup gives detailed information about UV intensity for UV reactors and power for LPSs. The
information is mainly used for advanced trouble shooting by Alfa Laval’s personnel.

54 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.22 Popup windows

3 LPS status popObe

The following information is displayed:

LPS status

Component Description

UVR Information is displayed for the UV reactor selected in the UVR number
field.

LPS fail safe Displays if LPSs is active and powered on. UV lamps can only be lit if an
LPS is active. When a critical alarm (e.g. no water in the UV reactor) is
issued, the fail safe function inactivates the LPSs and cut the power.

Status indication: Green = Active. Grey = Not active.


3 1.1 LPS active

LPS 1–16 Actual effect from each LPS to respective UV lamp. Green = LPS/Lamp
on. Gray = LPS/Lamp off.

Power optimization

Book No.9028188 02 55
3.22 Popup windows 3 Detailed page descriptions

Component Description

Setpoint The UV intensity the system is aiming to attain by increasing or decreasing


power effect to the LPS controlling the dimming of the UV lamps.

Measured Actual UV intensity (W/m2) measured by UV sensor QT201–50. If intensity


is lower or higher than needed, the effect to LPS will increase or decrease
to attain setpoint for UV intensity.

Power output Actual LPS power effect to UV lamps.

The effect is adjusted to attain the setpoint for UV intensity based on


measured water transmittance. Output is adjusted based on input from
UV sensor QT201–50. Effect can be 50–100 %.

Control mode Displays current control mode. Status indication:

• Automatic: Normal mode. Power optimization is activated.


• Manual: If function button Manual is pressed, it is possible to enter a
value in the Manual power output field.
• Not used: Power optimization is disabled in parameter p237. UV
lamps are always lit to 100 %.

Manual power Manually set effect to LPS. Requires that the system is set in manual
output mode.

3.22.2 Filter popup


The popup is displayed when the Filter is pressed in the flow chart. The popup displays status
values for the filter and its related components.

In manual mode (login level Advanced operator or higher) it is also possible to operate components
manually. If the component is pressed, a popup window is displayed from which the sub component
can be operated. When manual mode is deactivated the system will return to standby mode: All
manually operated components will return to their status prior to the manual operation.

56 Book No.9028188 02
3 Detailed page descriptions 3.22 Popup windows

3 1.1 Filter Filtrex

The following information is displayed:

Component Description

Mode Filter status:


- Idle (No backflush or preservation)
- Backflush preparation
- Backflush ongoing
- Continuous backflush
- Filter preservation.

Diff. pressure Indicates differential pressure over thefilter (PT201–71 minus


PT201–72). When the pressure reach the value set in parameter p305,
a backflush is triggered.

Pressure Current pressure:

PT201–71: Inlet pressure.


PT201–72: Outlet pressure.

Press the button to start a manual backflush. See instruction Backflush


filter manually on page 65.
3 BackflushBut

Pipes, valves, motor For status indications, see Status indication – Component color in
and pump section Flow chart on page 21.

Book No.9028188 02 57
3.22 Popup windows 3 Detailed page descriptions
4 Operating instructions

This section contains step-by-step instructions for operating the PureBallast system. Please read
and follow the preparations and conditions carefully, as well as any danger or warning notes.

Preparations and conditions

For reference information, see the following sections i this chapter:

• Control system pages used in the instructions: See section Control system — Detailed page
descriptions.
• Login levels required for different procedures: See section Login levels on page 11.
• Detailed information about components (valves, motors, pumps etc) involved in each step the
process. See section Detailed process description.

4.1 Log in
Follow the steps below

1. Press the expand button on the Log in tab in the top right corner of the screen.
Result: The log in menu is displayed.

2. Press the expand button on the left drop down menu to display available users. Press desired
user.
Result: A keyboard is displayed.

3. Enter password and press Enter. (See section Login levels on page 11.)

4.2 Perform ballast


Follow this instruction to ballast.

Preparations and conditions

• IMO or USCG mode must be selected by IMO or USCG function buttons, based on which
legislation that should be followed.
• The Alarm list (page 2.1) must be controlled to verify that there are no alarms needing attention.
• All ballast system valves outside the PureBallast system must be set in the correct positions
for ballasting. The valve after the ballast pump must be closed (not part of Alfa Laval’s scope
of supply).
• Flow must have been selected before a process can be started, either manually or automatically.
See Flow selection on page 19.

Book No.9028188 02 59
4.2 Perform ballast 4 Operating instructions

• There must be available power for the system. If power management is integrated, this will
be handled automatically. If power management is not integrated, confirm available power
manually.
Follow the steps below:

1. Press the function button Ballast.


Comment: If the button is not blue, check that flow or UV reactors have been selected.

2. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: Ballast start-up starts, with cooling water cooling the lamps during warm-up.

3. Wait for the message “Confirm ballast pump started”. Start the pump and then press the
button in the popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast
system control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with
the control system.)
Result: Cooling stops and ballasting starts.

4. When desired amount of water has been processed, press the function button Stop.
To get a smooth stop, the flow from the ballast pump can be reduced, but not more than 50 %.
Result: Ongoing process is stopped and the lamps are switched off. An automatic filter
backflush is performed.

5. Wait for the message “Close valves ...”. Close relevant valves and then press the button in
the popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside outside the PureBallast
system control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with
the control system.)

6. Wait for the message “Stop ballast water pump”. Stop the pump and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

7. Wait for the ”Start CIP” popup.


Yes: ACIP process will be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).
In No is chosen, CIP must be started within time indicated in the popup. A ballast/deballast
process can be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).

CIPpop

60 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.3 Perform deballast

NOTE

A CIP cleaning process must be f nished within the time stated in the popup (30 hours from the f rst operation
after the previous CIP process). Therefore consider the time for CIP process. A CIP process takes about 25
minutes , if default parameters are used. If no CIP process is performed within the time limit an entry is made in
the control system log f le. Operations after the warning does not fullf ll the type approval certif cate.

Note that it is possible to run operations during the 30 hours. Complete status information regarding CIP is
displayed in page 1.3 CIP status. A CIP process is started manually according to instruction CIP clean UVR
after ballast / deballast on page 65.

4.3 Perform deballast


Follow this instruction to deballast.

Preparations and conditions

• IMO or USCG mode must be selected by IMO or USCG function buttons, based on which
legislation that should be followed.
• The Alarm list (page 2.1) must be controlled to verify that there are no alarms needing attention.
• All ballast system valves outside the PureBallast system must be set in the correct positions
for ballasting. The valve after the ballast pump must be closed (not part of Alfa Laval’s scope
of supply).
• Flow must have been selected before a process can be started, either manually or automatically.
See Flow selection on page 19.
• There must be available power for the system. If power management is integrated, this will
be handled automatically. If power management is not integrated, confirm available power
manually.
Follow the steps below:

1. Press the function button Deballast.


Comment: If the button is not blue, check that flow or UV reactor have been selected.

2. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: Deballast start-up starts, with cooling water cooling the lamps during warm-up.

3. Wait for the message “Confirm ballast pump started”. Start the pump and then press the
button in the popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast
system control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with
the control system.)
Result: Cooling stops and deballasting starts.

4. When desired amount of water has been processed, press the function button Stop.
To get a smooth stop, the flow from the ballast pump can be reduced, but not more than 50 %.
Result: Ongoing process is stopped and the lamps are switched off.

5. Wait for the message “Stop ballast water pump”. Stop the pump and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

Book No.9028188 02 61
4.4 Perform tank stripping 4 Operating instructions

6. Wait for the message “Close valves ...”. Close relevant valves and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

7. Wait for the ”Start CIP” popup.


Yes: ACIP process will be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).
In No is chosen, CIP must be started within time indicated in the popup. A ballast/deballast
process can be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).

CIPpop

NOTE

A CIP cleaning process must be f nished within the time stated in the popup (30 hours from the f rst operation
after the previous CIP process). Therefore consider the time for CIP process. A CIP process takes about 25
minutes , if default parameters are used. If no CIP process is performed within the time limit an entry is made in
the control system log f le. Operations after the warning does not fullf ll the type approval certif cate.

Note that it is possible to run operations during the 30 hours. Complete status information regarding CIP is
displayed in page 1.3 CIP status. A CIP process is started manually according to instruction CIP clean UVR
after ballast / deballast on page 65.

4.4 Perform tank stripping


Follow this instruction to deballast.

Preparations and conditions

• IMO or USCG mode must be selected by IMO or USCG function buttons, based on which
legislation that should be followed.
• The Alarm list (page 2.1) must be controlled to verify that there are no alarms needing attention.
• Stripping function must be activated in parameter p170.
• All ballast system valves outside the PureBallast system must be set in the correct positions
for ballasting. The valve after the ballast pump must be closed (not part of Alfa Laval’s scope
of supply).
• There must be available power for the system. If power management is integrated, this will
be handled automatically. If power management is not integrated, confirm available power
manually.
Follow the steps below:

62 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.4 Perform tank stripping

1. Press the function button Strip.


Comment: If the button is not blue, check that flow or UV reactor have been selected.

2. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: Deballast start-up starts, with cooling water cooling the lamps during warm-up.

3. Wait for the message “Confirm strip pump started”. Start the pump and then press the button
in the popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system
control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control
system.)
Result: Cooling stops and stripping starts.

4. When desired amount of water has been stripped, press the function button Stop.
Result: Ongoing process is stopped and the lamps are switched off.

5. Wait for the message “Stop stripping water pump”. Stop the pump and then press the button
in the popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system
control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control
system.)

6. Wait for the message “Close valves ...”. Close relevant valves and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

7. Wait for the ”Start CIP” popup.


Yes: ACIP process will be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).
In No is chosen, CIP must be started within time indicated in the popup. A ballast/deballast
process can be started after the UV lamp cooling time (5 minutes ).

CIPpop

NOTE

A CIP cleaning process must be f nished within the time stated in the popup (30 hours from the f rst operation
after the previous CIP process). Therefore consider the time for CIP process. A CIP process takes about
25minutes , if default parameters are used. If no CIP process is performed within the time limit an entry is made
in the control system log f le. Operations after the warning does not fulf ll the type approval certif cate.

Note that it is possible to run operations during the 30 hours. Complete status information regarding CIP is
displayed in page 1.3 CIP status. A CIP process is started manually according to instruction CIP clean UVR
after ballast / deballast on page 65.

Book No.9028188 02 63
4.6 Heel (internal transfer) 4 Operating instructions

4.5 Pause ballast / deballast / stripping


Follow this instruction to pause an ongoing process.

Preparations and conditions

• This is only possible in sub process full ballast or full deballast. This is indicated by the lit
Pause button.
• Allowed in sub process full stripping if activated in parameter (p170). After defined time, the
paused process is stopped.
• Allowed length of a pause is parameter set (p138). After defined time, the paused process
is stopped.
Follow the steps below:

1. Press the function button Pause.

2. Wait for the message “Stop ballast water pump”. Stop the pump and then press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: Ongoing process is paused. The UV lamps remains on at reduced power and cooling
water is run through the UV reactor to cool the lamps. Pause mode is indicated by yellow light
under the Pause button and blinking yellow under the function button Ballast, Deballast or
Strip.

3. To resume the process. Press the Ballast or Deballast button.


Result: PureBallast goes to Ballast or Deballast mode.

4. Press the Ballast, Deballast or Strip button to resume the process.

5. Wait for the message “Confirm ballast pump started”. Start the pump and press the button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! This component is outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: The process is resumed.

4.6 Heel (internal transfer)


Follow this instruction to pause an ongoing ballast or deballast process to enable heeling (internal
transfer).

Preparations and conditions

• This requires that a signal for heeling mode is integrated between PureBallast and the vessel’s
ISCS.
• This is only possible in sub process standby, full ballast and full deballast.
• Allowed length of heeling is parameter set (p138). After defined time, the system is stopped.
Follow the steps below:

1. Activate heeling from ISCS, which means that a heeling signal is sent to PureBallast.

64 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.8 CIP clean UV reactor after ballast
/ deballast / stripping

2. In PureBallast: Wait for the message “Stop ballast water pump”. Note! This component is
outside the PureBallast system control. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback
is integrated with the control system.)
Note: If you you need the ballast pump for heeling, confirm the request without stopping the
ballast water pump.
Result: System goes to heeling mode (ongoing process is paused). The UV lamps remains
on at reduced power and cooling water is run through the UVR to avoid overheating of the
lamps. During heeling, the yellow light under the Pause button is lit and the yellow light under
the function button Ballast or Deballast is blinking.

3. To resume the paused process. Deactivate the heeling from ISCS.


Result: PureBallast goes to Pause mode.

4. Press the Ballast or Deballast button to resume the process.

5. Wait for the message “Confirm ballast pump started”. Start the pump and press the button in
the popup to confirm the action. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is
integrated with the control system.)
Result: The process is resumed.

4.7 Backf ush f lter manually


Follow this instruction to backflush rinse the filter manually.

Preparations and conditions

• The system must be in full ballast mode.


Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview.

2. Press the Filter in the flow chart.


Result: The Filter popup is displayed.

3. Press the Start backf ush button.


Result: A backflush is performed. The default backflush process time is 20 seconds.

4.8 CIP clean UV reactor after ballast / deballast /


stripping
Follow this instruction to clean the UV reactor(s) using the cleaning in place (CIP) process.

If system shut down is activated during the CIP process, the CIP liquid is drained to the CIP tank.
Water in the UV reactors is drained overboard.

Preparations and conditions

• The system must be in standby mode. This means that this operation cannot be executed
during ballast or deballast.

Book No.9028188 02 65
4.9 Attend to alarms 4 Operating instructions

• We recommend that a CIP process is performed within the same ecological zone or in
international waters (200 nautical miles from the base line). This will avoid untreated water from
the UVR and the filter to enter a different ecological zone.
• Complete status information regarding CIP is displayed in page 1.4 CIP status. The page
displays remaining time for ongoing CIP cycles, remaining time before individual UV reactors
are required to be CIP:ed etc.
• If a ballast operation has been performed since the last CIP process, the process is completed
with a filter preservation, where the filter is filled up with fresh water.
Follow the steps below:

1. Press the function button CIP.

2. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
Result: The CIP process starts. The CIP process takes about 25 minutes , if default
parameters are used.
Note: If CIP process is started after a process the CIP process will start after 2 minutes, when
the UV lamps have been cooled.

3. Wait for the message “Close valves ...”. Close relevant valves and then press button in the
popup to confirm the action. Note! These valves are outside the PureBallast system control.
(The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)

4.9 Attend to alarms


Follow this instruction to attend to alarms and warnings. For descriptions of alarms and trouble
shooting, see chapter 5. Alarms and faultfinding.

An alarm or warning is indicated by a audible signal and that the icon on the alarm list tab is blinking:

3 Alarm

Preparations and conditions

• Alarms will shut down ongoing process and disable start of process.
• Warnings are information to the operator and will not shut down ongoing or disable start
of process.
• An alarm or warning will activate the alarm buzzer (sound and light) on the cabinet. The sound
is silenzed by touching the buzzer, but note that the alarm is not acknowledged by this.

66 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.9 Attend to alarms

NG
WARNI
!
• Never reset an alarm without first finding and attending to the problem.
• Requires login level Operator or higher.
• For color indication of alarms. See page 32.
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 2.1 Alarm list to view active alarms.

• If the alarm has caused the system to automatically stop, go to step 2.


• If the alarm allows the ballast process to continue, go to step 3.
2. If the process have stopped: Take action to eliminate what has caused the alarm.

3. If the process continues: Consider if the process shall be terminated. Take action to eliminate
what has caused the alarm.

4. After the problem has been dealt with Press the Ack all button to acknowledge all alarms, or
press the alarm row and press Ack selected button to acknowledge only this alarm.
Result: The alarm will change color to indicate change of status. See section Page 2.1 Alarm
list in this chapter. The acknowledge time is updated, and the Normal time will be updated
when the problem is resolved.

Book No.9028188 02 67
4.10 Shut down and deactivate system 4 Operating instructions

4.10 Shut down and deactivate system


Follow this instruction to quickly stop any ongoing operation in the PureBallast system, for example,
when a critical fault has been detected, or to make the system deactivated (currentless).

PureBallast will shut down if the system loose power (intentionally or unintentionally) or if an alarm
is issued. Alarm has alarm ID beginning with an “A”.

Events at shutdown:

• Any ongoing process will stop.


• Valves will return to closed position. Valves are opened at high signal from the control system,
and when this signal is lost, the valves are closed pneumatically.
• The following signals to ISCS are lost, which means that PureBallast no longer require
overboard valve open, ballast pump running and request for dedicated power if power
management (optional) is used.
• An evnt is written to the eventlog.
Control cabinet Lamp drive cabinet

3 Emergency stop 3 Emergency stop LDC

Follow the steps below:

One of the following methods can be used to abort any ongoing operation and stop the system:

68 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.11 Reset system after shut down

Action Method

Stop ongoing Press the Stop button in the control panel.


process Result: Ongoing process is stopped in a controlled way. Valves are
returned to starting position.

3StopButtonBlue

System stop Press the Stop button (2) on the control cabinet door.
Result: Ongoing process is stopped and valves are returned to starting
position as fast as possible. Note: The power is still on.

System stop If an external system stop button has been installed and integrated, it
(External button) will function as the system stop above.

Deactivate Complete deactivation is performed in two steps:


PureBallast to
make it completely 1. Turn off the main breaker (1) at the side of the control cabinet.
deactivated
2. Turn off the main breaker (A) on the LDC door.
(currentless).
The system is then currentless on the PureBallast side of the breaker
(Q1 in control cabinet and Q1 in the LDC.

To make the complete system currentless, power to PureBallast must


be switched off using the ship’s switch board.

Note: Both breakers can be locked in off position using a padlock.

4.11 Reset system after shut down


Follow this instruction to reset the system if deactivated. Numbers refer to the illustration under
instruction Shut down and deactivate system on page 68.

The system may only be reset after the reason for shut down is known. If the reason is not known,
follow the instruction Attend to alarms.

Depending on how the system was shut down:

Manual on control cabinet: Turn the main breaker (1) and acknowledge the alarm in the control
system. Release the button on the control cabinet.

Automatic in LDC: Follow the instruction below if a reactor has been shut down by temperature
switch TS201-60 (alarm A137) or if the cabinet or system has been shut down by a blackout or
electrical faults in the cabinet:

1. Make sure that the main breaker (A) on the LDC door is turned on.
2. Press the blue reset button (B) on the LDC door (when the reactor has cooled down or when
the power is back on).
3. Acknowledge all alarm related to the shut down in the control system.

Book No.9028188 02 69
4.12 Operate components manually 4 Operating instructions

4.12 Operate components manually


Follow this instruction to operate components manually. This shall only be done during
commissioning, advanced faultfinding or service.

Valves are recommended to be operated via the PureBallast control system. It is also possible to
open/close them manually according to instruction in chapter 7. Service manual, section Operate
valves manually.

The following components can be operated manually:

• Filter motor (M709-43)


• CIP pump for CIP liquid (P320-1)
• CIP pump for draining (P321-5)
• LDC cooling water pump (401–1), if installed
• UVR cooling water pump (403–1), if installed
• UV lamps in the UV reactor
• UV lamp effect.
Preparations and conditions

• This operation requires login level Advanced operator or higher.


• It is not possible to run any processes in manual mode. Only individual components can be
operated.
• When operating valves, the positioning screw on the valve must be in position 0: Closed
(default position).
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview or 1.4 CIP status.

2. Press the button Manual function button.


Result: The control system is set in manual mode.

3. Press desired component.


Result: A popup is opened. Current status is indicated. If an existing alarm exist, it is indicated
with an alarm icon. If the UV reactor or filter was pressed, a popup is opened with sub
components. If the CIP was pressed, page 1.4 CIP status is opened.

70 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.13 Operate UV lamps manually

3 PopValve

Example popup for a valve.

4. Press (not slide) the Hand button icon to enable manual operation of the component.
Result: The open and closed buttons turn blue for operation. A hand icon is also displayed on
the component in the popup and the flow chart to indicate that it is manually operated.

5. Operate the component using the open/run (left) and closed/not running (right) buttons in
the popup.

6. Press Hand button to stop manual mode for the component and the X button to close the popup.
or
Press the X button to close the popup and let the component remain in manually set status.
The popup is closed, and a hand icon is displayed by the component to indicate it is manually
operated.

7. Press the Manual function button to exit manual mode.


Result: All manually operated components are restored to their previous status.

4.13 Operate UV lamps manually


Follow this instruction to start and stop individual UV lamps in an UV reactor and to dim the UV
lamps. This can, for example, be done to check that a changed lamp functions OK.

Preparations and conditions

• This operation requires login level Advanced operator or higher.


• The control system must be in manual mode.

NGE R
! DA
• Manual start of the UV lamps is only allowed (and possible) when there is water in the UV
reactor (indicated by level switch LS201-29), and the water temperature is below 60 °C. All
necessary items – cooling water flow, water temperature, and power management – must be
supervised and verified by the authorized trained personnel operating the system. Inappropriate
operation of this function could seriously damage the equipment and injure personnel.

Book No.9028188 02 71
4.14 Set ship specific component ID 4 Operating instructions

Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview. Press the Manual function button to activate manual mode.

2. Press the UVR image.


Result: The UVRpopup opens. (See description on page 51.)

3. Select which UV reactor to operate in the UVR number entry field.

4. Open, in stated order, the following valves to fill the UV reactor with water: 201-19, 404-36
and 403-35.
Result: The UV reactor is now filled with water through the cooling water line 403.

5. Wait until the UV reactor is filled with water, indicated by the level switch (LS201–29) turning
green.

6. Press the LPS control button.


Result: The LPS control popup is displayed for selected UV reactor.

7. Press the Manual mode button to enable manual operation of the UV lamps.

8. Operate lamps by pressing one of the following buttons:


Start all LPS units.
Stop all LPS units.
LPS1-16: Start / stop individual lamps. Each lamp power supply (LPS) powers to
corresponding UV lamp. The buttons toggles between started and stopped. Place the UVR
and the LPS control popups side to side to see that the lams are started.
UV lamp stauts: Grey = Stopped; Green = Started; Yellow = Starting.

9. If desired, the UV lamps can be dimmed manually: Press the LPS status button in the UV
reactor popup. Press the Manual output filed, and enter desired percentage between 50
and 100 %. The LPS will give the entered percentage of full effect to the UV lamps. This is
indicated in the Power output field.

10. Press the Stop all LPS units button.


Result: Any lit UV lamps are stopped and the popup is closed.

11. Press the Close button to close the popup.

12. Press the Manual function button to exit manual mode.


Result: All manually operated components are restored to standby status.

4.14 Set ship specif c component ID


Follow this instruction to set ship specific IDs for valves and pumps. The ID will be visible in page
1.1 Overview and popups for the components.

Preparations and conditions

• If remote control panels (option) are used, enterd IDs will be displayed on all panels.
• Requires login level Advanced operator.
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview.

72 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.15 Export control system event log files

2. Press desired component.


Result: A popup is opened.

3 ShipIDComp

Example: Popup with ship specific ID. Entered ID is


displayed on the component to the left.

3. Press the input field at the bottom.

4. Use the keyboard to enter an ID. Press Enter to finish.


Result: The name is saved and visible in page 1.1 Overview and the popup. .

4.15 Export control system event log f les


Follow this instruction to copy event log files and alarm lists from the control system. The
information (copied as text files to a USB memory) is recommended to be opened in Visualog, but
can also be opened in Excel or similar tools. Visualog is a tool designed to present and analyze
the information from the PureBallast log files.

The following information can be exported:

Information to be Description
exported

Event log The event log includes all important events in the PureBallast system. The
log also include components connected via the log box. Intended to be
used mainly by service technicians.

Event log - Contains a selection of the complete event log, relevant to comply with
Certif cate the IMO regulations.

Alarms and A list of all alarms and warnings that has been issued from the control
warnings system. Intended to be used mainly by service technicians.

For specific information about logged events, see section List of logged information on page 87.

Preparations and conditions

Book No.9028188 02 73
4.15 Export control system event log files 4 Operating instructions

• Events are only copied, hence they will remain in the control system.
• The log and alarm files are stamped with the system name and serial number entered in page
4.5 Installation parameters.
• The easiest way of reading the log file is to use the program Visualog, but the file can also
be read in Exel.
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Press the Export button in page section Export log f les.


Result: A popup is displayed.

3 ExportLog

Note: The Update export button is only used when


updating softwares.

3. Wait for message: Insert USB in PLC. Insert a USB memory in USB PLC port on the cabinet
door.

4. Chose one of the following alternatives to decide time interval for the information to be copied:

• Recommended: Accept suggested default time interval in the Start and End fields. Default
start date is the oldest file in the system, and default end date is today’s date.
• Select the Specify time interval box, and enter desired interval in the Start and End fields.

74 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.17 Restore control system settings

5. Press one of the following function buttons: Events or Alarms. (The Update export is only
used when updating softwares.)
Result: The information is copied to the USB memory indicated by a green checkmark on
the button during copying.

6. Wait for the message "Export OK" to appear. If desired, export next category of events using
the function buttons.
Result: A folder named PureBallast has been saved to the USB. It contains two sub folders:
Alarm and Event. The folder corresponding to your export choices contains a CSV file.

7. Press Close and remove the USB memory

4.16 Backup control system settings


Follow this instruction to export all settings made in the control system to a backup on a USB
memory.

The following information is saved:

• Parameter settings. File: Parameters.csv.


• Operating timers for UVR, UV lamps etc. File: operatingtimers.csv.
• Settings for components in the trend curve pages. File: ValueSaved.xml and
ValueTrendLegend.xml.
• Settings for trend pages, e.g. min and max values for different components. File:
ValueTrendLegend.xml.
• Notpad.txt. Can be used to make notes for the backup.
Follow the steps below

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Insert a USB memory in USB panel port on the cabinet door.

3. Press the Backup button in page section Backup and restore.


Result: A popup is displayed and the process is started. Read the final line of list before
closing the popup: Important information might be displayed.

4. Wait for the OK / Close button to turn blue again. If the backup was successful, the last line
shall state "Backup done".
Result: A folder named PureBallast backup has been saved containing the backup files.

5. Remove the USB memory.

4.17 Restore control system settings


Follow this instruction to restore all control system settings, previously saved to a USB memory.
This includes parameters and settings for the trend pages 3.1 — 3.5.

Preparations and conditions

Book No.9028188 02 75
4.18 Set control panel IP address 4 Operating instructions

• This operation requires login level Advanced operator or higher.


• A USB memory with backup files. When the files where backuped, the backup files where
saved in a folder named “PureBallast Backup”. For information about backup files, see section
“Backup and restore” in the page description for 4.1 System info, section on page 39.
• This method shall not be used to restore parameter settings after software update.
• If you do not wish to update a certain type of setting, remove the specific file from the USB
memory before inserting the USB memory in the USB panel port on the cabinet door.
• Remove the file Parameters.csv from the USB before following this instruction.
Follow the steps below

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Insert a USB memory in USB panel port on the cabinet door.

3. Press the Restore button in page section Backup and restore, Settings to/from HMI USB.
Result: A popup is displayed and the process is started.

4. Wait for the OK / Close button to turn blue.

5. Read the second last line in popup: If the restore was successful, it shall state "Restore done".

6. Press the OK / Close button on the popup.

7. Remove the USB memory.

8. The control panel must be rebooted. At the rear side of the control panel: Pull out the power
cable from the 24V DC port, and insert it again.

4.18 Set control panel IP address


Follow this instruction to set IP address for the main panel and the remote control panels (optional).

Preparations and conditions

• This setting shall be done for all panels installed.


• These instructions require login level AlfaLaval.
• Port LAN A must be used for the Ethernet cable at the backside of the panel.
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Press the Setup button in the IP settings box.


Result: The IP settings popup is displayed.

76 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.19 Set remote control panel communication

3. Press the IP Settings button.


Result: A popup is displayed.

3 IPaddress

4. In the Port 1 tab select the radio button Specify an IP address.

Enter the IP address according to the list below. Also check that correct setting is done for Port
2 in the Port 2 tab.

3 IPaddress

Note: Only the IP address shall be changed.

5. Press OK.

6. Reboot the panel to update communication with the new IP address. Make sure that the new
IP address is displayed on page 4.1 System info.

7. Repeat this instruction for all installed control panels, both main and remote control panels, if
installed.

8. Follow the instruction Set remote control panel communication to activate remote control panel.

4.19 Set remote control panel communication


Follow this instruction to connect remote control panels (optional) to the PLC.

Preparations and conditions

• These instructions require login level AlfaLaval.


• The same setting shall be done for all panels installed.

Book No.9028188 02 77
4.19 Set remote control panel communication 4 Operating instructions

• IP addresses must have been set according to instruction Set control panel IP address.
• Main control panel and remote control panel 1 (192.168.0.11) are added as default . If no
remote control panelse is used, address 192.168.0.11 shall be removed.
• All remote control panels must be on and connected with an Ethernet cable.
Follow the steps below:

1. On the main panel in the control cabinet: Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. In the Remote control panels box, press the Set button.


Result: A popup is displayed.

3 RCP communication

3. Select an available remote control panel in the left hand side.

4. Press the >> button.


Result: The panel is connected and moved to the right hand side.
Note: Server port shall always be “1001”.

5. Press the Panel alias field for the new control panel. Use the keyboard to enter a name, for
example the location it is placed.
Note: Panel alias for all control panels shall be entered (with the same wording) in all panels
to be displayed in a correct way.

6. Press the save (USB symbol) button.


Result: The information is saved and the popup is closed.

7. Repeat step 4–7 to connect more remote control panels.

8. Repeat this entire instruction for all installed panels.

78 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.21 Test remote interface communication

Delete a remote control panel

If remote control panels are not used, any added control panels shall be deleted from the list.

To delete a connected panel: Select it a panel in the hand side and press the delete (X) button. If a
keyboard is displayed, pres Esc to remove it.

4.20 Set remote interface communication


Follow this instruction to make settings for the remote interface (optional) communication between
the ISCS and PureBallast.

Preparations and conditions

• These instructions require login level AlfaLaval.


Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 5.7 Remote interface.

2. Set parameters to match ISCS’s RTU server data according to the information in chapter 4.
Parameters, section 5.7 – Remote interface.

4.21 Test remote interface communication


Follow this instruction to test that the remote interface (optional) communication between
PureBallast’s PLC and the ISCS is correct and functioning.

Test communication

The first test is to see that the two systems communicate.

1. Go to page 4.5 Remote interface 1. Make sure that the system is not in test mode (no
checkmark on the button). If not, press the Test mode button to deactivate it. Make sure that
Local operation is activated. If not, press the Local function button.

2. Check that the heartbeat signal is updated in both systems (06 and 77). Also check that values
are read from the PureBallast system, for example temperature (address 116 and 117).
This will confirm that the systems communicate.

Test values sent from PureBallast to ISCS

Values are entered and displayed in the control system as actual values, but are sent to ISCS using
the binary numeral system. This information is found in group Data to ISCS and Cmd/status to
ISCS on page 4.5 Remote interface 1, and is indicated by a unit (m3, hour, second, kW etc).

Addresses with special conditions

The following addresses does not display correct values in page 4.5:

• 50 Process volume

Book No.9028188 02 79
4.21 Test remote interface communication 4 Operating instructions

• 114/124/134 UV reactor temperature for UV reactor 1, 2 and 3


• 115/125/135 LDC water temperature for UV reactor 1, 2 and 3
• 52 System pressure
• 63 Filter differential pressure
• 64 Filter inlet pressure V201–71 (Hydac filter)
• 65 Filter outlet pressure V201–72 (Hydac filter)
• 66 V201-8 setpoint
• 57058. Current time
For detailed information, see the directory of addresses.

Follow the steps below:

1. Press the Remote function button.


Result: Test mode is activated enabling that communication is sent between the systems
without actually affecting the control system (start processes etc). This also result in alarm A93
Heartbeat signal missing. This alarm shall be ignored during this test.

2. Enter actual values in the in the input field for the address to send simulated information to
the ISCS. Information in decimal form, for example processed volume, is written as actual
values. Information in binary form, for example command status, is written as a bit pattern.
The key for the bit pattern is found in chapter 6. Installation description and drawings, section
System interfaces.

3. Make sure that values and status information is displayed correspondingly in the ISCS.

4. Repeat the simulation for the information you which to test.


Note: Only implemented signals needs to be tested.

Test commands from ISCS to PureBallast

In the ISCS, activate input commands corresponding to the addresses displayed in page 4.5. (Note
that address 06 does not need to be tested; it was tested at the beginning of this procedure.)

1. Activate a command from ISCS, according to the HMI implementation.

2. Make sure that the command is received in page 4.5. Use the directory of addresses to see
that the bit pattern is updated correctly.

3. In the control panel, restore all changed values after the communication test. If not, commands
might be executed involuntarily, when the system is set to online again. Most important is that
address 001 displays ”00000000”.

Test alarms and warnings

Alarms and warnings are tested by simulation in control page 4.5 Remote interface 1 and 4.6
Remote interface 2. Use the alarm list to identify addresses and bit patterns for the alarms.

You want to simulate alarm W40 (Process pressure too low). When you find W40 in the table, you
use the column heading to see which address the alarm shall be sent to and the row heading to
see which bit in the bit pattern that shall be high. For W40 the signal shall be sent to address
902, and bit 12 shall be high.

80 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.22 Simulate power request

Translate the bit to a bit pattern: Bit 12 is the 13th digit from the right (the first digit from
right is counted as zero, second digit counted as 1 etc). This gives the following bit pattern:
0010000000000000.

UV reactor alarms/warnings: Each installed UV reactor has a unique address:

• UV reactor 1/ LDC 1: Address 910 – 912


• UV reactor 2 / LDC 2: Address 913 – 915
• UV reactor 3 / LDC 3: Address 916 – 918
Follow the steps below:

1. Enter the desired bit pattern in the input field for the address.

2. Make sure that the alarm/warning is indicated in ISCS.

3. If common alarm and warnings are used, make sure that address 70:7 and 70:8 are updated.
It is only necessary to check this for the first alarm.

4. Clear the bit pattern in the input field.

5. Repeat the simulation for those alarms/warnings you which to test.

6. Press the Test mode button to set the system in online mode (no check mark on the button).
Press the Remote function button if you want to activate remote control.

4.22 Simulate power request


Follow this instruction to test the power management signals if PureBallast is integrated with the
vessel’s power management system. This instruction can also be used in manual mode during
faultfinding.

Preparations and conditions

• This instruction requires login level Advanced operator or higher.


Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 1.4 Power request. Press the Manual function button.


Result: The control system is set in manual mode, indicated by a green checkmark on the
button.

2. Press the hand button in the Request column for a row with power step for desired number of
UV reactors. For details, see description of page 1.4 – Power request.

3. Press the Request button for the row to simulate power request signal.
Result: Status is updated to “Requested” in the Request column.

4. Wait until the status is updated to “Yes” in the Granted column.

5. Press the hand button in the Status column.

6. Press the Set run button to simulate running signal.


Result: Status is updated to “Running” in the Status column.

Book No.9028188 02 81
4.25 Calibrate the control panel’s touch screen 4 Operating instructions
sensibility

7. Press the Set run button to deactivate the simulate running signal.

8. Press the Manual function button to exit manual mode.

4.23 Set default parameters


Follow this instruction to set or reset all parameters in the control system to the factory set default
values.

Preparations and conditions

• This operation requires login level Advanced operator or higher.


Follow the steps below

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Press the Default parameters button in page section Parameters.


Result: A popup is displayed.

3. Press Yes in the popup.


Result: All parameters are reset.

4.24 Update control system softwares


Control system softwares must be updated according the Release note for the specific version of
the softwares. The release note contains instructions for updating the softwares and information
about new features, changes in the software etc.

Preparations and conditions

The following is needed:

• A flash card with correct version of the PLC software.


• A USB memory with HMI software. Note that the same version must be used for the HMI
and PLC software (same version number).
• A USB memory with the T15BR firmware.
4.25 Calibrate the control panel’s touch screen
sensibility
Follow this instruction to improve the touch precision on the screen, if it is hard to hit buttons and
icons with precision.

Follow the steps below

1. Pull out the power cable from the 24V DC port on the rear side of the control panel. And
then reconnect the power cable.
For remote control panels: Use the Power button to turn off, and then turn on the power.

82 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.26 Fine tune flow control

2. Wait for a sandglass to appear and disappear. When it appears again, press a finger on the
screen and hold it there for approximately 20 seconds.
Note: Keep holding the finger on the screen even when the panel turns white with a red
message “Welcome to ...”.

3. Wait for the screen to turn completely white with a message “Tap anywhere on the screen
within 10 seconds”. Release the finger and tap once on the screen.

4. Follow the instructions on the screen.

4.26 Fine tune f ow control


Calibration of flow and presure regulation is performed to fine tune the system so it runs with a
steady and even flow and pressure.

4.26.1 Calibrate pressure controlled regulation


During ballast and deballast operation, the control valve is PID regulated based on input from the
flow transmitter FIT201-1 to maintain stable flow. Desired flow is defined as selected certified flow
for the operation minus the Undershoot percentage set in parameter p111.

During backflush, the control valve is PID regulated based on input from the pressure transmitter
PT201-16 to maintain stable pressure for efficient backflush. Desired pressure is defined in
parameter p304.

The purpose is to adjust the movement of V201-8 when it changes from flow controlled regulation to
pressure controlled regulation which it does during backflushing of the filter. The first goal is that
the valve travels as fast as possible to a steady position where it creates required pressure (as
defined in parameter p304).

The second goal is to shorten the time from backflush trigger to start of actual backflush. This is
done by shortening the time in p310 (Backflush initial delay) that is done after the movement of
V201-8 has been calibrated.

Preparations and conditions

• This operation requires login level AlfaLaval.


• All components on page 3.1 Trend (15 min) shall be selected for plotting, and FIT201-1 shall be
used for Y axis selection.
Follow the steps below:

This instruction shall be read together with the example after the instruction.

1. Perform a backflush.
2. Open page 3.1 Trend (15 min) and analyze the trend curve for V201-8.
Before the backflush, the valve shall move as fast as possible to a steady position where it
creates required pressure. If not, parameter p166 shall be adjusted.
3. Adjust parameters, and perform a new backflush.
4. See if the curve has improved. Repeat until satisfactory result has been achieved.

Book No.9028188 02 83
4.26 Fine tune flow control 4 Operating instructions

5. See if the time between backflush initiation and backflush can be shortened . If possible, adjust
parameter p310. See parameter p310 in the example below.
Example

In this example, five backflushes are performed. After the first four backflushes, the PID parameters
where changed for pressure regulation to adjust the movement of the control valve V201-8 before
the backflush.

The illustration is taken from page 3.1 Trend (15 min). Backflush is indicated by the movement
of the backflush valve 309-1 (pink line) and the movement of control valve V201-8 is indicated
by the blue line.

1st backflush Parameter p166 is set to 0.30. But it takes too long time for V201-8 to get into
position to create desired pressure (1). The curve slops downwards in a long bend,
which means that it takes time for V201-8 to find correct position.
2nd backflush Parameter p166 was adjusted to 0.6. This made the valve movement much faster
in the beginning, shown by the steep curve at the beginning. But then a more
slow regulation starts, shown by the soft slope (2). This was a change for the
better, but not enough.
3rd backflush Parameter p166 was increased to 1.2 which resulted in a satisfactory valve
movement (3): A fast movement, followed by a minor adjustment. A small
overcompensation can be noted (curve goes too low), that might be adjusted by
decreasing the value to 1.1.
4th backflush During the first backflushes, parameter p310 was set to 60 seconds. The parameter
defines time between a backflush is triggered and it actually starts. But now, when
V201-8 is calibrated, this time can be shortened. Before the fourth backflush
parameter p310 is set to 15 seconds. The shortened time span is indicated by
the braces in the illustration.
5th backflush No parameter was changed. This backflush is only showed to confirm that the
parameter setting is OK and that the curve (5) for V201-8 is basically the same as
for backflush three and four (3 and 4).

84 Book No.9028188 02
4 Operating instructions 4.26 Fine tune flow control

3 CalibExample

4.26.2 Calibrate external feed control (optional)


External feed control allows PureBallast to control the flow delivered from the vessel’s ballast water
system by regulating either the ballast water pump via a variable frequency driver (VFD) or a
valve installed before PureBallast.

If this optional signal is used to control flow to PureBallast, the regulation can be finetuned to
function as smooth as possible.

Preparations and conditions

• This operation requires login level AlfaLaval.


Follow the steps below:

This instruction shall be read together with the example after the instruction.

1. Start a ballast process. Wait untill the system is in mode Full ballast. Listen for cavitation
noises at V201-8.
If cavitation, go to step 2. It not, go to step 5.
2. Go to page 5.2 main parameters 2.
3. Increase parameter p157 in steps of 5 % at a time. After each change, wait until the parameter
change take effect (a couple of minutes). Listen for cavitation noises at V201-8. Note: The
effect can not be observed during backflush, since the external feed function is disabled.
4. Stop raising when the noises from cavitation stops.
5. Look at the movement of V201-8. If the movement is continuously changing and the curve is
unstable, parameter p156 must be adjusted. The goal is to get a smooth regulation with long
and steady curves.

Book No.9028188 02 85
4.26 Fine tune flow control 4 Operating instructions

6. Increase parameter p156 in steps of 1 second per % at a time. After each change, wait until the
parameter change take effect (a couple of minutes).
7. Stop when the regulation curve flattens out and the trend curve is long and smooth. See
exemple below.
8. Stop the process.
9. Start another ballast operation. Verify settings during startup and process.
10. Perform a manual backflush. Verify settings during and after backflush.
11. Stop the process.
12. Start a deballast. Verify settings during startup and process.

Example

In this example, parameter p156 External feed change rate is adjusted to get a stable regulation.

The illustration is taken from page 3.1 Trend (15 min).

Area 1 Parameter p156 was set to 2 s / % when process was started. The curves for
V201-8 and external feed signal are chasing each other. The reason is that the
request signal changes too fast which makes V201-8 compensate, which affects
the signal in return.
Area 2 Parameter p156 is raised to 6 seconds which makes the request signal change
more slowly, which results in a smooth movement of V201-8 when regulating the
external flow.

3 CalibExampleExtFeed

86 Book No.9028188 02
5 List of logged information

Alarm history and important events are logged in the control system. The log also include
components connected via the log box (optional).

The control system store all alarms and relevant events for at least 24 months. The memory has
a vast safety margin but when it is full, data will be deleted starting with the oldest data. Logged
information can be exported to a USB memory stick. See Export control system log files on page 73.

5.1 Event log


The table below shows which information that is saved in the log file.

The GPS stamp column indicates if the event is stamped with GPS position (Y=yes, N=no). All
events relevant to the IMO certificate are GPS stamped

Event Description GPS


code stamp

70 Operator command, set certified flow to [x] m3/h N

80 Operator command, start stripping is issued N

100 Manual mode set by operator. N

110 Heeling mode set by ISCS. N

120 Heeling mode canceled by ISCS. N

150 Overboard valve opened. Feedback from ISCS. Y

155 Ballast water pump started. Feedback from ISCS. Y

160 Overboard valve closed. Feedback from ISCS. N

165 Ballast water pump stopped. Feedback from ISCS. Y

170 External shutdown issued. (System stop button on control cabinet N


or external system stop button)

190 Standby mode N

210 Ballast Start-up mode N

220 Full Ballast mode Y

230 Pause Ballast N

Book No.9028188 02 87
5.1 Event log 5 List of logged information

Event Description GPS


code stamp

240 Filter backflush mode N

250 PureBallast is in mode Stop Ballast N

260 Deballast Start-up mode N

270 Full Deballast mode Y

280 Pause Deballast mode N

290 Stop Deballast mode N

300 CIP process started, UVR [x, y, z ...] N


x, y, z ...= units that has been subjected to CIP

310 E-stop N

320 Power tuned on. PureBallast has been powered off for N
[x]days:[y]hrs:[z]min
Time of how long the power has been switched off

330 Amount (m3) of ballast intake treated Y

331 Amount (m3) of ballast intake treated. Time interval according to Y


parameter p161.

340 [X] m3 of ballast discharge treated Y

341 [X] m3 of ballast discharge treated. Time interval according to Y


parameter p162.

350 PureBallast is bypassed. Valve V212-31 open. Y

360 PureBallast bypass discontinued. Valve V212-31 closed. Y

370 Request sent to ISCS: Open overboard valve. N

380 Request sent to ISCS: Close overboard valve. N

390 Request sent to ISCS: Start ballast water pump. N

400 Request sent to ISCS: Stop ballast water pump. N

410 Power requested from ISCS. N

420 Power granted by ISCS. N

430 Power used for process. N

450 PureBallast shut down and/or start blocked due to alarm(s). Y

460 PureBallast is bypassed. Additional (external) bypass valve 1 open. Y

88 Book No.9028188 02
5 List of logged information 5.1 Event log

Event Description GPS


code stamp

470 PureBallast bypass discontinued. Additional (external) bypass Y


valve 1 closed.

480 PureBallast is bypassed. Additional (external) bypass valve 2 open. Y

490 PureBallast bypass discontinued. Additional (external) bypass Y


valve 2 closed.

500 PureBallast is bypassed. Additional (external) bypass valve 3 open. Y

510 PureBallast bypass discontinued. Additional (external) bypass Y


valve 3 closed.

515 PureBallast is bypassed. Additional (external) bypass valve opened Y


from ISCS. Valve information from ISCS:

520 Low UV intensity in UVR 1. Y

530 Low UV intensity in UVR 2. Y

540 Low UV intensity in UVR 3. Y

550 Low UV intensity in UVR 4. Y

560 Low UV intensity in UVR 5. Y

570 Low UV intensity in UVR 6. Y

640 UV intensity in UVR 1: [X] W/m2 Y

650 UV intensity in UVR 2: [X] W/m2 Y

660 UV intensity in UVR 3: [X] W/m2 Y

670 UV intensity in UVR 4: [X] W/m2 Y

680 UV intensity in UVR 5: [X] W/m2 Y

690 UV intensity in UVR 6: [X] W/m2 Y

701 UVR 1 UV lamp time reset N

711 UVR 2 UV lamp time reset N

721 UVR 3 UV lamp time reset N

731 UVR 4 UV lamp time reset N

741 UVR 5 UV lamp time reset N

751 UVR 6 UV lamp time reset N

Book No.9028188 02 89
5.1 Event log 5 List of logged information

Event Description GPS


code stamp

760 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 1: Y

770 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 2: Y

780 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 3: Y

790 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 4: Y

791 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 5: Y

792 Power setpoint (%) for UVR 6: Y

800 Flow higer than certified flow. Y

801 Flow restored to certified flow. Y

805 System started in IMO mode Y

806 System started in USCG mode Y

810 UVR 1 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

811 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 1. Y

812 UVR 2 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

813 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 2. Y

814 UVR 3 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

815 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 3. Y

816 UVR 4 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

817 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 4. Y

818 UVR 5 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

819 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 5. Y

820 UVR 6 was not CIP cleaned within required time. Y

821 CIP cleaning completed for UVR 6. Y

5010 Log box: V01 Closed position change: [value]. 1=Closed. 0=Not N
closed.

5011 Log box: V01 Open position change: [value]. 1=Open. 0=Not open. N

5020 Log box: V02 Closed position change: [value]. 1=Closed. 0=Not N
closed.

90 Book No.9028188 02
5 List of logged information 5.1 Event log

Event Description GPS


code stamp

5021 Log box: V02 Closed position change: [value]. 1=Closed. 0=Not N
closed.

etc until 5181 N

5190 Log box: Pump 01 operation change: [value]. 1=Started. N


0=Stopped.

5200 Log box: Pump 02 operation change: [value]. 1=Started. N


0=Stopped.

etc until 5220 N

Book No.9028188 02 91
5.1 Event log 5 List of logged information
6 Detailed process description

This section gives a detailed description of the PureBallast processes. The processes are divided
into three main processes, with sub processes, with indications of automatic and manually initiated
steps.

All steps are not valid for all installations.

6.1 Standby mode


Standby mode is the starting point of PureBallast. Standby mode is active at system start-up or
when no other process is active. From Standby mode, the following processes and sub processes
can be started.

• Ballast
• Deballast
• CIP
• Deactivate system
• Change flow
• Manual mode.

Book No.9028188 02 93
6.2 Ballast process 6 Detailed process description

6.2 Ballast process


The ballast process and sub processes are illustrated and described below. Note that the process
can be stopped at any time.

3 BallastProcess

6.2.1 Ballast start-up


Purpose: To warm UV lamps under controlled conditions before water treatment.

1. Operator starts the process from the control system.

2. Request from control system to open overboard (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)

3. Overboard valve opened by operator and confirmed in control system. (Handled automatic, if
external component signal is enabled.)
Component activities:

• - Start P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


- Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Open V401-51 (LDC cooling water inlet)
- Open V201-32 (filter outlet)
• Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used).
4. Power management
Automatic power request from PureBallast to vessel’s power management system (if
integrated).

94 Book No.9028188 02
6 Detailed process description 6.2 Ballast process

5. UV lamp warming
Component activities:

• Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)


• Open V201-19 (reactor inlet).
6. Cooling water fills the UV reactors. When filled, indicated by LS201-29:

• Start UV lamps (100 %). If all lamps are not lit within p212, process is stopped.
• Start counter: UV lamp runtime.
• Start LDC fan.
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.
7. Time p210 after all lamps are lit: Request from control system to start ballast water pump
(outside PureBallast system). (Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)

8. Ballast water pump started by operator and confirmed in control system. If not confirmed
within 20 seconds, lamp power is reduced to 50 %. If not confirmed within p141 (including the
20 seconds), process is stopped.

9. Open V201-3 (filter inlet).

6.2.2 Full ballast


Purpose: To treat ballast water.

1. Component activities:

• - Open V201-20 (reactor outlet)


- Start counter: Accumulated water and CIP required.
- Wait for flow p116 to be established. If not established, process is stopped.
- Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)
- When flow is established: Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on
input from the flow meter.
• USCG mode: Start flow control based on input from UV sensor (QT201–50).
• IMO mode: After 2 minutes in full ballast: Start power optimization based on input from
UV sensor (QT201–50).

6.2.3 Filter backf ush


Purpose: To clean the filter. This sub process is either triggered by too high differential pressure
or by time set interval. It can also be started manually. It is normally repeated several times
during a ballast process.

Book No.9028188 02 95
6.2 Ballast process 6 Detailed process description

1. Filter backflush triggered by high differential pressure over the filter.


Component activities:

• Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the pressure transmitter
• Start backflush pump P309–1 (optional)
• After p319 seconds, open V309-1
• Start M709-43.
2. Filter backflush is performed for p308 seconds.
Component activities:

• Stop M709-43
• Close V309-1
• Stop P309–1 (optional)
• Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the flow meter.
3. Differential pressure check. If necessary, the process is repeated.

6.2.3.1 Change f ow - Increase f ow

Purpose: To decrease flow during operation.

1. Operator adjusts the certified flow from the control system.


2. Automatic power request from PureBallast to vessel’s power management system (if integrated).
3. Component activities when power has been granted. (Eventual ongoing backflush will finish
before the activities are effectuated):

• Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)


• Open V201-19 (reactor inlet).
• Start counter: CIP required for new UV reactor.
4. Component activities when added UV reactors are filled, indicated by LS201-29 and LS201-30.
During warm-up, the lamps are cooled with ballast water, sea-to-sea.

• - Start UV lamps (100 %).


- Start counter: UV lamp runtime
- Start LDC fan.
• Open V201-20 (reactor outlet)
• Close V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)
• Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the flow meter.
• After 2 minutes in full ballast: Start power optimization based on input from UV sensor
QT201–50.

6.2.3.2 Change f ow - Decrease f ow

Purpose: To decrease flow during operation.

96 Book No.9028188 02
6 Detailed process description 6.2 Ballast process

1. Operator adjusts the certified flow manually from the control system.
Component activities:

• - One or more UV reactors are switched of


• Component activities for switched of UV reactors:
– UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
– Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
– Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
– Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
– Automatic power request adjustment (if integrated).

6.2.4 Pause ballast (Heeling mode)


Purpose: To pause the ballast process temporarily. During pause, the lamps are cooled with
cooling water, sea-to-sea. This mode is also used during heeling (internal transfer).

1. Operator pause the ballast process manually. Pause can also be initiated by an external signal,
for example when heeling is initiated from the ISCS. In this case, the process is resumed
automatically when the heeling signal is deactivated.
2. Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter (p113) set opening percent.
3. Request from control system to stop ballast water pump (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
4. BW pump stopped by operator and confirmed in control system. Component activities:

• - Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors


- Stop counter: Accumulated water
- Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
• Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
- Close V201-3 (filter inlet)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors
- UV lamps dimmed to 50 %
• Close V201-8 (control valve).
5. System in pause mode

6.
Resume ballasting
Operator resumes the ballast process manually.
Component activities:

• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.


• UV lamps are lit at 100 %
• Open V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors.
7. Request from control system to start ballast water pump” (outside PureBallast system).
(Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
8. BW pump started by operator and confirmed in control system. (Handled automatic, if external
component signal is enabled.)

• Open 201-3 (filter inlet)

Book No.9028188 02 97
6.3 Deballast process 6 Detailed process description

9. Component activities when minimum process flow established, indicated by FIT201-1:

• - Start counter: Accumulated water.


- Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors
- Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the flow meter.
- After 2 minutes in full ballast: Start power optimization based on input from UV sensor
QT201–50.

6.2.5 Stop ballast


Purpose: To stop the ballast process.

1. Operator stops the ballast process manually.


Component activities:

• Stop P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


• Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Close V403-35 (cooling water inlet), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Run backflush process. (See section Filter backflush in Ballast process. )
• Close V401–51 LDC (LDC cooling water inlet)
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter set opening percent
• Close V201-3 (main inlet valve) Wait for feed back “closed” or max time 15 seconds.
• UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
• Start counter UV lamp cooling time. A new process can only be started after UV lamps have
been cooled down for 5 minutes.
• Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
• - Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
2. Request from control system stop ballast water pump (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. BW pump stopped by operator and confirmed in control system.

• Automatic withdrawal of power allocation (if integrated)


• Close V201-32
• Close V201-8
• Stop counter: Accumulated water.
4. Request from control system to close overboard. (Handled automatic, if external component
signal is enabled.)
5. Popup reminder “Start CIP”. Option to start CIP or delay.
6.3 Deballast process
The deballast process and sub processes are illustrated and described below. Note that the
process can be stopped at any time.

98 Book No.9028188 02
6 Detailed process description 6.3 Deballast process

3 DeBallastProcess

6.3.1 Deballast start-up


Purpose: To warm UV lamps under controlled conditions before water treatment.

1. Operator start the deballast process manually.


2. Request from control system to open overboard valve (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. Overboard valve opened by operator and confirmed in control system.
Component activities:

• - Start P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


- Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Open V401-51 (LDC cooling water inlet)
• Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used).
4. Power management
Automatic power request from PureBallast to vessel’s power management system (if integrated).
5. UV lamp warming
Component activities when power has been granted:

• Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)


• Open V201-19 (reactor inlet).
6. Water fills the UV reactors.

Book No.9028188 02 99
6.3 Deballast process 6 Detailed process description

7. Component activities, when UV reactors are filled, indicated by LS201-29:

• Start UV lamps (100 %). If all lamps are not lit within p212, process is stopped.
• Start counter: UV lamp runtime.
• Start LDC fan.
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.
8. Time p210 after all lamps are lit: Request from control system to start ballast water pump
(outside PureBallast system). (Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
9. BW pump started by operator and confirmed in control system. If not confirmed within 20
seconds, lamp power is reduced to 50 %. If not confirmed within p141 (including the 20
seconds), process is stopped.
Component activities:

• Open V201-9 (main inlet valve).

6.3.2 Full deballast


Purpose: To treat deballast water.

1. Component activities when minimum process flow established, indicated by FIT201-1:

• - Open V201-20 (reactor outlet)


- Start counter: Accumulated water and CIP required.
- Wait for flow p116 to be established. If not established, process is stopped.
- Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors
- When flow is established: Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on
input from the flow meter.
• USCG mode: Start flow control based on input from UV sensor (QT201–50).
• IMO mode: After 2 minutes in full ballast: Start power optimization based on input from
UV sensor (QT201–50).

6.3.2.1 Change f ow - Decrease f ow

Purpose: To decrease flow during operation.

1. Operator adjusts the certified flow manually from the control system.
2. Component activities:

• Automatic pressure and flow adjustment (8)


• One or more UV reactors are switched of
• Component activities for switched of UV reactors:
– UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
– Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
– Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
– Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
– Automatic power request adjustment (if integrated).

100 Book No.9028188 02


6 Detailed process description 6.3 Deballast process

6.3.3 Pause deballast (Heeling)


Purpose: To pause the deballast process temporarily. During pause, the lamps are cooled with
cooling water, sea-to-sea. This mode is also used during heeling (internal transfer).

1. Operator pause the deballast process manually. Pause can also be initiated by an external
signal, for example when heeling is initiated from the ISCS. In this case, the process is resumed
automatically when the heeling signal is deactivated.
Component activities:

• Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter set opening percent


• Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
• - Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
- Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors.
2. Request from control system to stop ballast water pump (outside the PureBallast system
control). (Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
Component activities:

• - Stop counter: Accumulated water


- Close V201-9 (main inlet valve)
- Close V201-8 (control valve)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors
- UV lamps dimmed to 50 %.
3. System in pause mode

4. Resume deballasting
Operator resume the deballast process manually.
Component activities:

• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.


• UV lamps are lit at 100 %
• Open V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors.

5. Request from control system to start ballast water pump” (outside PureBallast system).
(Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
6. BW pump started by operator and confirmed in control system.
Component activities:

• Open V201-9 (main inlet valve)


7. Component activities when minimum process flow established, indicated by FIT201-1:

• - Start counter: Accumulated water.


Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close 404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)
- Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the flow meter.
- After 2 minutes in full deballast: Start power optimization based on input from UV sensor
QT201–50.

Book No.9028188 02 101


6.4 Stripping process 6 Detailed process description

6.3.4 Stop deballast


Purpose: To stop the deballast process.

1. Operator stops the ballast process manually.


Component activities:

• Stop P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


• Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Close V403-35 (cooling water inlet), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Close V401–51 LDC (LDC cooling water inlet)
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter set opening percent
• Close V201-9 (main inlet valve) Wait for feed back “closed” or max time 15 seconds.
• UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
• Start counter UV lamp cooling time. A new process can only be started after UV lamps have
been cooled down for 5 minutes.
• Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
• - Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
2. Request from control system stop ballast water pump (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. BW pump stopped by operator and confirmed in control system.

• Automatic withdrawal of power allocation (if integrated)


• Close V201-8
• Stop counter: Accumulated water.
4. Request from control system to close overboard. (Handled automatic, if external component
signal is enabled.)
5. Popup reminder “Start CIP”. Option to start CIP or delay.
6.4 Stripping process
The stripping process and sub processes are illustrated and described below. Number of UV
reactors used during stripping is defined in p171. Pump used can either be a dedicated stripping
pump or the ballast water pump. Note that the process can be stopped at any time.

102 Book No.9028188 02


6 Detailed process description 6.4 Stripping process

3 StrippingProcess

6.4.1 Stripping start-up


Purpose: To warm UV lamps under controlled conditions before water treatment.

1. Operator start the stripping process manually.


2. Request from control system to open overboard valve (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. Overboard valve opened by operator and confirmed in control system.
Component activities:

• - Start P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


- Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Open V401-51 (LDC cooling water inlet)
• Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used).
4. Power management
Automatic power request from PureBallast to vessel’s power management system (if integrated).

Book No.9028188 02 103


6.4 Stripping process 6 Detailed process description

5. UV lamp warming
Component activities when power has been granted:

• Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water)


• Open V201-19 (reactor inlet).
6. Water fills the UV reactors.
7. Component activities, when UV reactors are filled, indicated by LS201-29:

• Start UV lamps (100 %). If all lamps are not lit within p212, process is stopped.
• Start counter: UV lamp runtime.
• Start LDC fan.
• Open V201-20 (reactor outlet)
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.
8. Time p210 after all lamps are lit: Request from control system to start stripping pump (outside
PureBallast system). (Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
9. Stripping pump started by operator and confirmed in control system. If not confirmed within
20 seconds, lamp power is reduced to 50 %. If not confirmed within p141 (including the
20 seconds), process is stopped.
Component activities:

• Open V201-9 (main inlet valve).

6.4.2 Full stripping


Purpose: To treat stripping water.

1. Component activities when minimum process flow established (p172), indicated by FIT201-1:

• - Start counter: Accumulated water and CIP required.


- Wait for flow p116 to be established. If not established, process is stopped.
- Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors
- When flow is established: Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on
input from the flow meter.

6.4.2.1 Change f ow - Decrease f ow

Purpose: To decrease flow during operation.

1. Operator adjusts the certified flow manually from the control system.

104 Book No.9028188 02


6 Detailed process description 6.4 Stripping process

2. Component activities:

• Automatic pressure and flow adjustment.


• One or more UV reactors are switched of
• Component activities for switched of UV reactors:
– UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
– Start counter UV lamp cooling time. A new process can only be started after UV lamps
have been cooled down for 5 minutes.
– Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
– Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
– Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
– Automatic power request adjustment (if integrated).

6.4.3 Pause stripping


Purpose: To pause the stripping process temporarily. During pause, the lamps are cooled with
cooling water, sea-to-sea.

1. Operator pause the stripping process manually.


Component activities:

• Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter set opening percent


• Open V403-35 (cooling water inlet)
• Close V401–51 LDC (LDC cooling water inlet)
• - Start P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
- Open V404-36 (UV reactor outlet, cooling water) on running UV reactors.
2. Request from control system to stop stripping pump (outside the PureBallast system control).
(Handled automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
Component activities:

• - Stop counter: Accumulated water


- Close V201-9 (main inlet valve)
- Close V201-8 (control valve)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors
- UV lamps dimmed to 50 %.
3. System in pause mode

4. Resume stripping
Operator resume the stripping process manually.
Component activities:

• Set V201-8 (control valve) to 50 %.


• UV lamps are lit at 100 %
• Open V201-20 (reactor outlet) on running UV reactors.

5. Request from control system to start stripping pump” (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)

Book No.9028188 02 105


6.4 Stripping process 6 Detailed process description

6. Stripping pump started by operator and confirmed in control system.


Component activities:

• Open V201-9 (main inlet valve)


7. Component activities when minimum process flow established, indicated by FIT201-1:

• - Start counter: Accumulated water.


Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used)
• - Close 403-35 (cooling water inlet)
- Close 404-36 (UVR reactor outlet, cooling water)
- Start automatic control of control valve (V201-8) based on input from the flow meter.
- After 2 minutes in full stripping: Start power optimization based on input from UV sensor
QT201–50.

6.4.4 Stop stripping


Purpose: To stop the stripping process.

1. Operator stops the stripping process manually.


Component activities:

• Stop P401-1 (LDC cooling water pump) (if used)


• Stop P403-1 (UVR cooling water pump) (if used), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Close V403-35 (cooling water inlet), only needed if stop from pause mode
• Close V401–51 LDC (LDC cooling water inlet)
• Set V201-8 (control valve) to parameter set opening percent
• Close V201-9 (main inlet valve) Wait for feed back “closed” or max time 15 seconds.
• UV lamps are lit at 100 % for 10 seconds, then switched off.
• Stop counter: UV lamp runtime
• Start counter UV lamp cooling time. A new process can only be started after UV lamps have
been cooled down for 5 minutes.
• - Close V201-19 (reactor inlet)
- Close V201-20 (reactor outlet)
2. Request from control system stop stripping pump (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. Stripping pump stopped by operator and confirmed in control system.

• Automatic withdrawal of power allocation (if integrated)


• Close V201-8
• Stop counter: Accumulated water.
4. Request from control system to close overboard. (Handled automatic, if external component
signal is enabled.)
5. Popup reminder “Start CIP”. Option to start CIP or delay.

106 Book No.9028188 02


6 Detailed process description 6.5 CIP process

6.5 CIP process


The CIP process is run to remove seawater scaling from the UV reactor after ballast and deballast.
The process is performed for used UV reactor in sequence. The process can start directly after
ballast or deballast process, or be delayed. A CIP process is started manually according to
instruction CIP clean UVR after ballast / debalalst on page 65. Note that the process can be
stopped at any time.

3 CIPprocess

6.5.1 Start CIP


1. Operator starts the CIP process manually.
2. Request from control system to open overboard valve (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
3. Overboard valve opened by operator and confirmed in control system.
Note: If CIP process is started after a process the CIP process will start after 2 minutes, when
the UV lamps have been cooled.

Book No.9028188 02 107


6.5 CIP process 6 Detailed process description

6.5.2 Drain ballast water


1.
Component activities (in no specific order):

• - Open V460-2 (CIP, drain valve)


- Open V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)
- Open V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Start P321-5 (CIP, water pump)
2. Component activities, when UV reactors are empty, indicated by LS201-29:

• - Stop P321-5
- Close V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Close V460-2 (CIP, drain valve)
- Close V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Close V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve).

6.5.3 Fresh water f lling


1.
Component activities:

• - Open V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)


- Open V310-6 (CIP, UV reactor fresh water filling)
- Open V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve).
2. Component activities, when UV reactors are filled, indicated by LS201-29:

• - Close V310-6 (CIP, UV reactor fresh water filling)


- Close V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Close V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Close V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve).

6.5.4 Fresh water draining


1. Component activities:

• - Open V460-2 (CIP, drain valve)


- Open V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Open V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)
- Start P321-5 (CIP, water pump).
2. Component activities when UV reactor is empty, indicated by LS201-29 + drain time (p200):

• - Stop P321-5 (CIP, water pump)


- Close V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Close V460-2 (CIP, drain valve)
- Close V321–2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Close V320–4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)

108 Book No.9028188 02


6 Detailed process description 6.5 CIP process

6.5.5 CIP cleaning


1. Component activities:

• - Open V320–2 (CIP outlet to UV reactor)


- Open V320-4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)
- Open V321-2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open 321–4
- Start P320-1 (CIP, liquid pump).
2. When UV reactors are filled, indicated by LS201-29, CIP liquid is circulated for 15 minutes.
3. Component activities after finished CIP process .

• - Stop P320-1 (CIP, liquid pump)


- Close V320-2 (CIP outlet to UV reactor)
- Close V320-4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)
- Status update for the UV reactor: CIP completed.

6.5.6 CIP draining


1. Component activities:

• Open V321-4 (CIP, return valve)


Open V321–1 (CIP, outlet valve)
- Open V321-2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open V320-4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve)
- Start P321-5 (CIP, water pump).
2. Component activities, when UV reactor is empty, indicated by LS201-29 + drain time (p200):

• - Stop P321-5 (CIP, water pump)


- Close V321-2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Close V 321-4 (CIP, return valve)
- Close V321-1 (CIP, outlet valve).

6.5.7 Fresh water f lling


1.
Component activities:

• - Open V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)


- Open V310-6 (CIP, UV reactor fresh water filling)
- Open V321-2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Open V320-4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve).
2. Component activities, when UV reactor is filled, indicated by LS201-29:

• Close V310-6 (CIP, UV reactor fresh water filling)


• Close V571-1 (CIP, deaeration valve)
- Close V321-2 (UV reactor, upper CIP return valve)
- Close V320-4 (UV reactor, lower CIP return valve).

Book No.9028188 02 109


6.6 Manual mode 6 Detailed process description

6.5.8 Repeat
When CIP process is done for the first UV reactor, the remaining UV reactors with status CIP
required are processed in the same way.

6.5.9 Filter preservation


Only performed if ballast has been performed since last filter preservation.

1.
Component activities when all required UV reactors are processed:

• - Open V310-1
- Open V309-1
- Start M709-43.
2. Component activities after the filter is filled:

• - Stop M709-43
- Close V309-1
- Close V310-1.
3. Request from control system to close overboard valve (outside PureBallast system). (Handled
automatic, if external component signal is enabled.)
4. Overboard valve closed by operator and confirmed in control system.

6.6 Manual mode


PureBallast can be set in manual mode, which enables the operator to operate components
manually and to set digital outputs.

The following can be performed in manual mode:

• Operate components from control panel.


• Operate and simulate power management.
The following limitations exist for manual mode:

• Requires login level 2. The Manual mode button is only displayed for login level 2.
• Flow in pipes is not indicated in flow chart.
• Can only be activate from standby mode.
• No automatic processes can be run.

If another operator take over command by logging in on another control panel, manual mode is
deactivated, and the system returns to standby.

See instructions Operate components manually and Operate UV lamps manually.

110 Book No.9028188 02


1 Quick guide to PureBallast
operations

1.1 Introduction
This is a quick guide to the most common routines performed in the PureBallast control system.
More detailed instructions are found in the PureBallast manual.

This guide covers the following routines:

• Ballast and deballast


• CIP clean895
• Basic alarm handling
• Save log file and parameters to USB memory
Preparations and conditions

• The Alarm list (page 2.1) must be controlled to verify that there are no alarms needing attention.
• Flow must have been selected before a process can be started. If the Auto button is selected
(checkmark) maximum flow is automatically selected, and flow can only be changed during
process according to instruction Change ballast / deballast / stripping flow. If parameter the
Auto button is deselected (no checkmark) last selected flow is used. Otherwise, flow is selected
on page 1.1 Overview or 1.2 UVR and flow selection.
1.2 Ballast, deballast and stripping
Follow the steps below

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview

2. Press the Ballast, Deballast or Strip function button.


Comment: If the button is not blue, check that flow or UVR reactors have been selected.

3. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press the button in
the popup to confirm the action. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is
integrated with the control system.)

4. Wait for the message “Confirm ballast pump started”. Start the pump and then press the button
in the popup to confirm the action. (The popup is not displayed if the component feedback is
integrated with the control system.)

5. When desired amount of water has been processed, press the function button Stop to end
the process.

6. Wait for the message “Close valves ...” and “Stop ballast water pump”. Handle accordingly.
(The popups are not displayed if the component feedback is integrated with the control system.)
1.4 CIP clean UVR 1 Quick guide to PureBallast operations

7. Wait for the ”Start CIP” popup. Choose to start a CIP or wait maximum the time stated in
the popup.

CIPpop

1.3 Alarm handling


Follow this instruction to attend to alarms and to acknowledge them afterwards. For descriptions of
alarms and trouble shooting, see chapter 5. Alarms and fault finding.

An alarm is indicated by a audible signal and by a blinking warning icon in the control panel.

Preparations and conditions

• Never reset an alarm without first finding and attending to the problem.
Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 2.1 Alarm list.

2. Select an alarm by pressing the alarm row.

3. If the process have stopped: Take action to eliminate what has caused the alarm.

4. If the alarm is caused by a faulty UVR module, the ballast/deballast process has to be restarted
with another UVR according to the Perform ballast instruction.

5. If the process continues: Consider if the process shall be terminated. Take action to eliminate
what has caused the alarm.

Press the Ack selected or Ack all button after the problem has been dealt with.

1.4 CIP clean UVR


Preparations and conditions

• The system must be in standby mode. This means that this operation cannot be executed
during ballast or deballast.
• Complete status information regarding CIP is displayed in page 1.4 CIP status. The page
displays remaining time for ongoing CIP cycles, remaining time before individual UVRs are
required to be CIP:ed etc.
1 Quick guide to PureBallast operations 1.5 Export control system log files

Follow the steps below

1. Go to page 1.1 Overview.

2. Press the function button CIP.

3. Wait for the message “Open valves ...”. Open relevant valves and then press button in the
popup to confirm the action.
Result: The automatic CIP cycle starts. The CIP cycle takes about 25 minutes per UVR.

4. Wait for the message “Confirm overboard valve closed”. Close the valve and then press button
in the popup to confirm the action.

1.5 Export control system log f les


Follow this instruction to copy control system information as text files to a USB memory.

Preparations and conditions

• Required USB memory.


Follow the steps below:

1. Go to page 4.1 System info.

2. Press the Export button in page section Export log f les.


Result: Popup Export PLC events is displayed.

3. Wait for message: Insert USB in PLC. Insert a USB memory in USB PLC port on the cabinet
door.

4. Chose one of the following alternatives to decide time interval for the information to be copied:

• Accept suggested default time interval in the Start and End fields. Default start date is the
oldest file in the system, and default end date is today’s date.
• Select the Specify time interval box, and enter desired interval in the Start and End fields.
5. Press one of the following function buttons: Events, Cert events or Alarms.
Result: The information is copied to the USB memory indicated by a green checkmark on
the button during copying.

6. Wait for the message "Export OK" to appear. If desired, export next category of events using
the function buttons.
Result: A folder named PureBallast has been downloaded. It contains three sub folders:
Alarm, Cert and Event. The folder corresponding to your export choice contains a CSV file.

7. Prtess Close and remove the USB memory


Chapter: 4. Parameters
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00

Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40


This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 5

2 Control system parameters 7


2.1 Introduction to parameters and
parameter settings 7
2.2 Page 5.1 – Main parameters 1 9
2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2 12
2.4 Page 5.3 – UVR parameters 17
2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters 20
2.6 Page 5.5 – CIP parameters 24
2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters 25
2.8 Page 5.7 – Remote interface 29

3 Flow transmitter parameters 31


3.1 Check and set parameters 32

4 Lamp power supply (LPS)


parameters 37
4.1 DIP switch settings 37
4.2 Change DIP switch setting 38

5 Fuse settings for f lter motor and


installed (optional) pump motors 41

3
1 Introduction

This chapter contains information about parameters in the control system and parameter controlled
compoents. It covers:

• Parameter page descriptions.


• Parameter lists including information about setting range, default values etc.

Book No.9028188 02 5
1 Introduction
2 Control system parameters

This section describes all parameters set in the PureBallast control system.

Preparations and conditions

• Parameters shall only be set when the system is in mode Standby.


• Only authorized trained personnel must set parameters in the control system. The PureBallast
equipment or connected equipment can be irreparably damaged if set or handled incorrectly.
• The parameter settings can be exported to a USB memory for safety backup, and be restored
from a backup. See chapter 3. Operating instructions and control system description for
instructions.
Parameters are valid for PLC software version V3.1.11.
• Parameters are roughly sorted by area, for example UV reactor, filter and remote interface,
but the sorting is not strict.

2.1 Introduction to parameters and parameter settings


All parameters are checked and adjusted at first start up during commissioning.

How the parameters are explained

NOTE

• Parameters shall only be set by Alfa Laval.


• Login level 2 or 3 is required to change parameters. Login level 2 gives access to set
parameters, with exception from crucial parameters, which requires level 3.
• Parameters are divided into three categories according to tab le below:
You must consider to change this parameter.

4 Must

Do not change this parameter.

4 MustNot

No icon This parameter should noramlly be left alone. If there are specific reasones,
the parameter can be changed.
p000 Parameters in bold can only be changed by login level AlfaLaval. Parameters
in normal text can be changed by login level Advanced operator.

Follow this instruction to set parameters:

Book No.9028188 02 7
2.1 Introduction to parameters and parameter 2 Control system parameters
settings

1. Go to desired parameter page 5.1–5.7.


Result: The page is displayed with all parameters listed with current setting and unit.

2. To see allowed range (maximum and minimum values) and change setting, press the blue
button (with the parameter ID). A button pair is displayed.

4 ParaIntervalSet

Press the ≤ ≥ sign to display range. Entered parameter value must be within defined setting
range.

4 MinMax

3. To set parameter, press the 123 button.


Result: A keyboard is displayed.

4. Enter the setting and confirm by touching the Enter button. To close the keyboard without
saving data, touch the Esc button.
If the parameter is set with a drop down menu, select desired choice by touching the value.
Result: The setting is saved directly, it is now safe to leave the page.

8 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.2 Page 5.1 – Main parameters 1

2.2 Page 5.1 – Main parameters 1


This section describes the main system parameters set in page 5.1 Main parameters 1.

4 5.1 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

p100 High pressure, 7.00 1–10 bar Setpoint for shut down due to high
shutdown trigger pressure at PT201-16. Default value
(PT201-16) shall be used for standard system (7 bar
= 0.7 MPa)
4 Must

Max. working pressure for standard


system: 6 bar.

Max. working pressure for high pressure


system:
9 bar.

p101 High pressure, 6.00 0–10 bar Setpoint for warning due to high pressure
warning trigger at PT201-16. Default value shall be used
(PT201-16) for standard system.

4 Must (6 bar = 0.6 MPa)

Max. working pressure for standard


system: 6 bar.

Book No.9028188 02 9
2.2 Page 5.1 – Main parameters 1 2 Control system parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

Max. working pressure for high pressure


system:
9 bar.

p103 Low pressure, 0.1 -1–2 bar Setpoint for warning due to low pressure
warning trigger at PT201-16.
(PT201–16)
(1 bar = 0.1 MPa)

p104 Max pressure 6 6 or bar Defines range for pressure transmitter


(PT201–16) 10 PT201–16. Set according to range
printed on the transmitter:

4 Must 0 – 10 bar: Set parameter to 6.

-1 – 15 bar: Set parameter to 10.

p111 Undershoot 5 0–80 % Safety margin between defined max


certified flow flow and actual max flow to avoid
unnecessary shut down.

p113 Min % open for 20 10–100 % During ballast and deballast, valve
V201-8 V201–8 handles the automatic pressure
and flow control.

This parameter defines minimum


opening, to secure an even flow without
interruptions.

p116 Low flow shut 10 10–90 % Set point for shut down due to low flow,
down limit defined as percent of certified flow.
(FIT201-1)

4 MustNot

p117 Max delay of CIP 6 0–24 hrs Define max delay, in hours, before a CIP
cycle, hours process must be performed after ballast
or deballast.

4 MustNot

p118 Max delay of CIP 1 0–30 day Define max delay, in days, before a CIP
cycle, days process must be performed after ballast
or deballast.

4 MustNot

p119 Valve travelling 5 1–10 sec Maximum time for V201–8 to go from
time for 201-8 opened to closed, and vice versa, before
a warning is issued.

10 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.2 Page 5.1 – Main parameters 1

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

p120 V201–8 PID 0.30 0.00 N/A Defines proportional gain (Pf) value used
proportional gain – for PID regulation of V201–8 during
10.00 ballast and deballast.

4 Must Normal value: 0.1 – 1.5.

The PID regulation during ballast and


deballast is based on input from flow
transmitter FIT201–1.

p121 V201–8 PID 7.00 0–100 sec Defines integral time (If) value used for
integral time PID regulation of V201–8 during ballast
and deballast.

4 Must Normal value: 5 – 12.

For details, see p120.

p122 V201–8 PID 0.0 0.0–100.0N/A Defines derivate gain (Df) value used for
derivative gain PID regulation of V201–8 during ballast
and deballast.

4 MustNot For details, see p120.

p138 Timeout: Time 5 1–30 min Defines maximum time a ballast and
in Pause before deballast process can be manually
going to Stop paused. After defined time, the process
is stopped.

p140 Timeout: Request 5 1–30 min Time the control system will wait for
"Open overboard confirmation signal from ISCS, hard
valve" wire or manually in popup before
displaying message that operation was
not performed.

p141 Timeout: Request 1 1–3 min Time the control system will wait for
"Start BW confirmation signal from ISCS, hard wire
pump/strip pump" or manually in popup. After that the
process is stopped.

The parameter is used for both BW pump


during ballast/deballast and for stripping
pump during stripping.

p143 Timeout: Power 60 1–300 sec Time the control system will wait for
granted signal not confirmation signal from ISCS that the
received operation was performed.

Only used if parameter p127 is set to


Activated (Hardwire ranged or fixed).

Book No.9028188 02 11
2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2 2 Control system parameters

2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2


This section describes the main system parameters set in page 5.2 Main parameters 2.

4 5.2 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

p127 Power Not N/A Drop Defines if power management is used.


management used list
Alternatives:

4 Must • Not used


• Hardwire ranged
• Hardwire fixed
• Remote interface (requires that p132
is activated)

p128 Max time 60 15–240 Sec Define max delay before the system
communication shuts down after communication is
loss PLC/remote lost between the PLC and the remote
interface interface (optional). The value must be
greater than the heartbeat signal interval
defined in the ISCS.

For further information see chapter 6.


Installation description and drawings,

12 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value
section Remote interface integration
(optional). See address +006 and +047.

p129 Booster pump Not N/A Drop Defines if an LDC cooling water pump is
(P401-1) for LDC used list used to create sufficient cooling water
cooling water flow to the LDC.

4 Must Alternatives:
– Not used.
– External: Pump started by signal
from PureBallast control cabinet: Power
supply with over current protection
relay and contactors and are handled
externally.
– Internal: Pump completely controlled
from PureBallast control cabinet:
Start signal and power supply with
over current protection relays and
contactors from control cabinet. It is still
possible to connect pumps according to
configuration 1.

Note: In internal mode, external signal


will also be activated.

Note: Internal is only displayed for


control cabinets of configuration 2. See
control system page 4.1, field Control
cabinet configuration.

p130 Booster pump Not N/A Drop Defines if an UVR cooling water pump
(P403-1) for used list is used to create sufficient cooling water
reactor cooling flow to the UV reactor.
water
4 Must Alternatives:
– Not used.
– External: Pump started by signal
from PureBallast control cabinet: Power
supply with over current protection
relay and contactors and are handled
externally.
– Internal: Pump completely controlled
from PureBallast control cabinet:
Start signal and power supply with
over current protection relays and
contactors from control cabinet. It is still
possible to connect pumps according to
configuration 1.

Note: In internal mode, external signal


will also be activated.

Book No.9028188 02 13
2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2 2 Control system parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

Note: Internal is only displayed for


control cabinets of configuration 2. See
control system page 4.1, field Control
cabinet configuration.

p132 Remote interface Not N/A Drop Defines if remote interface (optional) is
via modubus used list used and connected via modbus.

If connected, the Local and Remote


4 Must buttons are visible in the control panel.
They are used to choose if operation
shall be done from the remote interface
or a control panel.

p135 External system Not N/A Drop Defines if an external system stop button
stop used list (or signal) is installed.

4 Must Purpose: Ongoing process is stopped


and valves are returned to starting
position as fast as possible.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p137 Hide Pause Acti- N/A Drop Defines if the Pause button is visible or
button vated list hidden in the control system. If activated,
the button is hidden.

4 Must Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p155 External feed min 50 50 – % Defines lowest value PureBallast can


setpoint 100 request from external feed. Only valid
if PureBallast is contolling ballast water
flow by sending signals to vessels ballast
water pump or throttle valve before
PureBallast.

If external feed controls a ballast water


pump, PureBallast will never request
it to run on a lower speed than the
percentage set in this parameter. If a
valve is controlled, the parameter defines
percent open.

The parameter also defines starting point


for flow regulation when a process is
started, to ensure a smooth start with
a gradually increased flow until desired
value is reached.

Default value should normally be used.

14 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

p156 External feed 5 2 – 30 s / Defines how many seconds it takes to


change rate % change the external feed signal 1 %.

Note: It might take a little longer for the


4 Must actual change of the pump or the valve
to adjust the flow.

p157 External feed 70 50 – % Defines when external feed control is


V201–8 low 90 activated, based on V201-8.
trigger limit
PureBallast will start to request reduced
4 Must flow when V201-8 closes to reach this
degree of percent open.

p160 GPS time Acti- N/A Drop Only valid if RMC protocol is used for
synchronization vated list GPS integration.
via RMC-protocol
If activated, time and date in the control
system is retrieved from vessel’s GPS.

If not activated, time and date must be


set in control system page 4.1. System
info.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p161 Time interval for 1.0 0.1 – Min. Time interval to update the amount (m3)
log event 331 60.0 of ballast water treated in log file.

p162 Time interval for 1.0 0.1 – Min. Time interval to update the amount (m3)
log event 341 60.0 of deballast water treated in log file.

p163 Additional bypass Not N/A Drop Defines if an additional bypass valve is
signal 1 used list used. The signal gives information if the
valve is opened during process, so that
PureBallast is bypassed.
4 Must

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p164 Additional bypass Not N/A Drop Defines if a second additional bypass
signal 2 used list valve is used. The signal gives
information if the valve is opened during
process, so that PureBallast is bypassed.
4 Must

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p165 Additional bypass Not N/A Drop Defines if a third additional bypass valve
signal 3 used list is used. The signal gives information if
the valve is opened during process, so
that PureBallast is bypassed.
4 Must

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

Book No.9028188 02 15
2.3 Page 5.2 – Main parameters 2 2 Control system parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Description


fault Max
value

p166 Pressure PID 0.60 0.00 – N/A Defines proportional gain (Pf) value used
proportional gain 10.00 for PID regulation of V201–8 during
backflush.

4 Must The PID regulation during backflush is


based on input from pressure transmitter
PT201-27.

Normal value: 0.1 – 1.5.

p167 Pressure PID 7.0 0.0 – sec Defines integral time (If) value used
integral time 100.0 for PID regulation of V201–8 during
backflush.

4 Must This parameter shall normally not be


changed.

Normal value: 5 – 12.

p168 Pressure PID 0.0 0.0 – N/A Defines derivate gain (Df) value used
derivate gain 100.0 for PID regulation of V201–8 during
backflush.

4 MustNot

p170 Stripping enabled Not N/A Drop Defines if stripping is used.


used list
Purpose: Enables stripping to be used
with stripping events written to event log.
4 Must Possible to connect a stripping pump via
hard wire or remote interface to be used.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.


p171 No. UV reactors 1 Min: 1 No. Defines how many UV reactors to be
to use when used for stripping process.
stripping Max:
p106
4 Must

p172 Minimum flow 10 7–90 % Set point for shut down due to low flow,
when stripping defined as percent of certified flow.
(FIT201–1)

4 MustNot

16 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.4 Page 5.3 – UVR parameters

2.4 Page 5.3 – UVR parameters


This section describes parameters controlling the UV reactor set in page 5.3 UVR parameters.

4 5.3 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p200 Timeout: UV 2 0.5–10.0 min Time the control system will wait for
reactor draining confirmation that an UV reactor is drained
before an alarm is issued. Recommended
setting: Approximately 1 minute more
4 Must than actual drain time.

p201 Timeout: Reactor 2 1–10 min Time the control system will wait for
cooling water confirmation that cooling water has filled
(LS201-29) the UV reactor before an alarm is issued.

p202 High temp, 60 10–100 ºC Setpoint for high water temperature alarm,
alarm trigger indicated by temperature transmitter in
(TT201-33) UV reactor.

4 MustNot

p204 Low temp, -2 -5–40 ºC Setpoint for low water temperature alarm,
alarm trigger indicated by temperature transmitter in
(TT201-33) the UV reactor.

4 MustNot

Book No.9028188 02 17
2.4 Page 5.3 – UVR parameters 2 Control system parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p206 Alarm delay for 5 0–10 sec Delay before alarm is issued after setpoint
sensor TT201-33 temperature (p202 and p204) is reached.

p208 Timeout: CIP 5 1–15 min Setpoint for max time to fill an UV reactor
fluid fill-up time with CIP liquid during CIP process before
UV reactor an alarm is issued.

p210 UV lamp warm-up 90 0–90 sec Warm up time for UV lamps before full
time ballast or deballast starts.

4 MustNot

p211 UV lamp cooling 300 180–600 sec Cooling time for UV lamps after ballast
time or deballast.

4 MustNot

p212 Timeout: UV 70 10–70 sec Time the control system will wait for
lamp ignition confirmation signal that UV lamps are
ignited. If no lamps are ignited or if
less lamps than set in parameter p213
4 MustNot are ignited, the UV reactor will be
automatically stopped.

p214 High temp, 45 20–100 ºC Incoming cooling water temperature


warning trigger warning, indicated by temperature
in LDC (TT401-1) transmitter in LDC.

4 MustNot

p215 Alarm delay for 5 0–10 sec Delay before shutdown when there is no
LS201-29 water in an UV reactor, indicated by level
switch in UV reactor (LS201-29).

4 MustNot

p216 Timeout: Fluid 5 2–10 min Setpoint for max time to fill an UV reactor
fill-up time UV with fresh water during CIP process
reactor before an alarm is issued.

p230 Cabinet 2 0.5–5.0 °C Accepted temperature change without


temperature effect on the fan.
hysteresis
(TT401-2)
4 MustNot

18 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.4 Page 5.3 – UVR parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p231 Cabinet 40.0 20.0 – °C Setpoint for LDC cooling fan regulation.
temperature 60.0 When the temperature is below setpoint,
low threshold the fan is running at 30 % of full effect.
(TT401-2)
4 MustNot At setpoint the fan effect is increased
proportional to temperature from 30 % up
to 100 % at temperature set in p232.

p232 Cabinet 45.0 20.0 – °C Setpoint for running the LDC cooling fan
temperature 60.0 at 100 %.
high threshold
(TT401-2)
4 MustNot

p234 UV control 0.10 0.00 – N/A Defines proportional gain (Pf) value used
proportional gain 100.00 for PID regulation of UV lamp effect.

The PID regulation is based on input from


4 MustNot UV sensor QT201–50.

p235 UV control 15 0–100 sec Defines integral time (If) value used for
integral time PID regulation of UV lamp effect.

4 MustNot

p237 Power Acti- N/A Drop Activates UV optimization to regulate


optimization vated list the UV lamp effect based on actual
transmittance in the UV reactor. This
means that the lamps are lit to the degree
4 MustNot needed for full treatment, but not more.

If disabled, UV lamps are lit at 100 % all


the time. Disable if the UV optimization
malfunctions, to avoid alarms.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p238 High 50.0 20.0 – °C Air temperature warning, indicated by


temperature, 100.0 temperature transmitter in LDC.
warning trigger
in LDC (TT401-2)
4 MustNot

Book No.9028188 02 19
2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters 2 Control system parameters

2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters


This section describes parameters controlling the filter set in page 8.4 Filter parameters.

4 5.4 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p300 High filter 3 1–10 bar Setpoint for shut down due to high
diff. pressure differential pressure over the filter.
shutdown trigger

4 MustNot

p301 High filter 1.5 0.0- bar Setpoint for high pressure warning,
differential 2.0 indicated by pressure transmitter in the
pressure, filter.
warning trigger
4 MustNot (1.5 bar = 0.15 MPa)

p302 Continuous 2 1–5 min Only valid for Filtrex filter.


backflush trigger
time If two backflushes are triggered by
differential pressure within this time, the
filter will run continuous backflushes for
p303 minutes.

20 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p303 Continuous 20 10-30 min Only valid for Filtrex filter.


backflush length
Defines for how many minutes the filter
will run continuous backflushes, after
triggered by p302.

p304 Pressure 2.50 1.00– bar Defines desired pressure for efficient
setpoint during 5.00 backflushing.
backflush
4 Must When a backflush is triggered, control
valve V201–8 will regulate to obtain this
pressure. After time set in parameter p310
the backflush will start, regardless of if the
pressure has been reached.

During backflush pressure is maintained


by PID regulation of control valve V201-8,
based on input from pressure transmitter
PT201-16.

Parameter is set according to the formula


below:
p304 ≥ 1.0 bar + calculated pressure drop
for pipe 309.

p305 Backflush 0.50 0.00– bar Setpoint for automatic start of filter
trigger, 2.00 backflush due to dirt in the filter, indicated
differential by high differential pressure over filter.
pressure
(PT201-27) Note: This parameter can be adjusted, but
only by Alfa Laval during commissioning.
If adjusted, parameter p301 shall be set
to 30 percent higher.

(0.50 bar = 0.050 MPa)

p306 Filter 5 1–30 min Defines duration of filter preservation


preservation time (fresh water filling of filter) after ballasting.

p308 Backflush cycle 20 1– sec Defines duration of one filter backflush.


time 100
The parameter should be set to: 20
seconds.
4 MustNot

p309 Time controlled 30 1– min Defines time between automatic backflush


backflush 120 of the filter. Automatic backflushes
interval are performed with this set interval to
secure performance, regardles of current
differential pressure.

Book No.9028188 02 21
2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters 2 Control system parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p310 Backflush initial 5 0–60 sec Defines how long time that should pass
delay from a backflush is triggered until is
actually started.

4 Must During this time, the control valve is PID


regulated to create the required pressure
defined in parameter p304.

p311 Backflush delay 2.0 0.0– sec Defines for how many seconds the
(p305 during x 10.0 differential pressure defined in p305 must
sec). last, before automatic backflush starts.

p313 Differential 5 0–30 sec Time constant for low pass filter used for
pressure the differential pressure over the filter.
measurement The low pass filter is used to smoothen
filter the effect of sudden changes in differential
pressure (primarily pressure peaks after
completed backflush).

Value for low pass filtered differential


pressure is indicated as “dp” on the filter
in the filter popup, when logged in as login
level Operator or higher.

Actual differential pressure (PT201-27) is


indicated in the filter popup.

This parameter shall normally not be


changed, but time can be increased to
flatten the differential pressure curves.

p314 Filter Type N/A Drop Defines type of filter installed.


2 list
Alternatives: Type 1 (Boll), Type 2 (Hydac)
and Type 3 (Filtrex).

p315 Filter type 500 100 – m3/h Parameter p314 should be set before this
6000 parameter. Available alternatives depend
on selection in p314.

4 Must Defines filter type and capacity according


to plate mounted on the filter.

The parameter shall be set to


ACB-985–300.

Note: If the parameter is called Filter


size, set the parameter to maximum
capacity for installed filter. This is same
as the maximum ballast flow. See item
201 in in the Connection list in chapter 6.
Installation description and drawings.

22 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.5 Page 5.4 – Filter parameters

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p316 Max filter 6 6 or bar Defines range for pressure transmitter


pressure 10 PT201–16. Set according to range printed
on the transmitter:

4 Must -1 – 9 bar: Set parameter to 6.

-1 – 15 bar: Set parameter to 10.

p318 Backflush pump Not N/A Drop Defines if an LDC cooling water pump
(P309–1) used list (optional) is used to create sufficient
backflush flow in pipe 309.

4 Must Alternatives:
– Not used.
– External: Pump started by signal from
PureBallast control cabinet: Power supply
with over current protection relay and
contactors and are handled externally.
– Internal: Pump completely controlled
from PureBallast control cabinet: Start
signal and power supply with over current
protection relays and contactors from
control cabinet. It is still possible to
connect pumps according to configuration
1.

Note: In internal mode, external signal will


also be activated.

Note: Internal is only displayed for control


cabinets of configuration 2. See control
system page 4.1, field Control cabinet
configuration.

p319 Backflush pump 5 0 – 10 sec Delay from backflush pump P309–1


(P309) lead time (optional) start to opening of backflush
valve V309–1.

Only used if parameter p318 is activated.

Book No.9028188 02 23
2.6 Page 5.5 – CIP parameters 2 Control system parameters

2.6 Page 5.5 – CIP parameters


This section describes parameters controlling the CIP module set in page 5.5 CIP parameters.

4 5.5 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p400 CIP cycle time 15 1–60 min Duration of circulation of CIP liquid
during a CIP process.

4 MustNot

24 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters

2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters


This section describes the installation specific system parameters set in page 5.6 Installation
parameters.

4 5.6 USCG

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

System name N/A N/A N/A Possibility to enter a system name for
the system, for example Vessel name
when logged in as login level Advanced
operator or higher. If two systems is
4 Must installed information about starbord and
port side.

The text is entered in the event log


file and alarm lists exported from the
control systen for easy identification.

fisk

Serial number N/A N/A N/A Possibility to enter the PureBallast


serial number when logged in as login
level Advanced operator or higher.
4 Must

Book No.9028188 02 25
2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters 2 Control system parameters

p106 Number of UV 1 1–6 # Defines number of installed UV


reactors installed reactors.

4 Must

p112 Maximum flow 1200 0– m3/h The parameter shall be set according to
(FIT201-1) 3000 pipe dimension for the flow meter pipe.

Pipe - Qmax (m3/h)


4 Must 80 – 150
100 – 250
150 – 500
200 – 700
250 – 1200
300 – 1200
350 – 1700
400 – 2200
450 – 3300
500 – 3300
600 – 3300
The parameter shall be set to the same
value as the Qmax value in the flow
meter (FIT201-1).

Qmax setting in the flow meter can be


checked according to instruction Check
and set parameters.

p131 Automatic UV Not N/A Drop Defines if UV reactors shall be


reactor selection used list automatically selected for process.

It is pissible to toggle the parameter with


4 Must the Auto button in page 1.1 Overview.

If activated: All UV reactors (without


alarms) will be automatically selected,
to enable operation in full capacity.
Activation disables the possibility
to select a lowr flow before starting
a process (during standby mode).
However flow can be changed during
process.

If deactivated: Flow must be selected


manually at first start-up and after
shutdown.

26 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters

p213 Allowed number 0 0–1 No. If more lamps than set in this parameter
of failed UV are broken, it is not allowed to start a
lamps per UV new operation.
reactor
4 MustNot If a UV lamp fails during ongoing
operation, the flow is set 80 % in IMO
mode and 50 % in USCG mode of flow
capacity. The UV lamps are lit to 100 %.

Operation with faulty LPS or lamps does


not fulfill the type approval certificate.

p217 UV reactor size 300 N/A Drop Defines size of the UV reactor, defined
(m3/h) list as max capacity (m3/h).
Alternatives: 300, 600 and 1000.

4 Must

p218 Estimated UV 3 000 0 – hrs Setpoint for UV lamp change warning.


lamp lifetime 20000 Counter for UV lamp run time is reset
in page 4.4 Operation timers UVR after
all UV lamps have been changed in an
4 MustNot UV reactor.

p150 Ex proof system Not N/A Drop Defines if the Ex proof version of
used list PureBallast is installed. This affects
both installation and control system.

4 Must Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p151 Ex-I barrier fault Not N/A Drop Defines if alarm for barrier box is
used list activated.

Mandatory for IECEx installations. Only


4 Must used for Ex US flag installations.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p155 External feed min 50 50 – % Defines lowest value PureBallast can


setpoint 100 request from external feed. Only valid
if PureBallast is contolling ballast water
flow by sending signals to vessels
ballast water pump or throttle valve
before PureBallast.

If external feed controls a ballast water


pump, PureBallast will never request
it to run on a lower speed than the
percentage set in this parameter. If
a valve is controlled, the parameter
defines percent open.

The parameter also defines starting


point for flow regulation when a process
is started, to ensure a smooth start with
a gradually increased flow until desired
value is reached.

Book No.9028188 02 27
2.7 Page 5.6 – Installation parameters 2 Control system parameters

Default value should normally be used.

p156 External feed 5 2 – 30 s / Defines how many seconds it takes to


change rate % change the external feed signal 1 %.

Note: It might take a little longer for the


4 Must actual change of the pump or the valve
to adjust the flow.

p157 External feed 70 50 – % Defines when external feed control is


V201–8 low 90 activated, based on V201-8.
trigger limit
PureBallast will start to request reduced
4 Must flow when V201-8 closes to reach this
degree of percent open.

p180 USCG system Not N/A Drop Defines if the system is an USCG
used list system according to the system plate
on the control cabinet. If activated, it
is possible to run the system in USCG
4 Must mode and IMO mode. This is changed
by the IMO and USCG function buttons.

Note: This parameter can only be


activated for a USCG system.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

p500 Log box Not N/A Drop Defines if the log box (optional ) is
used list installed to monitor and log external
valves and pumps, that are not part of
Alfa Laval’s scope of supply.
4 Must

Parameters to activate feedback signals


for components are set in page 4.7 Log
box 1 and 4.8 Log box 2. See chapter
3. Operating instructions and control
system description.

Alternatives: Activated or Not used.

28 Book No.9028188 02
2 Control system parameters 2.8 Page 5.7 – Remote interface

2.8 Page 5.7 – Remote interface


This section describes the installation specific system parameters set in page 5.7 Installation
parameters. Further information about RTU server data is found in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings section Communication between PureBallast PLC and remote interface.

This page is only relevant if remote interface (optional) is used.

4 5.7 USCG

Control system screen showing the main overview page.

Parameters for the ISCS modbus RTU server data shall be set according to the information below.

ID Parameter De- Min- Unit Comment


fault Max
value

p700 Interface type RS485 N/A Drop Defines communication (cable) type
list used for communication between the
ISCS and PureBallast.

Alternatives: RS485 and RS422.

Book No.9028188 02 29
2.8 Page 5.7 – Remote interface 2 Control system parameters

p701 Baud rate 9600 N/A Drop Defines baud rate in bits per second.
list
The parameter can be changed, but
it is not recommended. Note, that the
information must be the same in ISCS
and PureBallast control system.

Alternatives: 300, 600, 1200, 2400,


4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600,
115200.

p702 Parity No N/A Drop Defines parity.


parity list
The parameter can be changed, but
it is not recommended. Note, that the
information must be the same in ISCS
and PureBallast control system.

Alternatives: None, Odd, Even, High,


Low.

p703 Data bits 8 N/A Drop Defines data bits per character.
list
Alternatives: 7 or 8.

4 MustNot

p704 Stop bits 1 N/A Drop Defines number of stop bits.


list
Alternatives: 1 or 2.

4 MustNot

30 Book No.9028188 02
3 Flow transmitter parameters

This section describes the parameters set in the parameter pages in the flow transmitter, installed
on the flow meter.

General (non-installation specific) parameters are preset to function for all systems. They must only
be adjusted, by Alfa Laval, if required by performance reasons or similar. They are checked during
preparations for commissioning and shall normally not be adjusted after start up.

Operating keys

The parameters are set by using the operationg keys on the flow transmitter panel.

4 Operating keys

Operating keys:
1. (-) Minus key for entering, selecting.
2. (+) Plus key for entering, selecting.
3. Enter key for calling the function matrix, saving.
ESC. When the +/- keys are pressed simultaneously
·Press once to exit, step-by-step
·Press > 3 sec to cancel data input and return to the measured value display.

Display lines

4 Display lines

Display lines/fields:
1. Main line for primary measured values.
2. Additional line for additional measured variables/status variables.
3. Current measured values.
4. Engineering units/time units.

Book No.9028188 02 31
3.1 Check and set parameters 3 Flow transmitter parameters

3.1 Check and set parameters


Follow this instruction to check and set parameters in the flow transmitter.

The parameters for CURRENT OUTPUT: VALUE 20 mA and the PROCESS PARAMETER:
ON-VAL.LF-CUTOFF shall be set according to pipe dimension for the flow meter pipe.

The parameters are set by using the three operating keys; E, +, - on the flow transmitter panel. Use
the keys to navigate between options in the menu on the display.

Follow the steps below

1. Press E (Enter) key

2. Press + (Plus) or - (Minus) key to find function group listed below.

3. Press E key to find parameter.

4. Press + or -.

5. Set acess code 0050 by pressing + or - the correct digit and then press E after each digit.

6. Change value by pressing E.

7. Press + key and - key simultaneously for minimum 3 sec, to escape the programming mode.

Meny on the display:

Function group Parameter Factory settings

MEASURING VALUES N/A

SYSTEM UNITS UNIT VOLUME FLOW m3/h

UNIT VOLUME m3

UNIT LENGTH MILLIMETER

FORMAT DATE/TIME DD.MM.YY 24H

QUICK SETUP QUICK SETUP NO


COMMISSIONING

OPERATION LANGUAGE ENGLISH

ACCESS CODE N/A

DEF. PRIVATE CODE 50

STATUS ACCESS N/A

ACCESS CODE COUNTER 0

32 Book No.9028188 02
3 Flow transmitter parameters 3.1 Check and set parameters

USER INTERFACE ASSIGN LINE 1 VOLUME FLOW

ASSIGN LINE 2 TOTALIZER 1

FORMAT X.XXXX

DISPLAY DAMPING 3 s

CONTRAST LCD 50 %

BACKLIGHT 50 %

TEST DISPLAY OFF

TOTALIZER 1 / 2 (both) ASSIGN TOTALIZER VOLUME FLOW

SUM N/A

OVERFLOW N/A

UNIT TOTALIZER m3

TOTALIZER MODE Totalizer 1 + 2: FORWARD

RESET TOTAL NO

HANDLING TOTAL RESET ALL TOTAL NO

FAILSAFE MODE STOP

CURRENT OUTPUT 1 ASSIGN CURRENT VOLUME FLOW

CURRENT SPAN 4–20 mA

VALUE 20 mA See table below

TIME CONSTANT 3.00 s

FAILSAFE MODE ACTUAL VALUE

ACTUAL CURRENT N/A

SIMULATION CURR. OFF

COMMUNICATION N/A

PROCESS PARAMETER ASSIGN LF-CUTOFF VOLUME FLOW

ON-VAL. LF-CUTOFF See table below

OFF VAL. LF-CUTOFF 50 %

EMPTY PIPE DET. ON STANDARD

Book No.9028188 02 33
3.1 Check and set parameters 3 Flow transmitter parameters

EPD/OED RESPONSE TIME 1.0 s

ECC N/A

EPD/OED ADJUSTMENT OFF

SYSTEM PARAMETER INSTL. DIR. SENSOR NORMAL (FORWARD)

MEASURING MODE STANDARD

POS. ZERO RETURN OFF

SYSTEM DAMPING 9

INTEGRATION TIME 20 ms at 50 Hz, 16.7


ms at 60 Hz

SENSOR DATA N/A

SUPERVISION CURRENT SYSTEM N/A


CONDITION

PREV. SYS. COND. N/A

ASSIGN SYS. ERROR CANCEL

ASSIGN PROCESS ERRORS CANCEL

ALARM DELAY 0 s

SYSTEM RESET NO

OPERATION HOURS N/A

PERMANENT STORAGE ON

SIMULATION SYSTEM SIM. FAILSAFE MODE OFF

SIM. MEASURAND OFF

SENSOR VERSION N/A

AMP. VERSION N/A

Set parameter “VALUE 20 mA” and “ON-VAL. LF-CUTOFF” (low flow cut off) as table below:

34 Book No.9028188 02
3 Flow transmitter parameters 3.1 Check and set parameters

Flow meter - Pipe dimension specif c values:

Pipe dimension VALUE 20 mA (f ow span Low f ow cut off (m3/h)


corresponding to 4-20 mA)

A/DN 80 0-150 0.7

A/DN 100 0-250 1.2

A/DN 150 0-500 2.5

A/DN 200 0-700 5.0

A/DN 250 0-1200 7.5

A/DN 300 0-1200 10

A/DN 350 0-1700 15

A/DN 400 0-2200 20

A/DN 450 0-3300 25

A/DN 500 0-3300 30

A/DN 600 0-3300 40

If restoring of factory settings is required. Follow the steps below.

1. Find function group SUPERVISION.

2. Press E key to find parameter SYSTEM RESET.

3. Change the setting from NO to YES.

4. Press E key.

5. Press + and - key simultaneously for minimum 3 sec, to escape the programming mode.

Book No.9028188 02 35
3.1 Check and set parameters 3 Flow transmitter parameters
4 Lamp power supply (LPS)
parameters

This section describes the parameters (DIP switch settings) set in the LPS, installed in the lamp
drive cabinet (LDC). Each LPS is set to identify the individual LPS in the installation.

4.1 DIP switch settings


The table below show the correct settings for respective LPS.

Switch 1-3 shall always be in position off. Switch 4-8 is set to identify the individual LPS according
to the table below. Only position ON is indicated. For empty cells in the table, the switch shall be
in position OFF.

LPS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1–16
SW 1
SW 2
SW 3
SW 4 ON
SW 5 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
SW 6 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
SW 7 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON
SW 8 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON

Example

In the illustration, the DIP switches is set for LPS no. 5.

Book No.9028188 02 37
4.2 Change DIP switch setting 4 Lamp power supply (LPS) parameters

4 LPSdip

4.2 Change DIP switch setting


Follow this instruction to change the DIP switch settings for an LPS. Note that the DIP switch
settings for LPS shall only be changed if faulty, indicated by all LEDs lit in LPS in combination with
alarm A130 in the control system.

Preparations and conditions

NGE R
! DA
• Switch off the main breaker on the LDC door. The LPS has high voltage/power (600 V) inside
and on the lamp power connector, even when UV lamps are not lit.
• The LDC contains a fan, which can cause injury if in operatoin.
Follow the steps below

1. Unscrew the plastic lid (1) over the DIP switches on the fron of the LPS.

38 Book No.9028188 02
4 Lamp power supply (LPS) parameters 4.2 Change DIP switch setting

7 LPSdip

2. Use a small screw driver to change position of the swithces according to the table under
instruction DIP switch settings.

3. Re-fit the plastic lid of the DIP switches.

4. Turn back the power to the cabintet.

Book No.9028188 02 39
4.2 Change DIP switch setting 4 Lamp power supply (LPS) parameters
5 Fuse settings for filter motor
and installed (optional) pump
motors

Follow this instruction to change the fuse settings for filter motor M709–43 (F2) and installed
(optional) pump motors P401-1 (F3), P309-1 (F4) and P403-1 (F5) in the control cabinet.

Follow the steps below

1. On the filter motor and installed (optional) pump motors: Find area on the mark plate where
information is displayed for the frequency used for the system (50 or 60 Hz).

2. Look at voltage (V), stated as an interval.

3. Look at interval for Imax amp setting (A), also stated as an interval.

4. Make an estimation for Imax amp setting, so that it “match” the voltage in the range from
min to max.

5. On the fuse: Press Reset button until LEDs flash (6 seconds).

6. Turn the potentiometer to estimated amp setting according to mark plate.

7. Check that the setting is correct according to the LEDs. Compare to the table below.

4 FuseSettingBoosterPumps

8. Press Reset button to save the value.

Book No.9028188 02 41
Chapter: 5. Alarms and faultfinding
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40
This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 5

2 List of alarms and warnings 7


2.1 Control system 7
2.1.1 Alarm indication 7
2.1.2 Key to the table of alarms and warnings 7
2.1.3 List of alarms and warnings 8

2.2 Lamp power supply (LPS) 50


2.2.1 List of alarms and status indications 50

2.3 Flow meter 51


2.3.1 Fault finding instruction 51
2.3.2 Error messages on the display 51

2.4 Level switch 52


2.5 I/O system and X20 modules 54
2.5.1 List of alarms and status indications 55

3 List of problems and solutions 61


3.1 General problems 61
3.2 Filter 65
3.3 CIP 67
3.4 Valve V201–8 70

3
1 Introduction

This chapter covers information about alarms and warnings, together with information about how
to solve the problems causing the alarms to trip. The chapter also contains a list of solutions for
problems that may occur, but that is not indicated by any system.

The chapter contains lists of alarms indicated by:

• control system
• lamp power supply (LPS)
• flow meter (with fault finding instruction)
• I/O system and X20 modules.
See chapter 3. Operating instructions and control system description to find information about
the alarm pages and how to attend to alarms.

Book No.9028188 02 5
1 Introduction
2 List of alarms and warnings

This section lists all alarms and warnings related to the PureBallast system.

2.1 Control system


This sub section lists all alarms and warnings in the PureBallast control system. The alarms are
sorted in a strict numerical order.

2.1.1 Alarm indication


An alarm or warning will activate the alarm buzzer (sound and light) on the cabinet. The sound is
silenzed by touching the buzzer, but note that the alarm is not acknowledged by this.

An alarm is indicated in the following ways in the control panel.

Alarms

Alarms are indicated by:


3 Alarm

• The icon in the alarm tab starts to blink.


• The icon is also displayed by the faulty component in the screen.
• A red light in the exclamation mark on panel frame is lit.
• A sound is heard.
New alarm = blinking. Acknowledged alarm = Steady.
Warning

Works as alarms, but indicated in yellow.


3 Warning

No sound is heard for warnings. Exceptions: W12, W152 and W154.

All alarms are displayed in the control panel’s page 2.1 Alarm list and are sorted in order of
occurrence; most recent alarm at the top of the list.

2.1.2 Key to the table of alarms and warnings


The table below explains the information given in the alarms list table. The table contains the
following columns and information:

Book No.9028188 02 7
2.1 Control system 2 List of alarms and warnings

Column in Description
table

Alarm ID Identification number of the alarm. First letter indicate if it is an alarm or a


warning.

- A = Alarms stop the ongoing process, which can be restarted after the
problem has been attended to.
- W = Warnings are notification of a status change or a problem. Warnings
allow the process to continue.

Alarm text / The text displayed in the control system. Note that UV reactor number is
Problem indicated by “x” in the table, instead of the actual UV reactor number. In the
control system alarm text, the actual UV reactor number is stated for the UV
reactor concerned.

For problems not indicated by an alarm, the text gives a general explanation
of a problem that can occur.

Trigger / Trigger: Source of the alarm or warning, identified by the input sensor’s item
Parameter number or equivalent.
Parameter: The parameter controlling the alarm, when applicable.

Description Detailed information sorted on the following headings, when applicable:

Delay: Time before the alarm is activated after the condition of the alarm is met.
Comments: Additional information or explanations.

Possible Possible causes that might have triggered the alarm.


cause

What to do? Suggested action to solve the problem.

2.1.3 List of alarms and warnings


The table below explains alarms triggered by and displayed in the control system.

See next page.

8 Book No.9028188 02
2
Alarms and warnings — PureBallast control system

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A01 Process Trigger: PT201-16 Delay: 30 sec. Ballast water pump Check pressure and flow from

Book No.9028188 02
pressure too Parameter: p100 gives too high ballast pump(s). If the pressure
high (PT201-16). Comment: Pressure pressure. exceeds set value: Adjust incoming
Automatic stop. transmitter PT201-16 pressure to PureBallast.
indicates pressure
higher than set in Valves in the system Control that correct valves are
parameter p100. after pressure functioning and opened for current
List of alarms and warnings

transmitter are process. See chapter 3. Operating


closed. instructions and control system
description, section Detailed
process description.

Material is stocked Check the entire system for


after pressure blocking material.
transmitter PT201-16
(i.e. in an UV reactor).

Pressure transmitter 1. Check cables to pressure


PT201-16 is faulty. transmitter PT201-16. See
Control cabinet / Circuit
diagram in chapter 6.
Installation description and
drawings.
2. Replace pressure transmitter
PT201-16.
2.1

9
Control system
10
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A03 Process Trigger: PT201-16 Delay: 30 sec. Signal missing 1. Check fuse F45 in Control
pressure or pressure cabinet to see what circuit
signal missing Comment: Error transmitter PT201-16 caused the fuse trip.
(PT201-16). in system pressure malfunction.
2. Use the circuit diagram to
Control system

Automatic stop. sensor. Indication of


pressure -1.0 bar (-0.1 check the fuse setting, adjust
MPa) is not an error. according to figures in circuit
diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
4. Check cables to the
component. See Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
5. Check that all electrical
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
damaged.
2

6. Replace transmitter PT201-16.

W04 Process Trigger: PT201-16 Delay: 30 sec. See possible cause See A01.
pressure too Parameter: p101 for A01.
high (PT201-16). Comment: Pressure
higher than parameter
set limit.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A10 Process flow Trigger: FIT201-1. Delay: 5 sec. Signal missing or flow 1. Check fuse F45 in Control
signal missing Parameter: N/A transmitter FIT201-1 cabinet to see what circuit
(FIT201-1). Comment: Error in malfunction. caused the fuse trip.

Book No.9028188 02
system flow sensor.
2. Use the circuit diagram to
check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit
diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
List of alarms and warnings

3. Use the circuit diagram to


locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
4. Check cables to the
component. See Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
5. Check that all electrical
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
damaged.
6. Replace flow transmitter
FIT201-1.

Flow transmitter Check the flow transmitter. See


FIT201-1 malfunction chapter 7. Service manual.
(no text on the
2.1

transmitter display,
message error)

Flow meter See section Flow meter on page


malfunction. 51.

11
Control system
12
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W12 Process Trigger: FIT201–1 Delay: 30 sec. Flow rate higher than Reduce the incoming ballast water
flow higher Parameter: N/A certified flow. See flow to the PureBallast system.
than certified Comment: An field Certified flow in
(FIT201-1). additional common page 1.1 Overview. Note: Operation continues, but
Control system

Reduce flow! alarm signal is issued. does not fulfill the type approval
certificate. Act according to ballast
water plan.

Wrong setting in See chapter 4. Parameters, section


FIT201-1. Flow transmitter.

Flow sensor See section Flow meter on page


malfunctions. 51.

A13 Process flow too Trigger: FIT201–1 Delay: 20 sec. Flow too low. • Increase flow.
low (FIT201-1). Parameter: p116
• Make sure the ballast water
Automatic stop. Comment: If flow
is less than set in from the ballast pump is
parameter p116, the directed to PureBallast. When
system is shut down. OK the process will continue
automatically.
• Check pressure and flow
from ballast pump(s).
Adjust incoming pressure
2

to PureBallast, if necessary.

Wrong setting in See chapter 4. Parameters, section


FIT201-1. Flow transmitter.

Flow sensor See section Flow meter on page


malfunctions. 51.

Valves in ballast Control that correct valves are


system closed. opened for current process.
See chapter 3. Operating
instructions and control system
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID
description, section Detailed
process description.

If not, check mechanical function of

Book No.9028188 02
the valve and check that the cables
to the component is according
with the Control cabinet / Circuit
diagram.
List of alarms and warnings

Ballast water Attend to. Note: This component


pump stopped or is outside the PureBallast system
malfunctions control.

A14 Process Trigger: FIT201-1 Comment: Triggered Control valve V201–8 See alarm A17.
flow too low Parameter: p116 if flow defined in p116 malfunctions.
during start-up is not established
(FIT201-1). within 60 seconds after Flow too low. See alarm A13.
Automatic stop. ballast water pump is
started.

A17 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. Fuse tripped. 1. Check fuses F43 in control
(V201-3). GS201-3. cabinet to see what circuit
Parameter: N/A. Comment: Error on caused the fuse trip.
valve V201–3.
2. Check relay K1 and K2 on
module X10 in control cabinet.
3. Use the Control cabinet /
Circuit diagram to check the
fuse setting, adjust according
to figures in circuit diagram if
2.1

necessary and reset fuse.


4. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.

13
Control system
14
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

5. Check that all electrical


connections to actuator and
sensors on the valve are OK
and that the electrical wiring is
Control system

not damaged.

Position sensor is Adjust sensor. See chapter 7.


not in correct position Service manual, section Adjust
to sense indicator position sensor.
screws. Position
screws are in wrong Hint: Valves can be manually
position. operated. See instruction Operate
components manually in chapter 3.
Position sensor Operating instructions and control
mounted upside system description and Operate
down. valves manually in chapter 7.
Service manual.

Position sensor or 1. Check cables.


cables to position
2. Replace position sensor if
sensor malfunction.
faulty.

Too long 1. Follow the instruction Adjust


2

opening/closing time valve traveling speed in chapter


(valve travel time) 7. Service manual.
2. Adjust exhaust valves on
actuator.
3. Check that instrument air
pressure is according to
requirements in chapter 6.
Installation description and
drawings, section Connection
list.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Pilot valve on actuator The red LED on pilot valve contact


malfunction lights if opening signal comes to
the pilot. If the LED lights although

Book No.9028188 02
the valve malfunctions, the pilot
valve is faulty: Replace pilot valve.

Valve cannot Clean. If required dismount valve.


open/close due to See chapter 7. Service manual for
obstruction. instructions.
List of alarms and warnings

A19 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause Check relay K7 and K8 on module
(201-32) GS201-32. for A17. X10.
Parameter: N/A. Comment: Error on
valve V201–32.

A23 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause Check relay K5 and K6 on module
(V201-9). GS201-9. for A17. X10.
Parameter: N/A. Comment: Error on
valve V201–9.

A25 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause
(V404-35) GS201-35. for A17.
Parameter: N/A. Comment: Error on
valve V201–35.

A29 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause
(V201-8). GS201-8. for A17.
Parameter: N/A. Comment: Error on
control valve V201–8. • Sensor error. 1. Check open indication in the
2.1

Shows open all pneumatic positioner.


the time.
2. Check fuses F43 in control
• Signal error 4–20 cabinet to see what circuit
mA. caused the fuse trip.
3. Check relay K3 on module X10.

15
Control system
16
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

4. Use the Control cabinet /


Circuit diagram to check the
fuse setting, adjust according
to figures in circuit diagram if
Control system

necessary and reset fuse.


5. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
6. Check that all electrical
connections to actuator and
sensors on the valve are OK
and that the electrical wiring is
not damaged.

Positioner is not Calibrate according to chapter 7.


correcly set or Service manual, section Calibrate
calibrated. positioner on V201-8.

The air filters on Clean the filter on the possitioner.


V201-8 might be
clogged.
2

A33 Bypass valve is Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. The valve has been If not opened intentionally, close
open (V212-31). GS212-31. opened manually or valve V212-31.
Parameter: N/A Comment: If the valve via the ISCS.
(not controlled by
PureBallast) is opened, See possible cause
any ongoing process is for A17.
stopped.
This alarm is not
issued when the valve
is opened during mode
standby, heeling or
pause.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A35 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause
(V212-31). GS212-31. for A17.
Parameter: N/A Comment: Shutdown

Book No.9028188 02
of all steps except CIP.
The alarm does not
prevent completion or
start of CIP process.

W40 Process Trigger: Pressure Delay: 2 sec. Ballast water pump Check that pressure and flow
List of alarms and warnings

pressure too low transmitter: gives too low from ballast pump(s) is according
(PT201-16). PT201-16. pressure. to requirements in chapter 6.
Parameter: p103. Installation description and
drawings, section Connection list.

Pressure safety valve Check the valve, and repair or


V201 is faulty. change.

Pressure transmitter 1. Check cables to pressure


PT201-16 is faulty. transmitter PT201-16. See
Control cabinet / Circuit
diagram in chapter 6.
Installation description and
drawings.
2. Replace pressure transmitter
PT201-16.

A48 System stop Trigger: Stop button Delay: None. Process has been
activated (Stop on control cabinet stopped. NOTE
button). Parameter: N/A
2.1

Find out the reason why the process


has been stopped before releasing the
button and starting another process.

17
Control system
18
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A49 System stop Trigger: Stop button Delay: None See A48.
activated during on control cabinet
CIP (Stop Parameter: N/A
button).
Control system

A50 System stop Trigger: External Delay: None. Process has been
activated stop button on control stopped by external NOTE
(External stop cabinet (or signal). stop button or signal
button). Parameter: p135 from the ISCS Find out the reason why the process
(integrated ship has been stopped before releasing the
control system). button and starting another process.

A51 System stop Trigger: External Delay: None. See A50.


activated during stop button on control
CIP (External cabinet (or signal).
stop button). Parameter: p135

W58 Fuse tripped in Trigger: Control Delay: None. Possible reasons: 1. Check fuse F43–F45 in control
control cabinet. cabinet. • cabinet to see what circuit
Parameter: N/A caused the fuse trip.
• short circuit
2. Use the circuit diagram to
• overheated fuse
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
2

trip and attend to it.


3. Use the circuit diagram for
control cabinet to check the
fuse setting, adjust according
to figures in circuit diagram if
necessary and reset fuse.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A66 Additional Trigger: External Delay: 2 sec. The valve has been If not opened intentionally, close
bypass valve system. opened manually or the valve.
1 is open. Parameter: p163 Comment: If the valve via the ISCS.

Book No.9028188 02
(not controlled by
PureBallast) is opened,
any ongoing process is
stopped.
This alarm is not
issued when the valve
List of alarms and warnings

is opened during mode


standby, heeling or
pause.

A67 Additional Trigger: External Delay: 2 sec. See A66.


bypass valve system.
2 is open. Parameter: p164

A68 Additional Trigger: External Delay: 2 sec. See A66.


bypass valve system.
3 is open. Parameter: p165

A69 Remote system Trigger: External Delay: 2 sec. PureBallast is If valve is not opened intentionally,
reports system system. bypassed via the close the valve.
is bypassed. Parameter: ISCS.

A71 Ballast water Trigger: Control Delay: Set in Faulty connection of Check that all electrical connections
pump is system timer. parameter p141. signal cable. are OK. Check that the signal
not running. Parameter: p141. wiring is according to information in
Automatic stop. Comment: Feed back chapter 6. Installation description
2.1

signal “BW pump is and drawings, section External


running” is deactivated component signal integration.

If remote interface Test relevant addresses. See


(optinal) is used: chapter 3. Operating instructions
Communication

19
Control system
20
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID
between PureBallast and control system descriptionTest
and ISCS is wrong. remote interface communication

Time set in parameter Check/change parameter in


Control system

is lower than needed. control system page 5.1 – main


parameters 1.

A72 Stripping pump Trigger: Control Delay: Set in See possible cause
not running. system timer. parameter p141. for A71.
Automatic stop. Parameter: p141.
Comment: Feed
back signal “Stripping
pump is running” is
deactivated

A75 Overboard valve Trigger: Control Delay: Set in See possible cause
is not open. system timer. parameter p140. for A71.
Automatic stop. Parameter: p140
Comment: Feedback
“overboard valve is
OPEN”.

A77 Error on all Trigger: UV reactors Delay: None An active alarm exist Check page 2. Alarm list in control
operating on all installed UV
2

Parameter: N/A panel for related alarms.


UVR:s. Comment: All reactors. It can be the
Automatic stop. UV reactors are same error for all UV
deactivated. reactors, or different
errors.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

A79 Power is Trigger: Control Delay: Set in Power management Investigate if the reasons for not
not granted. system timer. parameter p143. master system not granting power is outside the
Automatic stop. Parameter: p127. granting power . PureBallast system.

Book No.9028188 02
Comment: No
power steps have Feedback signal from See A71.
been granted within power management
parameter set time. master is faulty. Check signal transmission to/from
PureBallast corresponds to
the specifications in chapter
List of alarms and warnings

6. Installation description
and drawings, section Power
management system integration.

Hint: If problem persists, see page


1.4 – PureBallast power request
to find which GRANTED signal
that was interrupted during the
ballast/deballast process.

W80 Power is not Trigger: Power Delay: None. See possible cause
fully granted. management system. for A79.
Flow capacity Parameter: p127. Comment: Not all
reduced. requested power steps Not enough power Continue process with lower flow
are granted. Triggered has been granted. capacity or try later.
if number or requested
power steps does
not match number of
granted power steps.
2.1

W82 Heeling mode Trigger: Heeling Delay: None. Heeling mode has
requested (internal transfer) been activated by
by operator. requested in control Comment: The system external system.
Automatic system. is set in pause mode.
pause. Parameter: N/A If operation has not
been requested: See
A71.

21
Control system
22
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W83 Heeling mode Trigger: Heeling Delay: None. See possible cause
cancelled (internal transfer) not for W82.
by operator. requested in control Comment: Process
Process system. is resumed after being
Control system

resumed. Parameter: N/A phased during heeling.

A91 PLC lost Trigger: Control Delay: 60 sec. Panel is switched off 1. Switch on the panel.
communication system PLC. or faulty.
2. Restart the panel. See problem
with all control Parameter: N/A Comment: After
60 seconds of lost 1 B in the general problems list
panels.
communication, on page .
ongoing process is 3. Replace if faulty.
stopped in a controlled
way and the system Wrong software Check that the HMI and PLC
is shut down. This version software have the save program
message is visible in version. This is visible in control
the control panels and system page 4.1 System info.
saved in the log after
the communication is Wrong network Check settings for each panel
restored. But, W92 will setting according to chapter 3, section Set
be visible in the main control panel IP settings.
control panel.
Check that the remote control
panel is added in the main panel
2

according to Set remote control


panel communication.

Faulty cable Check cables to the component.


connection. For reference, see Control cabinet
/ Interconnection diagram Remote
control panel / Circuit diagram and
in chapter 6. Installation description
and drawings.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W92 Main control Trigger: Control Delay: 30 sec. Master panel is See A91.
panel lost system PLC. switched off or faulty.
communication Parameter: N/A Comment: After

Book No.9028188 02
with the PLC. communication is lost, Faulty cable See A91.
ongoing process is connection.
stopped in a controlled
way and the system
is shut down. This
message is visible in
List of alarms and warnings

the main control panel.

A93 Heart beat signal Trigger: Control Delay: Set in To operate PureBallast when communication is down,
from remote system PLC. parameter p128. follow the steps below:
interface is not Parameter: p132
updating. Comment: After 1. Set the system to Local mode: Press the Local button
communication is on the control panel.
lost between ISCS
2. Run the system from the control panel. Note that you
and PLC, ongoing
will need to confirm two messages from the control
process is stopped in a
panel during operation: "Confirm ballast pump started"
controlled way and the
and "Confirm overboard valve open".
system is shut down.
3. Restore these settings when the communication is
The Heartbeat field working.
in page 4.5 Remote
4. Make sure that the system is not in test mode in page
interface, indicates
4.5 Remote interface (no check mark on the Test
communication.
mode button).

System is set to Test If you deliberately set the system


mode. to test mode (for example to test
2.1

remote interface integration, you


can disregard this alarm. If not
deactivate the test mode again in
page 4.5 Remote interface 1.

23
Control system
24
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Faulty settings. 1. Check that parameter p700 is


set to match the modbus cable
type used (RS422 or RS485).
2. Check if remote operation is
Control system

deactivated in the control panel


(The Remote button at the
bottom of the screen is gray). If
so, press the Remote button.
3. Check if test mode is activated
in page 4.5 Remote interface
(check mark on button). If so,
press the Test mode button.
Requires login level Advanced
operator.
4. Check that the communication
settings is OK according to
instruction Set remote interface
communication in chapter 3.
Operating instructions and
control system description.

Faulty cable Check cable between the ISCS


2

connection. and the main control panel and


the cable between the PLC and
the main control panel. For
reference, see Control cabinet /
Interconnection diagram in chapter
6. Installation description and
drawings.

Tips: Make sure that the modbus


cables in terminal X15 are correct
(not switched).
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Communication See W92.


between PLC and
main control panel is

Book No.9028188 02
lost.

ISCS is faulty. Investigate problem in ISCS, and


attend to found problems.

A94 Barrier fault To be completed To be completed


List of alarms and warnings

Trigger: Barrier in Delay: N/A.


LDC cabinet
Parameter: p151 Comment: This alarm
is specific for the
Ex proof version of
PureBallast for US
flag.

W95 PLC battery low. Trigger: Control Delay: 10 sec. The voltage in the Replace PLC battery in the control
system PLC. battery in the control cabinet.
Parameter: N/A system PLC is too
low.

W96 GPS signal not Trigger: Control Delay: 5 sec. Faulty electrical Check that the signal wiring
valid. system PLC. connection. is according to in chapter 6.
Parameter: p160 Installation description and
drawings, section GPS signal
integration and Control cabinet /
Interconnection diagram
2.1

25
Control system
26
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W97 PLC error in Trigger: N/A Delay: 2 sec. Error in module. Check the LED error indication for
control cabinet. Parameter: N/A the electronic modules in the LDC.
See section I/O system and X20
modules on page 54.
Control system

Faulty electrical • Check that the signal wiring is


connection. according to electrical drawings
in Chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
• Check that all electrical
connections are OK on bus
modules and that the electrical
wiring is not damaged.

W100 UVR [x]: UVR Trigger: UVR Delay: Set in High temperature • Check that the inlet valves
temp too high temperature parameter p206. due to obstacles or (V201-19.x, V403-35) and
(TT201-33). transmitter TT201-33. error in one or more outlet valves (V201-20.x,
UVR shutdown. Parameter: p202 Comment: If components involved. 404-36.x) open properly by
temperature rises operating them manually.
above parameter set See the instruction Operate
value, the UV reactor components manually
will shutdown. in chapter 3. Operating
instructions and control system
2

If the alarm trips during description.


operation with a flow
through the UV reactor, • Check that cooling water supply
the valves V201-19.x (403) is within specification
and V201-20.x will in chapter 6. Installation
close. description and drawings,
section Connection list.
If the alarm trips during
ballast start-up, valve Low flow of sea water Check pump, valves and other
V404-36.x will close. during start-up. components involved in the sea
water cooling system.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Parameter p202 not Check/change parameter in


correctly set. control system page 5.3 – UVR
parameters.

Book No.9028188 02
TT201-33.x Replace transmitter TT201–33
malfunction. according to instruction in
chapter 7. Service manual
section Temperature switch and
temperature transmitter.
List of alarms and warnings

W101 UVR [x]: UVR Trigger: UVR Delay: Set in See possible cause
temp too low temperature parameter p206. for W100.
(TT201-33). transmitter TT201-33.
UVR shutdown. Parameter: p204. Sea water too cold; See to that incoming water is
temperature below 0 warmer than 0 C°.
C°.

Engine room too cold; Increase temperature.


temperature below 0
C°.

W102 UVR [x]: Trigger: UVR Delay: Set in parameter Signal missing 1. Check fuse F42 in LDC to see
UVR temp temperature p206. or transmitter what circuit caused the fuse
signal missing transmitter TT201-33 TT201-33.x trip.
(TT201-33). error. malfunction.
2. Use the circuit diagram to
UVR shutdown.
Parameter: N/A. check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit
diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
2.1

3. Use the circuit diagram to


locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.

27
Control system
28
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

4. Check cables to the


component. See UVR /
Circuit diagram and Lamp drive
cabinet (LDC) / Circuit diagram
Control system

in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
5. Check that all electrical
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
damaged.
6. Replace transmitter TT201-33.
7. Restart the process from the
beginning.

W105 Temp below 0 Trigger: LDC Delay: Set in parameter


°C. temperature p206.
transmitter TT401.

W107 UVR [x]: LDC Trigger: LDC Delay: 15 sec. No cooling water to Check that cooling water supply
cooling water temperature the heat exchanger. (401) is within specification in
temp too high transmitter TT401. chapter 6. Installation description
(TT401–1). Parameter: p214 and drawings, section Connection
2

list in the General drawings section.

Incoming cooling Feel the water pipe, if it is too


water too warm. warm. If so, investigate and attend
to problem.

Incoming cooling Check and attend to.


water valve V401–1
and/or outgoing valve
blocked or closed.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Parameter p214 not Check/change parameter in


correctly set in control control system page 5.3 – UVR
system. parameters.

Book No.9028188 02
W109 UVR [x]: Trigger: LDC Delay: 5 sec. Signal missing or 1. Check fuse F42 in LDC to see
LDC cabinet temperature transmitter TT401 what circuit caused the fuse
temp missing transmitter TT401–1. malfunction. trip.
(TT401–1). Parameter: N/A
2. Use the circuit diagram for the
List of alarms and warnings

LDC to check the fuse setting,


adjust according to figures in
circuit diagram if necessary
and reset fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagrams for
the LDC and UV reactor to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
4. Check cables to the
component. See Lamp drive
cabinet (LDC) / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
5. Check that all electrical
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
damaged.
6. Replace transmitter TT401.
2.1

7. Restart the process from the


beginning.

Faulty connection to Check that all electrical connections


X20 module. are OK on X20 module and that the
electrical wiring is not damaged.

29
Control system
30
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Faulty X20 module. Check component. See section I/O


system and X20 modules on page
54.
Control system

Change according to instruction in


chapter 7. Service manual, section
Control cabinet.

W111 LDC air Trigger: Delay: 15 sec. LDC faulty. Check page 2. Alarm list in control
temperature too Temperature panel for related alarms.
high (TT401–2) transmitter TT401–2.
Parameter: p238 Faulty fan. Check electrical and mechanical
problems, and attend to.

W113 LDC cabinet Trigger: Delay: 5 sec. Signal missing or flow 1. Check fuse F42 in Control
temperature Temperature transmitter TT401-2 cabinet to see what circuit
missing transmitter TT401–2. malfunction. caused the fuse trip.
(TT401–2) Parameter: N/A
2. Use the circuit diagram to
check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit
2

diagram if necessary and reset


fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
4. Check cables to the
component. See Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

5. Check that all electrical


connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not

Book No.9028188 02
damaged.
6. Replace transmitter FIT201-27.
7. Restart the process from the
beginning.
List of alarms and warnings

W116 UVR [x]: UVR Trigger: Level sensor Delay: Set in Signal missing or 1. Check fuse F42 in LDC to see
fluid level LS201-29. parameter p215. sensor LS201-29.x which circuit that caused the
signal missing Parameter: N/A malfunction. fuse trip.
(LS201-29).
2. Check relay KS02.
3. Use the circuit diagrams for the
LDC to check the fuse setting,
adjust according to figures in
circuit diagram if necessary
and reset fuse.
4. Use the circuit diagrams for
the LDC and UV reactor to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
5. Check cables to the level switch
LS201-29.x. See drawing UVR
/ Circuit diagram and Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram
2.1

in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.

31
Control system
32
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

6. Check that the level switch is


working correctly. See section
Level switch on page 52.
Hint 2: Dismount level switch
Control system

and put the forks into a cup of


water to check dry/wet function.
7. Replace LS201-29.x. (Turn the
level switch so the forks are in
the right position. See chapter
7. Service manual.

W117 UVR [x]: UVR Trigger: Level sensor Delay: Set in No fluid in UV reactor. 1. Control that correct valves
fluid missing LS201-29. parameter p215. are opened for current
(LS201–29) in Parameter: N/A process. See Detailed process
manual mode Comment: The UV description in chapter 3.
reactor is shut down. Operating instructions and
Prevents start of LPS control system description.
(UV lamps) in manual
mode. 2. Check that the flow is equal
through all UV reactors and
that the UVR.x is not clogged.
3. Restart the process from the
beginning.
2

W118 UVR [x]: CIP Trigger: Level sensor Delay: Set in No fluid in UV reactor 1. Check that valves V320-2,
flow missing LS201-29. parameter p208. “x”. LS201-29.x V320-4.x, V321-4 and 321-2.x
(LS201-29). Parameter: p208 is indicating dry open and close correctly.
condition.
2. Check that pump P320-1
is functioning correctly. See
problem 6D−6I in the general
problems list on page .
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

3. Hint: Valves can be manually


operated. See the instruction
Operate valves manually

Book No.9028188 02
in chapter 3. Operating
instructions and control system
description.
Note that the manual
operations are password-
protected and must only be
List of alarms and warnings

performed by authorized
trained personnel. The
PureBallast equipment or
connected equipment can be
irreparably damaged if handled
incorrectly.
4. Examine the pipes related to
the CIP circuit. Make sure
that no material is clogging the
pipes.
5. Check that the level switch is
working correctly. See section
Level switch on page 52.

Time set in parameter Change parameter.


is lower than needed.

Level switch at UV See W116 to troubleshoot the level


reactor LS201-29.x switch electrically.
2.1

malfunction.

Too low level in CIP Refill the tank with CIP liquid. See
tank. instruction Change and refill CIP
liquid in chapter 7. Service manual.

Air in fluid. The level Deaerate the CIP, using the

33
Control system

switch indicates this deaeration valve on the CIP.


as no fluid in UV
reactor.
34
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W119 UVR [x]: No Trigger: Level sensor Delay: Set in No liquid in UV reactor 1. Check that pressure flushing
freshwater LS201-29. parameter p208. “x”. LS201-29.x water in pipe 310 is according
filling in UVR Parameter: p216 is indicating dry to requirements in chapter 6.
(LS201-29). condition. Installation description and
Control system

drawings, section Connection


list.
2. Check that valves (V310-6,
V320-4.x, V321-2.x and
V571-1) are operating correctly.
Also check that valve V310-3 is
OK and that V310–8 is opened.
Operate the components
manually.

Time set in parameter Change parameter.


is lower than needed.

Level switch at UV See W116 to troubleshoot the level


reactor LS201-29.x switch electrically.
malfunction.

W120 UVR [x]: UVR Trigger: Level sensor Delay: Set in Fluid in UV reactor Restart the process from the
was not drained LS201-29. parameter p200. “x”. LS201-29.x beginning.
2

(LS201-29). Parameter: p200 is indicating wet


condition.

Time set in parameter Change parameter.


is lower than needed.

Level switch at UV See W116.


reactor LS201-29.x
malfunction.

Faulty valves in the Control that correct valves


CIP unit. (V320–4, V460–2, V231–2,
V571–1, overboard valve) are
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID
opened for current process. Also
control that pump P321–5 is
functioning.

Book No.9028188 02
W122 UVR [x]: Fuse Trigger: LDC cabinet Delay: 1 sec. Fuse in LDC has Check fuse F42–43 in LDC cabinet
tripped in LDC for UVR tripped or has been to see what circuit caused the fuse
cabinet. Parameter: N/A switched off. trip. Check according to bullets.

• Use the circuit diagram for the


List of alarms and warnings

LDC to check the fuse setting,


adjust according to figures in
circuit diagram if necessary
and reset fuse.
• Use the circuit diagrams for
the LDC and UV reactor to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
• Check cables to the
component. See UVR /
Circuit diagram and Lamp drive
cabinet (LDC) / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
2.1

35
Control system
36
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W126 UVR [x]: MCB Trigger: LCD x-1 Delay: 1 sec. Motor circuit breaker 1. See LPS alarms in section
tripped in LDC Parameter: N/A (MCB) for an LPS in Lamp power supply (LPS) on
cabinet. Comment: UVR.x has tripped or page 50.
MCB=Motor circuit has been switched
2. Check Q101–Q116 in LDC and
Control system

breaker. UV reactor is off.


deactivated. respective cables and LPS unit.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
check the Ampere setting for
the MCB, adjust according
to figures in circuit diagram if
necessary and reset MCB.

Breaker on LDC has Reset the breaker by turning the


tripped or has been handle.
switched off.

W128 UVR [x]: LDC Q117 Delay: 5 sec. Motor circuit breaker Check Q117 in LDC.
cabinet fan (MCB) F1 in control
alarm cabinet has tripped
or has been switched
off.

Faulty fan. Check electrical and mechanical


problems, and attend to.
2

Faulty electrical Check that all electrical connections


connection. are OK and that the electrical wiring
is not damaged.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W129 UVR [x]: LDC Trigger: Water Delay: 5 sec. Leakage in cooling Repair.
cabinet water sensor LS below water piping.
alarm. heat exchanger in Dry wet areas in the cabinet.

Book No.9028188 02
LDC. Remove the sensor and dry it with
Parameter: N/A paper.

Condensation in the See above.


cabinet.
List of alarms and warnings

W130 UVR [x]: LPS Trigger: Lamp power Delay: 5 sec. • LPS malfunction. Check LED indication on the LPS
sum alarm. supply in UV reactors that triggered the alarm. See LPS
• Number of broken
LDC. alarms in section Lamp power
UV lamps exeeds
Parameter: N/A supply (LPS) on page 50.
number set in
parameter p213. Check which lamps that are broken
in column Lamp OK in page 4.9
LPS overview.

UV lamp OK signal Check that the signal wiring is


malfunction. according to electrical drawings.

Check that all electrical connections


are OK on bus modules and that
the electrical wiring is not damaged.

W131 UVR [x]: UV Trigger: Lamp power Delay: 5 sec. One or more UV lamp Check which lamps that are broken
system failure. supply. is broken. in column Lamp OK in page 4.9
Too many failed Parameter: p213. Comment: UV reactor LPS overview.
lamps. is deactivated.
2.1

Change according to instruction in


chapter 7. Service manual.

37
Control system
38
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W132 Estimated UV Trigger: UV reactor Delay: 1 sec. Lifetime for UV Recommended to change all lamps
lamp lifetime lap time. lamps are too after 3000 hours of operation.
exceeded. Parameter: p218. exceed according
to estimated lifetime Change according to instruction
Control system

in parameter. Replace UV lamp and quartz


sleeve in chapter 7. Service
manual.

A137 UVR [x]: To high Trigger: TS201-60 Delay: 1 sec. No flow in UV reactor See W100.
temperature Parameter: N/A or too low flow.
(TS201-60 Comment: UV reactor After problem has been attended
tripped) and/or is deactivated. to, the LDC needs to be reset.
LDC powered
off. Reset LDC

1. Turn on the power to the


cabinet/system.
2. Push the reset button on the
LDC. The button is placed
at the side facing the UV
reactor. All LDCs must be reset
individually.
3. Acknowledge alarm A137 in
2

the control system.

Faulty pump (ballast Check components.


or UVR cooling water Control that valves and pumps are
pump) or valve. functioning.

LDC has been The LDC needs to be reset, see


powered off. above in this alarm description.

Faulty electrical • Check that the signal wiring


List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID
connection. is according to electrical
drawings.
• Check that all electrical

Book No.9028188 02
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
damaged.

A138 UVR [x]: PLC Trigger UV reactor x. Delay: 2 sec. Error in module. Check the LED error indication for
List of alarms and warnings

error in LDC Parameter: N/A the electronic modules in the LDC.


cabinet. Comment: UV reactor See section I/O system and X20
is deactivated. modules on page 54.

W140 CIP schedule Trigger: Control Delay: Set in CIP not performed Control CIP status on page 1.3 CIP
timer elapsed system timer. parameter p117 and after operation. status in control system.
Start CIP! Parameter: N/A. p118.
Start CIP process.
Comment: CIP has not
been performed within
parameter set time limit
after (de)ballast.

W151 UVR [x]: Trigger: UV sensor Delay: 20 sec. See W152.


UV intensity QT201-50.
signal missing Signal missing. 1. Check fuse F42 in LDC to see
(QT201-50) which circuit that caused the
fuse trip.
2. Use the circuit diagram to
check the fuse setting, adjust
2.1

according to figures in circuit


diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.

39
Control system
40
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

4. Check cables to QT201-50.x.


See the drawing Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram
in chapter 6. Installation
Control system

description and drawings.


5. If the above is OK, the UV
sensor is probably broke and
needs to be replaced. Replace
the component.

W152 UVR [x]: UV Trigger: UV sensor Delay: 30 sec. Note: Operation continues, but
intensity low. QT201-50. does not fulfill the type approval
System flow Comment: The flow certificate. Act according to ballast
reduced. is reduced when UV water plan.
intensity (W/m2) is
below 252 according to See chapter 2. System overview,
IMO legislation. Power section Power optimization.
is set to 100% and the
flow is reduced to 50 Water is dirty or have Check water.
%. low UV transmittance.
It is also possible to fill the reactor
Note: Operation does with fresh water to rule out dirty
not fulfill the type water as reason for the warning.
approval certificate.
2

Act according to ballast Quartz sleeves dirty. Run CIP process, and try again.
water plan.
If problem remains, check and
Comment: An clean quarts sleeves according to
additional common instruction Replace UV lamp and
alarm signal is issued. quartz sleeves in chapter 7.

Note: See chapter 3. Old UV lamps. Check runtime on page 4.3 Timers
Operating instructions in control system. Change if old.
and control system Lamps loose effect when maximum
description, section runtime has been exceeded.
Ballast water handling
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
Transmitter Test the UV sensor:
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID
in the event of 1. Stop the process and restart
malfunction. QT201-50.x the process again.
malfunction.
2. In the control system’s UVR

Book No.9028188 02
popup, see if the UV values are
OK during the start-up phase.
UV values shall be OK, since
clean cooling water is used.
List of alarms and warnings

W153 UVR [x]: UV Trigger: UV reactor. Delay: 30 sec. Note: Operation with faulty LPS
lamp fail. System Parameter: p213 or lamps does not fulfill the type
flow reduced. Comment: If a UV approval certificate. Act according
lamp fails during to ballast water plan.
ongoing operation,
the flow is set 80 % in See chapter 2. System overview,
IMO mode and 50 % section Operation with broken UV
in USCG mode of flow lamp.
capacity.

The UV lamps are lit to


100 %.

After the process, it is


not possible to start a
new process.

Note: See chapter 3.


Operating instructions
and control system
2.1

description, section
Ballast water handling
in the event of
malfunction.

41
Control system
42
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W154 UV intensity Trigger: UV sensor Delay: 20 sec. See W152. Note: Operation continues, but
USCG low. QT201-50. does not fulfill the type approval
System flow Comment: Warning certificate. Act according to ballast
mainted at 50%. issued when UV water plan.
Control system

intensity is below
530 w/m2 according
to USCG legislation.
Power is set to 100%
and the flow is reduced
to 50 %.

Only relevant for


PureBallast USCG
systems.
Note: See chapter 3.
Operating instructions
and control system
description, section
Ballast water handling
in the event of
malfunction.

Comment: An
additional common
2

alarm signal is issued.

W160 UVR [x]: No Trigger: N/A. Delay: 1 sec.


response from Parameter: N/A
LDC. UVR
shutdown.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W161 UVR [x]: LPS Trigger: LPS Delay: 1 sec. Faulty connection of Check the three cable connectors
communication Parameter: N/A electricity or signal on the LPS .
error. UVR cable.

Book No.9028188 02
shutdown.
Wrong LPS setting. Check that the DIP switches
are correctly set for every LPS.
See chapter 4. Parameters,
section Lamp power supply (LPS)
parameters.
List of alarms and warnings

Faulty LPS. Change LPS. See instruction in


chapter 7. Service manual.

W163 UVR [x]: Lamp Trigger: LPS in UV Delay: 20 sec. Broken UV lamp. Change according to instruction in
error feedback reactor’s LDC. chapter 7. Service manual.
from LPS. Parameter: N/A Comment: No lamp
feedback when it is Faulty connection of Check UV lamp power cable.
requested to be started UV lamp cable.
by the LPS.

W164 UVR [x]: LPS Trigger: LPS in UV Delay: 20 sec. Faulty LPS. Check page 4.9 LPS power
error feedback reactor’s LDC. overview and LED indication on the
from LPS. Parameter: N/A Comment: No LPS LPS that triggered the alarm. See
feedback when it is LPS alarms in section Lamp power
requested to start its supply (LPS) on page 50.
lamp. UV reactor is
deactivated If the power is on but there are
no indication, the LPS is probably
broken.
2.1

43
Control system
44
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W165 UVR [x]: LPS in Trigger: LPS in UV Delay: 5 sec. One or more of the Check page 4.9 LPS power
fault state. reactor’s LDC. below: overview and LED indication on the
Parameter: N/A Comment: UV reactor LPS that triggered the alarm. See
is deactivated. • Air temp fault LPS alarms in section Lamp power
Control system

• Driver fault supply (LPS) on page 50.

• Fan fault During commissioning: Alfa


Laval can run a process with one
• Heat sink fault
faulty LPS, to be able to fulfill
• System fault commissioning. Parameter p213
(Allowed nr. of failed UV lamps) is
• Voltage fault
set to 1. Parameter must be reset
• Broken UV lamp to 0. Operation with faulty LPS
or lamps does not fulfill the type
approval certificate.

Fan fault and temperature faults


can be caused by something that
is preventing the fan from rotate.

Change LPS. See instruction in


chapter 7. Service manual.

W170 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause
2

(V201–19) GS201–19. for A17.


Comment: UV reactor
Parameter: N/A is deactivated.

W171 Valve error Trigger: Limit switch Delay: 25 sec. See possible cause
(V201–20) GS201–20. for A17.
Comment: UV reactor
Parameter: N/A is deactivated.

W180 LDC ring Trigger: LDC. Delay: 1 sec. Faulty connection of Check that the power link (LAN)
redundancy signal cable cable from the control cabinet (in a
error Parameter: N/A loop to all LDCs) and back is OK.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Filter sum alarm. Delay: 1 sec. Reset or trun on.


W300 Trigger: Filter. Motor circuit breaker
Parameter: N/A Comment: The (MCB) F1 in control

Book No.9028188 02
feedback signal “Filter cabinet has tripped
SUM alarm” is not or has been switched
detected. off.

Motor problem. 1. Check that the motor is not


overloaded and can rotate
List of alarms and warnings

easily.
2. Start the motor and check
that the operation is normal.
See chapter 3. Operating
instructions and control system
description, section Operate
components manually and
chapter 7. Service manual,
section Check filter gear motor
function.

Mechanical obstacles Check that machanical parts in


the filter can rotate freely. See 7.
Service manual, section Filter for
instructions.

W302 Filter 2 sum Trigger: Filter. Delay: 1 sec. See W300


alarm Parameter: N/A
Comment: Only valid
for systems with two
2.1

Filtrex filter and flow


1200–2000.

45
Control system
46
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

W303 Filter 3 sum Trigger: Filter. Delay: 1 sec. See W300


alarm Parameter: N/A
Comment: Only valid
for systems with three
Control system

Filtrex filter and flow


3000.

W306 Filter differential Trigger: Pressure Delay: 2 sec. Filter is clogged. Backflush manually from control
pressure too transmitter PT201-71 system. If not sufficient, clean
high and PT201-72. the filter element according to
Parameter: p301, instruction in chapter 7. Service
p314. manual.

Valves connected Make sure that the two valves


to filter pressure connected to the filter differential
transmitter closed. transmitter are open.

Pressure transmitters Hint: Pressure signals are


does not work displayed on in the Filter popup
correctly. opened from page 1.1 Overview.

1. Check fuse F45 in Control


cabinet to see what circuit
caused the fuse trip.
2

2. Use the circuit diagram to


check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit
diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

4. Check cables to the


component. See Control
cabinet / Circuit diagram

Book No.9028188 02
in chapter 6. Installation
description and drawings.
5. Check that all electrical
connections are OK and that
the electrical wiring is not
List of alarms and warnings

damaged.
6. Replace faulty transmitter.
7. Restart the process from the
beginning.

W308 Filter pressure Trigger: Pressure Delay: 30 sec. Signal missing 1. Check fuse F42 in LDC to see
signal missing transmitter or component which circuit that caused the
(PT201-71) PT201-71. Comment: Alarm malfunction. fuse trip.
Parameter: p314. deactivated in Standby.
2. Use the circuit diagram to
check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit
diagram if necessary and reset
fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to
locate the component or find
the reason that caused the fuse
trip and attend to it.
4. Check cables to PT201-71. See
2.1

the drawing Control cabinet


/ Circuit diagram in chapter
6. Installation description and
drawings.

47
Control system
48
2.1
Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

5. If the above is OK, the UV


sensor is probably broke and
needs to be replaced. Replace
the component.
Control system

W310 Filter pressure Trigger: Pressure Delay: 30 sec. See W308.


signal missing transmitter
(PT201-72) PT201-72. Comment: Alarm
Parameter: p314. deactivated in Standby.

W312 Filter pressure Trigger: Pressure Delay: 30 sec. See W308.


signal missing transmitter PT309-2
(PT309-2) on Hydac filter. Comment: Alarm
Parameter: p314. deactivated in Standby.

W314 Backflush failed Trigger: Hydac filter. Delay: 15 sec. See W308.
to start (timeout). Parameter: p314.

A315 Diff pressure too Trigger: Pressure Delay: 5 sec. See W306.
high. Automatic transmitter PT201-71
shutdown. and PT201-72. Comment: Pressure
Parameter: p300. transmitters indicates
pressure higher than
set in p300.
2

W501 Log box error Trigger: Log box Delay: 10 sec. Faulty cable Check connections and cable for
(optional). connection. power cable (W10) and Ehternet
Parameter: p500. cable (W104) between Control
cabinet and Log box.

Fuse in the log box Check fuse F02 and F03 in the log
has tripped or has box.
been switched off.
List of alarms and warnings

Book No.9028188 02
2

Alarm Alarm text Trigger / Parameter Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

Faulty setting. Make sure that the setting on the


X20 BC 0083 module is: X16=0,
X1=1

Book No.9028188 02
Error in module. Check the LED error indication for
the electronic modules in the log
box. See section I/O system and
X20 modules on page 54.
List of alarms and warnings

W502 External bypass Trigger: Log box Delay: 10 sec. See A33.
is open (optional).
Parameter: p500. Comment: If
detected by bypass
configuration in page
4.7 Log box.

W503 Heeling mode Trigger: Log box Comment: If See A33.


requested (optional). detected by heeling
Parameter: p500. configuration in page
4.7 Log box.
2.1

49
Control system
2.2 Lamp power supply (LPS) 2 List of alarms and warnings

2.2 Lamp power supply (LPS)


This section explains alarms triggered by and displayed on the lamp power supply (LPS) in the
lamp drive cabinet (LDC). LPS alarms are indicated in the control system by alarm W130 – Sum
alarm LPS unit.

2.2.1 List of alarms and status indications


The table below explains alarms triggered by and displayed in the LPS.

LED indication key

The LPS is equipped whit four light indications:

LPS on and communication is functioning.

5 LPSledG

Flashes (once per second) when processor is running.

5 LPSledG2 Flickering light during modbus communication.


Internal fault. Possible causes:

5 LPSledY
• LPS temperature too high (> 50° C).
• LPS fan faulty.
Lamp error. Possible causes:

5 LPSledR
• Two lamp ignition failures.
• Broken UV lamp.
• Loose cables to UV lamp.
Lamp on.

5 LPSledB

Flickering during lamp ignition, approx 2 seconds when lamp is started.

5 LPSledB2

All lamps on Possible causes:

• Faulty DIP switch setting on one or more LPS. This fault occur after a 10 seconds
delay after start.
• Voltage on the fail safe is missing.

50 Book No.9028188 02
2 List of alarms and warnings 2.3 Flow meter

2.3 Flow meter


This section explains faults and alarms triggered by and displayed in the flow transmitter, mounted
on the flow meter (FIT201-1). During normal conditions, all relevant alarms are displayed in the
PureBallast control panel.

2.3.1 Fault f nding instruction


Always start troubleshooting with the checklist below if faults occur after start-up or during operation.

1. Check the display, as described below.

2. Restart.

3. Check parameter settings according to chapter 4. Parameters, section Flow transmitter


parameters.

4. If the problem cannot be detected or corrected, the flowmeter, its transmitter or display must be
replaced. Follow the instruction in chapter 7 Service manual , section Mount the flow meter.

At installation or if the flow meter or its parts are replaced, internal settings must be checked
and reset according to chapter 4. Parameters, section Flow transmitter parameters

2.3.2 Error messages on the display


Errors which occur during commissioning or measuring operation are displayed immediately. If
two or more system or process errors occur, the error with the highest priority is the one shown
on the display.
The measuring system distinguishes between two types of error:
• System errors: This group comprises all device errors, e.g. communication errors, hardware
faults, etc.
• Process errors: This group comprises all application errors, e.g. empty pipe, etc.

There are two error message types:


• Notice message: Displayed as exclamation mark.
The error in question has no effect on the outputs of the measuring device.
• Fault message: Displayed as a lightning flash.
The error in question has a direct effect on the outputs. Serious system errors are always
recognized by the device as "Fault message", and are shown as a lightning flash on the display.
Fault messages immediately affect the outputs.

Error messages on the display

5 Error messages on the display

Error message on the display

Book No.9028188 02 51
2.4 Level switch 2 List of alarms and warnings

1. Error type; process error or system error


2. Error message type; fault message or notice message
3. Error designation: e.g. EMPTY PIPE = measuring tube is only partly filled or completely empty
4. Error number: e.g. #401
5. Duration of most recent error occurrence (in hours, minutes and seconds)

The table below explains errors displayed on the flow meter display.

Check the display


No display visible and no output 1. Check the supply voltage.
signals present 2. Check the power line fuse.
See chapter 7. Service manual, section Replace display and
fuse for detailed information.
3. Measuring electronics defective.
No display visible, but output 1. Check whether the ribbon-cable connector of the display
signals present module is correctly plugged into the amplifier board.
2. Display module defective.
3. Measuring electronics defective.
Display texts are in a foreign Switch off power supply. Press and hold down both the OS
language. buttons and switch on the measuring device. The display text
will appear in English (default) and is displayed at maximum
contrast.
Error messages on the display
Error messages consist of a variety of icons: the meanings of these icons are as follows (example):
Error type:
S = system error
P = process error
Error message type:

5 Flash

$ = fault message
! = notice message
EMPTY PIPE = Type of error, e.g. measuring tube is only partly filled or completely empty
03:00:05 = duration of error occurrence (in hours, minutes and seconds)
#401 = error number
Error number: System error (device error) has occurred
No. 001 – 399
No. 501 – 699
Error number: Process error (application error) has occurred
No. 401 - 499
351 to 354 S: CURRENT Current output: flow is out of 1. Change the upper or lower
RANGE n range. limit setting, as applicable.
!: # 351 to 354 2. Increase or reduce flow, as
applicable
401 EMPTY PIPE Measuring tube partially filled 1. Check the process conditions
$: # 401 or empty of the plant
2. Fill the measuring tube

2.4 Level switch


This section explains the different status indications on the level switch LS201-29 in the UV reactor.
Alarms and status are indicated by LED:s on the module.

52 Book No.9028188 02
2 List of alarms and warnings 2.4 Level switch

Color State Description What to do?

Green Steady Power on and in operation.

Green Off No power supply. Check plug, cable and power


supply.

Yellow Steady Wet condition.

Red Blinking Error: Internal sensor error or sensor Replace the component.
corroded.

Red Steady Error: Overload or short-circuit in load Rectify the short-circuit.


circuit.
Reduce maximum load current
to below 250 mA.

Book No.9028188 02 53
2.5 I/O system and X20 modules 2 List of alarms and warnings

2.5 I/O system and X20 modules


This section explains the different status indications on the X20 modules. Alarms and status are
indicated by LED:s on the module.

All modules are identified on the front, for example “X20 DO 6529” in the illustration below. To the
right, the stat indication LEDs are visible, for example “r, e, X, I” in the illustration below.

5X20

54 Book No.9028188 02
2 List of alarms and warnings 2.5 I/O system and X20 modules

The following modules are installed in the LDC or control cabinet:

Identif cation Function Installed in cabinet

AI4622 Analogue input Control cabinet

AO2622 Analogue output Lamp drive cabinet

AO4622 Analogue output Control cabinet

CP3585 PLC module (System module CPU) Control cabinet

IF1082-2 Interface module, power link Control cabinet

PS2100 Power feed, 24V Control cabinet

DI9371 Digital input Control cabinet

DO6529 Digital output Control cabinet


Lamp drive cabinet

DO9322 Digital output, 12 outputs Control cabinet


Lamp drive cabinet

AI2622 Analogue input Lamp drive cabinet

AT4222 Temperature input module Lamp drive cabinet

BC0083 Bus controller, power link Lamp drive cabinet

CS1030 Interface module Lamp drive cabinet

DI8371 Digital input Lamp drive cabinet

IF1030 Interface module, RS422/RS485 Control cabinet

PS9400 24V power feed, bus supply Lamp drive cabinet

2.5.1 List of alarms and status indications


Below, alarm and status indications displayed on the modules are explained.

NOTE

• Note that all status indications are not valid for all modules.
• The meaning of a status indication might vary for some modules. These variations are specified
in the Description column.
• Module BC0083, CP3585 and IF1082-2 are described in separate tables below the generic
table.
The table contains the following columns and information:

Book No.9028188 02 55
2.5 I/O system and X20 modules 2 List of alarms and warnings

Light Lights on the module.


Color Description of each light’s color and behavior.
State Different status is indicated by various light states.
Description Meaning of the light state.

Light Color State Description


r Green Off 24 V DC supply not connected, check fuse.
Single flashes Reset mode.
Blinking Preoperational mode.
On RUN mode.
e Red Off Module not supplied or everything is OK.
Single flashes Warning / error for an I/O channel. Level
monitoring for digital outputs has responded.

AT4222: Overflow or underflow of the analog


inputs.
Double flashes Indicates one of the following conditions:
• X2X bus power supply is overloaded.
• I/O supply too low.
• For PS9400: Input voltage for the X2X bus
supply too low.
On Error or reset state.
r+e Red/Green Red - steady / Invalid firmware.
Green - single
flashes
X Orange Off No communication at the X2X bus.
On X2X bus communication in progress.
I Red Off Bus controller / X2X link supply in acceptable
range.
On Bus controller / X2X link supply overloaded.
S Yellow Off No data traffic over service interface; no activity.
On Data is transferred over the service interface.
1–6 Orange On In/output status of the corresponding digital
in/output.
1–8 Green
Output status of the corresponding digital output.
1–12 Orange
In/output status of the corresponding digital
1–12 Green in/output.

1–16 Green In/output status of the corresponding digital


in/output.

Input status of the corresponding digital input.

56 Book No.9028188 02
2 List of alarms and warnings 2.5 I/O system and X20 modules

Light Color State Description


1–2 Green Off The input is switched off.
Blinking Overflow / underflow of the signal, or broken
connection.
On The analog/digital converter is running, values
OK.
1–4 Orange Off Value = 0.
On Value ≠ 0.
Status Green On Interface module is active.
Red On CPU starting up.
RxD Yellow On The module is receiving data via RS485 (or
RS422) interface.
TxD Yellow On The module is sending data via RS485 (or RS422)
interface.
Tx Yellow On For CS1030: The module is sending data via
RS485 (or RS422) interface.
Rx Yellow On For CS1030: The module is receiving data via
(RS485 or RS422) interface.
T Yellow On For CS1030: The terminating resistor integrated
in the module is turned on.

Module BC0083

Light Color Description

L/A IF1 Green On Link to the remote station is established.


L/A IF2 Blinking On and Ethernet activity present on the bus.
S/E Red On Bus controller error: Failed Ethernet frames, increased
number of collisions on the network etc.
Blinking Only during startup. This is not an error.
Green Off Bus controller is either powered of or not active.
Communication is not possible with the bus controller. After
5 seconds in this state, the bus controller restarts.

If POWERLINK communication is detected during


the 5 seconds, the bus controller goes to status
PRE_OPERATIONAL_1 (single flash).

If no powerlink communication is detected, the bus controller


goes to BASIC_ETHERNET state (flickering).
Green On Bus controler in operation.
Green Flickering No Powerlink communication detected by bus controller.
(approx. 10 Hz) In this state you can communicate directly with the bus
controller using UDP.

Book No.9028188 02 57
2.5 I/O system and X20 modules 2 List of alarms and warnings

Light Color Description

If POWERLINK communication is detected in this state, the


bus controller goes to state PRE_OPERATIONAL_1 (single
flash).
Green Single flash Bus controller in PRE_OPERATIONAL_1.
(approx. 1 Hz)
With operation on a POWERLINK V1 master, the bus
controller goes directly into PRE_OPERATIONAL_2.

With operation on a POWERLINK V2 manager, the CN


(Controlled Node) waits for the reception of a SoC frame
and then switches over to PRE_OPERATIONAL_2 (double
flash).
Green Double flash Bus controller in PRE_OPERATIONAL_2.
(approx. 1 Hz)
In this state the bus controller is normally configured by the
manager. A command (POWERLINK V2) or setting the data
valid flag in the output data (POWERLINK V1) then switches
the state to READY_TO_OPERATE (triple flash).
Green Triple flash Bus controller in READY_TO_OPERATE.
(approx. 1 Hz)
In a POWERLINK V2 network, the manager then switches
via command to OPERATIONAL.

In a POWERLINK V1 network, the bus controller then


switches automatically to OPERATIONAL as soon as input
data are present.
Green Blinking Bus controller is in STOPPED.
(approx. 2.5
Hz) No output data is produced and no input data is received.
Only the appropriate command from the manager can enter
or leave this state.

Module CP3585

R/E Green On Application is running.


Red On Service mode.
RD/F Yellow On Service or boot mode.
Red On Over-temperature.

58 Book No.9028188 02
2 List of alarms and warnings 2.5 I/O system and X20 modules

S/E Green Green Red Powerlink OK.


/Red on off
Green Red Fatal and irreparable system error. See control
off on system for alarm or warning. This status can only
be changed by resetting the module.
Blinking The powerlink managing node failed. This error
alternately code can only occur in controlled node operation.
This means that the set station number lies within
the range $01 - $FD.
Green Red System failure according to blinking pattern:
off blink-
ing ●●● — Pause ●●● — Pause: RAM error.

— ●● — Pause — ●● — Pause: Hardware error.


EPL Green On Link to powerlink remote station is established.
Blinking On and Ethernet activity present on the bus.
ETH Green On Link to Ethernet remote station is established.
Blinking On and Ethernet activity present on the bus.
CF Yellow On Flash card OK.
Green On Flash card active.
DC Yellow On CPU power supply OK.
OK Red On Backup battery is empty.

Module IF1082-2

The status/error light is a green/red dual LED. The interface can be operated in two moedes: Either
in Powerlink V mode or as an Ethernet TCP/IP interface. Status light depends on mode. For
TCP/IP mode, only SE green is valid.

Light Color Description


Green Red
L/A X1 Green On Link to the remote station is established.
L/A X2 Blinking On and Ethernet activity present on the bus.
S/E On Off TCP/IP mode: Powerlink interface is operated purely as
an Ethernet TCP/EP interface.

Powerlink mode: Powerlinkt station is running, no errors.


Off On Fatal and irreparable system error. See control system
for alarm or warning. This status can only be changed by
resetting the module.
Blinking alternately The powerlink managing node failed. This error code can
only occur in controlled node operation. This means that
the set station number lies within the range $01 - $FD.
Off Red blinking System failure according to blinking pattern:

●●● — Pause ●●● — Pause: RAM error.

— ●● — Pause — ●● — Pause: Hardware error.

Book No.9028188 02 59
2.5 I/O system and X20 modules 2 List of alarms and warnings

Module DI9371

Light Green Red Description

S Off Off Module not supplied, check fuse.


Single Off Reset mode.
flash
Blink- Off Prepoerational mode.
ing
On Off Run mode.
Off Module not supplied or everything is OK.
Single On Invalid firmware
flash

60 Book No.9028188 02
3 List of problems and solutions

This section contains problems that can occur, but is not indicated by an alarm.

3.1 General problems

Book No.9028188 02 61
62
3.1
Problem Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

1A The system does not start. Main breaker Q1 on control Turn on the breaker and measure that incoming 24 V DC to
The control panel does and LDC cabinet turned off, the control panel is present.
not light up. or power not connected to the
control panel.
General problems

Power turned off at main switch Turn on the power.


board

Fuse F42 tripped. 1. Check fuse F42 in control cabinet to see what circuit
caused the fuse trip.
2. Use the circuit diagram to check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit diagram if necessary and
reset fuse.
3. Use the circuit diagram to locate the component or find the
reason that caused the fuse trip and attend to it.

Fuse F41 in control cabinet 1. Check fuse F41 in control cabinet to see what circuit
tripped. caused the fuse trip.
2. Use the circuit diagram to check the fuse setting, adjust
according to figures in circuit diagram if necessary and
reset fuse.
3

3. Use the circuit diagram to locate the component or find the


reason that caused the fuse trip and attend to it.

Control panel error. Can be Replace control panel.


caused by overheating etc.

Control panel error due to Let the panel dry and try again.
damp.

Book No.9028188 02
List of problems and solutions
3

Problem Description Possible cause What to do?


ID

1B Control panel is not Abnormal operating condition. 1. Restart the control panel: Cut the power by removing the
displaying a normal page. power cable at the back of the control panel. Wait 30
seconds, and reconnect the cable again.

Book No.9028188 02
2. Restart the entire PureBallast system: Cut the power by
switching of the main breaker on the control cabinet. Wait
30 seconds, and switch on the main breaker again.
3. If panel is not OK, it is probably broke and needs to be
replaced. Replace the component.
List of problems and solutions

Wrong software version Check that the HMI and PLC software have the save program
version. This is visible in control system page 4.1 System info .

HMI software problem Re-load the HMI software according to the software Release
note.

1C PureBallast can not be Communication is broken See the What to do column for alarm A93.
controlled or monitored between ISCS and PLC.
from the ISCS’ graphical
user interface via the
remote interface (optional)

1D Error message on the screen.


3.1

5 PanelCommunicationError

These messages can appear alone or in combination. The message does not appear in remote control panels (option).

“PureBallast: Comm Error ...”: Check the following:


• See the What to do column for alarm A91.
Communication is broken between remote control panel
and PLC. • If the electrical and signal cables are disconnected or
broken. See Remote control panel / Circuit diagram.
General problems

63
64
3.1
Problem Description Possible cause What to do?
ID

• If the control cabinet is turned off.


• If the PLC is broken.
If control panels are not used: Remove IP address for Remote
control panel 1 according to instruction is set for the remote
General problems

control panel. See chapter 3. Operating instructions and


control system description, section Set remote control panel
communication.

“Disconnected from ...”: Check the following:


• If the electrical and signal cables are disconnected or
Communication is broken between remote control panel broken.
and main panel.
• If the control cabinet is turned off.
• If the main panel is turned off or broken.
If control panels are not used: See 1D.
3

Book No.9028188 02
List of problems and solutions
3 List of problems and solutions 3.2 Filter

3.2 Filter

Book No.9028188 02 65
66
3.2
5A Backflush sequence Pressure transmitters Dismantle the component and inspect/rinse.
starting error (general) PT201–71 and PT201–72
may be faulty.
Filter

Pressure transmitters
PT201–71 and PT201–72 Error with the pressure gauge Dismantle the component and inspect/attend to.
may be faulty. electric switches.

Valves for air pressure to valve Open the valve (ball cock) connected to V309-1.
V309-1 are closed.

5B Excessive backflushing The filter house is not properly Deaerate using the deaeration valve V201-50 on the filter lid.
or long backflushing deaerated.
sequences (general)
Damaged filter element. Check filter element for damage. Replace if necessary.

Large obstructions have Open the filter and remove the obstructions. See chapter 7.
entered the filter. Service manual, section Filter.

Dirty water See chapter 2. System description, section Backflushing for


different dirt loads.

Dirt build-up in the filter element. Clean the filter element.


3
List of problems and solutions

Book No.9028188 02
3 List of problems and solutions 3.3 CIP

3.3 CIP

Book No.9028188 02 67
68
3.3
6A Insufficient pump capacity Leakage in air hoses or Locate leakage and attend to.
(general). sealings.
CIP

Air pressure too low due to Adjust setting with the manual valve under the valve block on
incorrect setting on valve block the CIP module.
on CIP.

The diaphragm in the CIP pump Examine the pump. See chapter 7. Service manual, section
is broken. Repair CIP pump.

Pump is clogged. Examine the pump. See chapter 7. Service manual, section
Repair CIP pump.

6B Too high consumption Leakage in the CIP tank, CIP Locate leakage and attend to.
of CIP liquid (> 1 cm/UV pump, pipes or UV reactor.
reactor cycle).

6C CIP liquid is not returned Insufficient pump capacity 1. Increase airflow to the pump to increase pump capacity
to CIP tank. (P321-5). with the manual valve under the valve block on the CIP
module.
2. Check that pump P321-5 is functioning correctly. See
problem 6D−6I in this chapter.

Broken valve. Examine the following valves: V571-1, V321-2.x, V320-4.x


and V321-1.
3

Pipe blockage Investigate if there is a pipe blockage.

6D CIP pump does not run • The air pressure is to low Examine the pump and attend to problem. See chapter 7.
Service manual, section Test CIP pump.
• The air connection is
blocked
• Muffler is blocked
• Air valve is defect
• Dirt in the pump chamber
• Diaphragm breakdown
List of problems and solutions

Book No.9028188 02
3

6E CIP pump runs irregularly • Valve balls are blocked Examine the pump and attend to problem.
• Sealings are defect in air
valve or center block
• Diaphragm breakdown

Book No.9028188 02
6F Insufficient CIP pump • Suction connection blocked Examine the pump and attend to problem.
suction or not tight.
• Muffler is blocked
• Valve balls are blocked or
damaged
List of problems and solutions

6G Bad flow or pressure in • Pressure fall in incoming air Examine the pump and attend to problem.
CIP pump
• Suction or air connection
blocked
• Muffler is blocked
• Air valve is defect
• Valve balls worn out/broken
• Air in liquid Diaphragm
breakdown

6H CIP pump leakage Screws on the housing not Tighten the screws.
properly fastened

6I CIP pump muffler leakage Diaphragm breakdown Change diaphragm.


3.3

69
CIP
3.4 Valve V201–8 3 List of problems and solutions

3.4 Valve V201–8

70 Book No.9028188 02
3

8A Signal change has no effect on Faulty air supply Check air supply to the valve and tubing to the actuator.
the actuator position See chapter 7. Service manual, section Proportional
valve for instructions regarding the proportional valve.

Faulty signal • Check input signal to proportional valve.


• Check I/P output.

Book No.9028188 02
8B Signal change results in actuator Connection or signal problem • Check coupling between proportional valve and
running to end positions actuator.
• Check input signal.

Signal and positioning problems. • Inaccurate positioning. Adjust position sensor. See chapter 7. Service manual,
List of problems and solutions

8C
section Calibrate positioner on V201-8.
• Input signal fluctuates.
Check electric connection.
3.4
Valve V201–8

71
Chapter: 6. Technical data and drawings
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40
This publication or any part there of may not
be reproduced or transmitted by any process
or means without prior written permission of
Alfa Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 5
1.1 Ship specif c information 5

2 Technical data 7
2.1 PureBallast system 7
2.2 PureBallast components 8
2.3 Working pressure and pressure drop 10

3 Control system integration 13

4 Drawings 15
4.1 Graphic symbols used in drawings 16
4.2 General drawings 17
4.2.1 Flow chart 17
4.2.2 Technical data 19
4.2.3 Connection list 20
4.2.4 Electrical system layout (2 pages) 27
4.2.5 Instrument air distribution 29
4.2.6 Quality specification / Instrument air 30
4.2.7 Quality specification / Fresh water 31
4.2.8 Quality specification / CIP liquid 32
4.2.9 Material data sheet / UV lamp 33
4.2.10 Safety data sheet / CIP liquid 43

3
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical
data 51
4.3.1 UV reactor (previously called AOT reactor) 51
4.3.2 Filter 52
4.3.3 CIP module (2 pages) 53
4.3.4 Flow transmitter FIT201-1 55
4.3.5 Pressure monitoring device 6 bar system (Incl.
PT201-16, PI201-18, RV201 and 201-15) 56
4.3.6 Pressure monitoring device high pressure system
(Incl. PT201-16, PI201-18, RV201 and 201-15) 57
4.3.7 Valve V201-3 and V201-9 58
4.3.8 Valve V201-32 and V403-35 59
4.3.9 Valve V212-31 (Optional in scope of supply) 60
4.3.10 Control valve V201-8 62
4.3.11 Backflush valve V309-1 63
4.3.12 Sampling device Q201.1 and Q201.2 (3 pages)
(Optional in scope of supply) 64
4.3.13 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC) 67
4.3.14 Control cabinet 68
4.3.15 Remote control panel (Optional) 69
4.3.16 Log box (Optional) 70
4.3.17 Transformer (Optional) 71
4.3.18 Air filter / Filter regulator (Optional) 72
4.3.19 Additional pumps (Optional) 73
4.3.20 Closed cooling unit, LDC / Dimension drawing
(Optional) 76
4.3.21 UV reactor and LDC / Lamp power cable 77

4.4 Electrical drawings 78


4.4.1 Control cabinet / Interconnection diagram 78
4.4.2 Control cabinet / Circuit diagram 85
4.4.4 Control cabinet / Cable list 106
4.4.5 Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Interconnection
diagram 107
4.4.6 Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Circuit diagram 109
4.4.7 Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Cable list 125
4.4.8 UV reactor / Interconnection diagram 126
4.4.9 UV reactor / Circuit diagram 128
4.4.10 UV reactor / Cable list 131
4.4.11 Remote control panel (optional) / Circuit diagram 132
4.4.12 Transformer (optional) / Interconnection diagram 133
4.4.13 Transformer (optional) / Circuit diagram 134
4.4.14 Transformer (optional) / Cable list 135

5 Type approval certif cate 137

4
1 Introduction

This chapter contains technical information about PureBallast together with mechanical and
electrical drawings.

1.1 Ship specif c information


Enter vessel specific information in the table below. This will facilitate reading information and
drawings in this document, since some drawings include information for all system sizes /
dimensions, and the document contains information for options only used by on some vessels.

Data Value

Flange standard (EN or JIS): _______________

Main valve and piping Dimension: ________________

Control valve (201-8) Dimension: ________________

Bypass valve (V212–31) Dimension: ________________

Alfa Laval’s or other. Location: __________________

Cooling water valve (V403-35) Dimension: ________________

Remote operation (optional) Remote control panel (number): _________

Remote interface integration (yes/no): _____

Book No.9028188 02 5
1.1 Ship specific information 1 Introduction
2 Technical data

This section states technical data for the complete PureBallast system and for individual
components. In some cases references are given to data in drawings included in this chapter.

2.1 PureBallast system


The table below states conditions, limit values etc. for the PureBallast system.

Type of data Value

Water requirements See section Quality specification / Fresh water on page 43 and data for
different components in the Connection list on page 20.

Water temperature — UV reactor: Liquid form – 40 °C.

Water temperature — LDC cooling water: Max: 38 °C (± 2 °C).

Water types used in PureBallast:

• Sea water: Used for cooling UV lamps in the UV reactor during


start-up.
• LT (low temperature) fresh water: Used for cooling the lamp drive
cabinet (LDC) during operation.
• Fresh water: Used for flushing and filling up of UV reactors after
treatment.

Salinity of water to be PureBallast water treatment system with can be used in all salinities.
treated

UV intensity power limit The system have been tested and found to give full treatment of the
ballast water when the measured UV intensity (w/m2) is above 380 in
IMO mode or 772 in USCG mode.

Flow range (m3/h) Ballast: 165 → 750

Deballast: 100 → 1000

Stripping: 100 → 333 .

Book No.9028188 02 7
2.2 PureBallast components 2 Technical data

Type of data Value

Power consumption (kW) Lamp drive cabinet

100.0 Power to UV reactor.

Note: PureBallast only use power


needed for treatment. PureBallast
automatically regulates the lamp
power between 50 and 100 % to
secure the treatment efficiency.

Control cabinet

1 Control cabinet including filter


motor.

Control cabinet – Additional power for optional pumps

0.55 Pump P401–1 (optional) for LDC


cooling water.

3.0 Pump P403–1 (optional) for UVR


cooling water.

7.5 Pump P309–1 (optional) for filter


backflush water.

Power: Nominal 400–440 VAC, 50/60 Hz 3 phase.


voltage/Frequency
24VDC - Remote control panel (optional).

Power to LDC: Max Icu 50 KA.

IP rating Minimum rating: IP44.

See dimensional drawing for respective component in section Drawings.

2.2 PureBallast components


The table below states basic information about weight and volume for major component in the
PureBallast system.

8 Book No.9028188 02
2 Technical data 2.2 PureBallast components

For detailed information, see dimension drawings in section Dimension drawings including technical
data on page 51.

Component Type of data Value

UV reactor Weight, empty 330 kg.


(kg)

Volume (l) 190

Remote control panel Weight (kg) 15.


(optional)

Filter Weight, empty 950


with adaptor plates
on flanges (kg)

Volume (dm3) .

CIP module Weight, empty 155.


(kg)

Tank volume (l) 250. Note: Total tank volume is 300, but shall
only be filled to max 250.

Valves Type Instrument air operated.

Book No.9028188 02 9
2.3 Working pressure and pressure drop 2 Technical data

2.3 Working pressure and pressure drop


The table gives a description of system presure range and specific requirements regarding presure
during ballast and backflush operation.

Process Pressure per Comment


component

System pressure range

Working pressure – Standard system: 0–6 bar.


Piping:
High pressure system:

0–9 bar.

Working pressure – 5.5 – 8.0 bar to operate valves and CIP pumps. For detailed requirements,
Instrument air see

• Connection list on page 20.

Pressure during ballast, deballast and stripping

UV reactor: Presure including PureBallast valves.

≤ 0.20 bar

Filter: Max pressure over the filter (only during ballast process) is the default
limit value for parameter p305 (Backflush trigger), which defines maximum
0.15–0.50 allowed differential pressure over the filter before automatic backflush.

Note: This parameter can be adjusted, but only by Alfa Laval during
commissioning.

Total pressure drop: Maximum pressure for PureBallast.

≤ 0.70 bar Note Total pressure drop only includes the PureBallast components, not
the vessel’s piping leading the water to, through and from PureBallast,
since it is installation specific.

Pressure during backf ush (only during ballast process)

Backf ush Required difference between filter inlet “201” and filter backflush outlet
differential “309”.
pressure:

≥ 1.0 bar

10 Book No.9028188 02
2 Technical data 2.3 Working pressure and pressure drop

∆Pressure drop, The pressure drop for backflush pipe 309 is installation specific and must
pipe 309: Calculated be calculated to secure sufficient backflush flow in pipe 309 and to secure
that the ballast water pump can overcome the pressure drop. This is done
during engineering.

The connection list specifies required flow in pipe 309 to be 65 m3/h.

This flow is used to calculate the pressure drop in pipe 309. Note that the
pressure drop includes both static pressure and dynamic pressure (pipe
length, bends, valves etc) for pipe 309.

Total pressure drop: Calculated pressure drop during backflushing give minimum BW pump
Calculated capacity required for PureBallast. If the value is greater than existing pump
capacity, steps must be taken, for example:

• Reduce the total pressure drop by reducing ∆p309. This can, for
example, be done by increasing the pipe diameter or by reducing the
number of bends etc in pipe 309.
• Upgrade to a pump with bigger capacity.

Book No.9028188 02 11
2.3 Working pressure and pressure drop 2 Technical data
3 Control system integration

It is possible to is integrate PureBallast with the vessels ISCS as an option. The purpouse is to
monitor and controll external components on the vessel to make a more smooth integration.

This integration is normally done during installation.

For remote integration, please refer to the following documents, together with the Electrical dwg
- CC.

• Design and installation guide for information about remote control panels, power management
system, external components and GPS integration.
• Remote interface implementation guide
• Logbox installation guide.

Book No.9028188 02 13
3 Control system integration
4 Drawings

This section contains drawings for the PureBallast system. It is divided into three main parts:

• General drawings – overall and principle information for system layout (pipes, components,
electricity, air and water).
• Dimension drawing – detailed component information (dimensions, sizes etc).
• Electrical drawings – detailed electric information (circuit diagrams, cable lists etc).

See the Contents section at the beginning of this chapter to get an overview of included drawings.

Book No.9028188 02 15
4.1 Graphic symbols used in drawings 4 Drawings

4.1 Graphic symbols used in drawings


Symbols used in drawings are according to ISO 14617. Below, a guiding extract is shown.

573644

16 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2 General drawings

4.2.1 Flow chart


Note: If Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional) is installed see flow chart for Closed cooling unit,
regarding item 401 and 402.

Book No.9028188 02 17
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

Closed cooling unit, LDC (Optional) / Flow chart

9021886

18 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2.2 Technical data

9008377

Book No.9028188 02 19
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

4.2.3 Connection list


Note: If Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional) is installed see flow chart for Closed cooling unit,
regarding item 401 and 402.

20 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

9025984_Page_1

Book No.9028188 02 21
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

9025984_Page_2

22 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

9025984_Page_3

Book No.9028188 02 23
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

9025984_Page_4

24 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

9025984_Page_5

Book No.9028188 02 25
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

Closed cooling unit, LDC (Optional) / Connection list

9022489
26 Book No.9028188 02
27
General drawings

         
6+,36<67(0
9HVVHOFRQWUROV\VWHP (OHFWULFDOSRZHU
 :
1RWH:$'$OID/DYDOFDEOHPXVWEHXVHG
GLVWULEXWLRQFHQWUDO
 :
$  : 9$&+]SKDVH /'&Q:$'DUHV\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGHQW 3RZHUSHU/'&FDELQHWDQGUHFRPHQGHG:QFDEOHVL]H
 : 895VL]H :$ [ N:[PPð
 : 895VL]H :$:% [ N:[PPð
 : 895VL]H :$:%:&:' [ N:[PPð
     
5HPRWHFRQWUROSDQHOV
4.2

5, RSWLRQ RSWLRQ


:
9'& $PS : :
N:
5&3 :
%
3XPSGHSHQGHQW
5HPRWHFRQWURO
SDQHO
&& :
895 /'& 895 /'&
9'& $PS
5&3 :
5HPRWHFRQWURO
:$ /DPSGULYH :$ /DPSGULYH
SDQHO :% FDELQHW :% FDELQHW
:$ /'& :$ /'&

5HDFWRU

5HDFWRU
:% :%
:& :&
& :' :'
Electrical system layout (2 pages)

,1 287 ,1 287
*1' *1'
     

9025754_1
:)
:
: :
'
1RWH,I/'&FRQQHFW
:WR/'&287
: :QRWQHHGHG
(
:
: : : : : : : : : : : : : :
3( 3( 3(
*6 *1' *1' )LOWHU *6 *6 *6 *6 *6
&,3XQLW 0 0 0 ),7 37

Book No.9028188 02
a a a
9 9 9 9 9 9 ),7 37
) %\SDVVYDOYH 0 0 0
2SWLRQ 2SWLRQ 2SWLRQ
Drawings

4.2.4
3XPSV RSWLRQDO

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH  SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW 
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
(OHFWULFDOV\VWHPOD\RXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
&DEOHRYHUYLHZ $OID:DOOB)B )(1
$ 0LQFURVVVHFWLRQ
&DEOHQDPH 6RXUFH IURP 7DUJHW WR FDEOHW\SH DOOFRQGXFWRUV IXQFWLRQWH[W
>PP@
4

: 6+,36<67(0 && 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG   N: 3XPSGHSHQGHQW


: && /'&,1 /$1&$7H6KLHOGHGRUEHWWHU 0D[P
: /'&287 /'&,1 /$1&$7H6KLHOGHGRUEHWWHU 0D[P
: && /'&287 /$1&$7H6KLHOGHGRUEHWWHU 0D[P
: 6LJQDOFDEOH   )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH
: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH   )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH
: 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
: 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
%
: 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
: 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
: 6+,36<67(0 /'& 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
: 6+,36<67(0 /'& 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
:$ /'& 895 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
:$ /'& 895 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
:% /'& 895 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
:% /'& 895 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG  
:$ /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
&
:$ /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
:% /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
:% /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
:& /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
:& /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0

9025754_2
:' /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
:' /'& 895 $/)$/$9$/   0D[0
: && ),/7(5 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
: && ),/7(5 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
'
: && &,3 6LJQDOFDEOH  
: && 5&3 /$1&$7H6KLHOGHGRUEHWWHU 0D[P
:) 0XOWLPRGHILEHUXP ,IPRUHWKDQPXVHILEHUFDEOH
: 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
: && 5, RSWLRQ 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
: && ),7 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH  
: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH  
( : && 0 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
: && 0 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
: && 0 3RZHUFDEOHDUPRXUHG  
: && 37 6LJQDOFDEOHVKLHOGHG [ 
General drawings

: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH  


: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH  
: && 9 6LJQDOFDEOH  
)


&XUUHQWSDJH
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH  SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW 
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.2 &XUUHQWSDJH 

28
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2.5 Instrument air distribution

9010001

Book No.9028188 02 29
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

4.2.6 Quality specif cation / Instrument air

553407

30 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2.7 Quality specif cation / Fresh water

590773

Book No.9028188 02 31
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

4.2.8 Quality specif cation / CIP liquid

32 Book No.9028188 02

594956
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2.9 Material data sheet / UV lamp

Book No.9028188 02 33
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

34 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 35
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

36 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 37
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

38 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 39
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

40 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 41
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

42 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

4.2.10 Safety data sheet / CIP liquid

Book No.9028188 02 43
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

44 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 45
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

46 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 47
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

48 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.2 General drawings

Book No.9028188 02 49
4.2 General drawings 4 Drawings

50 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.1 UV reactor (previously called AOT reactor)

Book No.9028188 02 51
9003516
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.2 Filter

52
9024507
Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.3 CIP module (2 pages)

Book No.9028188 02 53
9004714_p1
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

9004714_p2

54 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.4 Flow transmitter FIT201-1

Book No.9028188 02 55
9024584
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.5 Pressure monitoring device 6 bar system (Incl. PT201-16,


PI201-18, RV201 and 201-15)

56
9015501
Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.6 Pressure monitoring device high pressure system (Incl.


PT201-16, PI201-18, RV201 and 201-15)

Book No.9028188 02 57
9011457
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.7 Valve V201-3 and V201-9

9007178

58 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.8 Valve V201-32 and V403-35

9007180

Book No.9028188 02 59
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.9 Valve V212-31 (Optional in scope of supply)


Note: For pipe dimension 600, see drawing 9008461.

9007176

60 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

9008461

Book No.9028188 02 61
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.10 Control valve V201-8

9007182

62 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.11 Backf ush valve V309-1


Note: If backflush pump P309–1 (optional) is installed, this valve is not used.

9025645

Book No.9028188 02 63
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.12 Sampling device Q201.1 and Q201.2 (3 pages) (Optional in scope


of supply)

64 590066 1
Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

590066 2

Book No.9028188 02 65
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

590066 3

66 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.13 Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

9011945

Book No.9028188 02 67
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.14 Control cabinet

9012103

68 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.15 Remote control panel (Optional)

9012094

Book No.9028188 02 69
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.16 Log box (Optional)

9002906

70 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.17 Transformer (Optional)

9029115

Book No.9028188 02 71
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.18 Air f lter / Filter regulator (Optional)

9018092

72 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.19 Additional pumps (Optional)


LDC cooling water pump P401–1 (Optional)

9019602

Book No.9028188 02 73
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

UVR cooling water pump P403–1 (Optional)

9019614

74 Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

Backf ush pump P309–1 (Optional)

9025762

Book No.9028188 02 75
4.3 Dimension drawings including technical 4 Drawings
data

4.3.20 Closed cooling unit, LDC / Dimension drawing (Optional)

76 Book No.9028188 02

9022315
4 Drawings 4.3 Dimension drawings including technical data

4.3.21 UV reactor and LDC / Lamp power cable

9007280

Book No.9028188 02 77
4.4 Electrical drawings 4 Drawings

4.4 Electrical drawings

4.4.1 Control cabinet / Interconnection diagram


SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)


7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP


0RGLILFDWLRQ


'DWH

(;7 &&
6833/<9$&

/ 5 / 5
[

/


0D[IXVH$

/ 6 / 6
: 4

/


1DPH

/ 7 / 7

/


&&


3( 3(
3(

3(
3(
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH
6(780%1%
6(78)(1


/'& &&
2*:+ 2*:+



2* 2*



*1:+ *1:+
&$7H6)873



5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVW

&211(&7,21
,17(5)$&(

%8 %8
),567/'&

:/$1



%8:+ %8:+
; ;



*1 *1



%1:+ %1:+



%1 %1



6+ 6+
6+

6+
5HSODFHGE\

/'& &&


2*:+ 2*:+


2* 2*



&XUUHQWSDJH


*1:+ *1:+
&$7H6)873



&211(&7,21
,17(5)$&(

%8 %8
:/$1
/$67/'&

%8:+ %8:+
; ;


*1 *1



,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP

%1:+ %1:+


%1 %1
&&

6+ 6+
6+

6+

6+,36<67(0 &&
 


 

'RFXPHQW1R



 


 


 


[
306,17(5)$&(

 
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ



 : 


8  [  ;


 


 


 


 


 


 

&XUUHQWSDJH

 &&
3%

78 Book No.9028188 02




SDJH
1H[W
4 Drawings 4.4 Electrical drawings

SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)

7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP
0RGLILFDWLRQ


[
306,17(5)$&(
'DWH

6+,36<67(0 &&
 : 


8  [  ;


1DPH

&&
6+ 6+

3(
3(


2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH
6(780%1%
6(78)(1


6+,36<67(0 &&
 

%%
  ;.

$


&&
 

%%
5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVW

  ;.

$
[
306,17(5)$&(

8 &&
 : 

%%
 [  ;.

$


&&
 

%%
  ;.

$
5HSODFHGE\

6+,36<67(0 &&
 


8   ;




 

 
&&
&XUUHQWSDJH


6+ 6+

3(
3(


,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP

6+,36<67(0 &&
 
&&



 


 


 


 


  


 [ 

(;7(51$/

:
6,*1$/6

 

'RFXPHQW1R



8  [  ;


 


 


 

&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

 


 


 


 


&&


6+ 6+
3(

3(
&XUUHQWSDJH

 &&
3%




SDJH
1H[W

9025776_24

Book No.9028188 02 79
4.4 Electrical drawings 4 Drawings
SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)


7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP


0RGLILFDWLRQ


'DWH

6+,36<67(0 &&
 

%%
  ;.

$
1DPH

&&
 

%%
;.


 

$
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

&&
 

%%
6(780%1%
6(78)(1


  ;.

$
&&
 
[

%%
;.


 
(;7(51$/

:

$
6,*1$/6

8 [ &&
5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVW

 

%%
  ;.

$
&&
 

%%
;.


 

$
&&
 

%%
;.
5HSODFHGE\

 

$
&&
 

%%
;.


 

$
&&
&XUUHQWSDJH

6+ 6+


3( 3(


,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP

),/7(5-% &&
[
),/7(502725

%1 %1
&&

/

:
6833/<

%. %.
/

; *< [ *< ;


/

*1<( *1<(
3(

3(

6+ 6+


'RFXPHQW1R

),/7(5-% &&
$ $


[[
),/7(56,*1$/6

% %


$ : $
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

; % [ % ;


$ $


% %


$ $

% %


6+ 6+
&XUUHQWSDJH

 &&
3%




SDJH
1H[W

9025776_25

80 Book No.9028188 02
81
Electrical drawings

         
&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&
$

6:
;

;

;
;

3(
6RXUFH IURP

          3( 3( 3(         6+ 6+ ,1 287   6+'  
4.4

2*:+

*1:+

%1:+
%8:+

5;

7;
2*

*1

%1
%8
6+

6+

6+

6+
$

$

$
%

%

%







%
&$7H6)873

[
:)

[[

[[
:
[
:

:

:
&
[

[
2*:+

*1:+

%1:+
%8:+

5;

7;
2*

*1

%1
%8
6+

6+

6+

6+
$

$

$
%

%

%








7DUJHW WR

$ % $ % $ % $ % $ &20         6+ 287 ,1 D E 6+ 7;' 5;'


'
&,3

&,3

5&3

5&3

5,

6:
3(

;

;
(

Book No.9028188 02
)
Drawings

&,3&211(&7,21 5(027(&21752/3$1(/ 5(027(3$1(/ *36,17(5)$&( 5(027(,17(5)$&(


/$1&211(&7,21 237,&$/),%(5 &211(&7,21 &211(&7,21


&XUUHQWSDJH
&211(&7,21 237,21$/ 27,21$/
56 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W

9025776_26
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP &XUUHQWSDJH 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&
&&

$
;.

;.

;.

;.

;.
;
4

;

;

;

;
3(

3(
6RXUFH IURP

 6+'     3(   %% $ $   %% $ 3(   %% $ $
6+

6+

6+

6+

6+
$

$

$

$

$
%

%

%

%

%



%
[[

[[

[[
:

:

:

:
[

[
:

&
[

[
6+

6+

6+

6+

6+
$

$

$

$

$
%

%

%

%

%



7DUJHW WR

*1' *1'          3(          3(
'
(;7

(;7

(;7

(;7
5,

),7

9

9

9
;

(
Electrical drawings

)
5(027(,17(5)$&( ),7 9 9 9
&211(&7,21 6<67(0:$7(5 &/26(23(1 &/26( &/26(23(1

27,21$/
56
)/2: 
&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W

9025776_27
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
4.4

82
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
83
Electrical drawings

         
&&

&&

&&

&&

&&
&&

&&

&&

;.

;.
;

;

;

;

;
3(
6RXUFH IURP

   3(    3(    3(   3(   %% $ $
4.4

*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
%1

%1

%1
*<

*<

*<
6+

6+

6+

6+

6+
%.

%.

%.

$

$
%

%


%

[[
:

:
:

:

:

[
[

[

[
&
[

[
*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
%1

%1

%1
*<

*<

*<
6+

6+

6+

6+

6+
%.

%.

%.

$

$
%

%


7DUJHW WR

/ / / 3( / / / 3( / / / 3(        3(
0

0

0
'

(;7

(;7
37

9
0

0

0
(

Book No.9028188 02
)
Drawings

06833/< 06833/< 06833/< 37 9


6<67(035(6685( &/26(23(1


&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W

9025776_28
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP &XUUHQWSDJH 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&

&&
$
;.

;.

;.

;.
4

;

;

;
3(

3(

3(
6RXUFH IURP

%% $ $ 3(   %% $ $      3(      3(
6+

6+

6+

6+



%
:

:

:
[

[

[

[
:
&

[
6+

6+

6+

6+



7DUJHW WR

   3(      3(           3(

6+,36<67(0
'
(;7

(;7

(;7
9

9

9
8
(
Electrical drawings

)
9 9 9 9
&/26(23(1 &/26(23(1 23(5$7,21)(('%$&. 23(5$7,21)(('%$&.

6+,36<67(0 
&XUUHQWSDJH
6+,36<67(0 &&&211(&7,21

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W

9025776_29
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
4.4

84
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
85
Electrical drawings

         
3RZHUFRQGXFWRUVVKDOOEHEODFN
,QVXODWHGHQGIHUUXOHVVKDOOEHXVHGXSWRPPð
PPðDQGXSXVHSLQRUULQJFDEOHOXJ
6WDQGDUG,3&:+0$$$&ODVV
$
6LJQDOFRQGXFWRUVVKDOOEHEOXHPPð
              
4 4 4
$   $   $  
,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,!
&

&

'
        
4.4

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
PPð

PPð

PPð

 %.

 %.

 %.
PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.
%
  

PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.
.
   '   







&
4
.

.

.

  






  









Control cabinet / Circuit diagram

)

.

.

.

7

7

7
&   


9025776_ 1
PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.
'
;   
: 3(
(;732:(56833/<   
[ : %. %1 *< *1<(
6833/<9$& [
0D[IXVH$ / 5 / 6 / 7 3( ),/7(502725
3( 6833/<

),/7(5-%
; / / / 3(
(   
:0 %. %1 *< *1<(
*
),/7(502725
6833/<

0
(;7 / / / 3(
9$&+]
/ / / 3(
3KDVH
0
0
0D[N$ 
3RZHUFRQVXPSWLRQLVSXPSRSWLRQGHSHQGHQW

Book No.9028188 02
5HFRPHQGHGIXVH$
)
),/7(502725

Drawings

6833/< 0
 &XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVW &&  SDJH
4.4.2
(G 6(78)(1  &&
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&RQWUROFDELQHW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         

4

$

$

$
.

.

.

$


4
























4

$
4









PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.


.6
' 
%
        
. . .
'    '    '   


            
) ) ) ) ) ) )
&    &    &    &  &  &  & 
$ $ $
&








PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.
 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

9025776_ 2
$ $ $ $
. . . .
0 $ 0 $ 0 $ 0 $








'
;    ;    ;   
3( 3( 3(


        


: %1 %. *< *1<( : %1 %. *< *1<( : %1 %. *< *1<(

;
[ [ [
(
06833/< 06833/< 06833/<
0

0

0
/ / / 3( / / / 3( / / / 3(
Electrical drawings

0
0 0
0 0
0
     &   %   %   %
  &   %   %   %
  &   %   %   %
  $   %   &   &
,1&/8'(',)%2267(53803 237,21 ,1&/8'(',)%2267(53803 237,21 ,1&/8'(',)%2267(53803 237,21
)
%2267(53803 %2267(53803 %2267(53803


0 0

&XUUHQWSDJH

0

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&RQWUROFDELQHW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4.4

86
4 Drawings 4.4 Electrical drawings

SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)

0RGLILFDWLRQ

3RZHUVXSSO\

4

4

4










XQLW

$
7
)
'DWH

(OHFWURQLFIXVH
 PPð PPð
 /2$'

$&

  %8  %8

/
,&
 6(75(6(7
 67$786

$&

PPð
1DPH

*1' 

/
 1&
 %8

$&



/
PPð

;




 %8

%XVEDU
%XVEDU
  PPð PPð
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

3(
 

*1<( *1<(

3(
$
  

3(

6(780%1%
6(78)(1


23 
 



.6  
 





'&2.


,,1


6:  
  
5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVW

)
(OHFWURQLFIXVH


 /2$'

,&

 6(75(6(7
 67$786
*1' 


 1&
;
%XVEDU


 
5HSODFHGE\

$  


  

;
 
  
;   $  
 


   
$   23  
     
;   .6  
&XUUHQWSDJH

     


.  


  
$  
  
)

;  


9'&SRZHU

(OHFWURQLFIXVH

   
 /2$'
 ;  
,&

 6(75(6(7  
&&


 67$786
*1'  $  
 1&  

;  
  
;

 0  


    
$   ;  
 


  
 
.6  
    
+
    
4
   

'RFXPHQW1R

  
)
   
 
 

6:  


  
)
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ


 
(OHFWURQLFIXVH


 /2$'

,&

 6(75(6(7
 67$786
*1' 
 1&
;

;


 
;  
  



&XUUHQWSDJH

 &&

;
3%








$




 

SDJH
1H[W

9025776_ 3

Book No.9028188 02 87
4.4 Electrical drawings 4 Drawings
SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)


$
0RGLILFDWLRQ

% 5;&3
(


'DWH

$

,)

,)
% 5;,)
(
1DPH

$
% 5;,)


(
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

$
6(780%1%
6(78)(1


% 5;,)
(
,QVWDOOHGLIUHPRWHLQWHUIDFH RSWLRQ

$


% 5;',
)
5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVW

$
% 5;',
)


$
% 5;',
)
5HSODFHGE\

$
% 5;$,
)


$
&XUUHQWSDJH

% 5;$2
$


$
% 5;36


3/&OD\RXW

$
&&

$
% 5;'2
$

$ 
% 5;'2
$

'RFXPHQW1R

$
% 5;'2
$


$
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

% 5;'2
$

$
% 5;'2
$


$
% 5;'2
$
&XUUHQWSDJH

 &&
3%




SDJH
1H[W

9025776_ 4

88 Book No.9028188 02
89
Electrical drawings

         
,1&/8'(',)5(027(&21752/3$1(/ 237,21
;

;

;

;

;

;

;
















$
23
&RQWUROSDQHO 6: &20 9$ 9%
    
/DQ$ /DQ%  
86% 86% ; ; ; ;
4.4

,1 287
7' 5'

86%
%
:)
:/$1 2SWLFILEHUFDEOHPXOWLPRGH
86%
&$7H6)873 FDEOH [—P 5; 7;
'RRU
5; 7;

5&3
:)
&

&&

9025776_ 5
'





:/$1 &RQQHFWWR23/DQ$LIQRWUHPRWHSDQHORSWLRQ :/$1
&$7H6)873  &$7H6)873 FDEOH
;
$ ;  ;  ;  ;  ;  ;  ,)  ,) 
5-
& 9'& 9'& *1' 9'& 9'& *1' ,) ,)
        6+
( (WKHUQHW (3/
,) ,)
:
;&3 ; &$7H6)873
86% 5(027(&21752/3$1(/
,),)
/$1&211(&7,21 2*:+ 2* *1:+ %8 %8:+ *1 %1:+ %1 6+
56
,)
7;' 5;' *1' 86% 86% 6+/' 6+/'
;  ;  ;  ,)  ,)  ;  ; 
9         6+

Book No.9028188 02
86%

5&3
:
)

Drawings

86%

&&
'RRU
 &XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&&38 &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
;

;
:

:
4

$
/'&

/'&
        6+         6+
%
2*:+

2*:+
*1:+

*1:+
%1:+

%1:+
%8:+

%8:+
:/$1 :/$1
2*

2*
*1

*1
%1

%1
%8

%8
&$7H6)873 &$7H6)873
&
; ;

9025776_ 6
        6+         6+
5- 5-
'
:/$1 :/$1
&$7H6)873 FDEOH &$7H6)873 FDEOH
(
$
&
Electrical drawings

(3/ (3/
,) ,)
) ;,)


),567/'&
,17(5)$&(
&211(&7,21

/$67/'&
,17(5)$&(
&211(&7,21
&XUUHQWSDJH
 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&,QWHUIDFH &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4.4

90
91
Electrical drawings

         
*36
,17(5)$&(
$
D E 6+
4.4

%
:
6LJQDO
FDEOH
VKLHOGHG
6+
$

%

[[
&

9025776_ 7
;
9,36&'68%0          6+'
        
6+
'
:
&$%/('68%         
(
$         
& 6+/' 7;'5HV 5;''$7$ 5HV *1' 9P$ 7;'?5HV 5;'?'$7$ 5HV

Book No.9028188 02
5656
) ;,)
Drawings



&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&*36LQWHUIDFH &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
:
:

$
5,
4

   6+
%
:
6LJQDO
FDEOH
VKLHOGHG
& [[ $ $ % 6+

9025776_ 8
; ,1&/8'(',)5(027(,17(5)$&( 237,21
9,36&'68%0          6+'
        
6+
'
:
&$%/('68%         
(
$         
&
Electrical drawings

6+/' 7;' 5;' 5HV *1' 9P$ 7;'? 5;'? 5HV


5HV '$7$ 5HV '$7$
56
) ;,)


&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 3/&5,LQWHUIDFH &XUUHQWSDJH 

92
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
93
Electrical drawings

         
.6

)

;

;








$






4.4

%
    
4 ) ) ) )
$  &  &  &  & 


&

4

9025776_ 9
$ 


'

4
$ 













(
$            
& ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ',

Book No.9028188 02
) ;',
Drawings

6<67(06723)520
6$)(7<5(/$<.6
'&)86(
$/$50
06&2021
)86($/$50
),/7(502725
$/$50
0
$/$50
0
$/$50

&XUUHQWSDJH

0
$/$50
    

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDOLQSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
(;7

9

9

9
9 9 9 9 9

   

   

   

   
       
2SHQ 2SHQ 2SHQ 2SHQ







$
       






4

&ROVH &ROVH &ROVH &ROVH




 
3(

3(

3(

3(
2SHQ


       



2SHQ 2SHQ 2SHQ 2SHQ


         
   

   

   

   
&ORVH &ORVH &ORVH &ORVH &ORVH


       
%
3(
3(
:      : $ % $ % :      :      :      :   
6LJQDO 6LJQDO 6LJQDO 6LJQDO 6LJQDO 6LJQDO
FDEOH FDEOH 3( FDEOH FDEOH FDEOH FDEOH
VKLHOGHG 3(
[ [[ [ [ [ [

































;

;

;

;

;

;

;

;

;

;
&
; ;
& 
; ;
%% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %% $
    %% .
  
;

9025776_10
  
; .
 %% 
. . . . . . . . . . . .
'
  %%
; .
 %% 
 
   
           
; ;

(
:
: (
[ %. %1 5' 2* <( *1 %8 97 [ %. %1 5' 2*
Electrical drawings

$            
& ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ',
) ;',


9
&/26(23(1
9
&/26(
9
&/26(23(1

&XUUHQWSDJH

9
&/26(23(1
9
&/26(23(1
9
&/26(23(1

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 3/&'LJLWDOLQSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 

94
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
95
Electrical drawings

         
6+,36<67(0
(;$03/(&211(&7,21
$
4.4

%
:                         :
6LJQDO 6LJQDO
FDEOH FDEOH
VKLHOGHG VKLHOGHG
[ [
;
& ;

&
; ;
%% $ %% $ %% $ %% $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $ %%  $
%%  
;.
 

9025776_11

.

. . . . . . . . . . . .
'
%%
.


 
           
;
;

(
:
( :
[ <( *1 %8 97 [ %. %1 5' 2* <( *1 %8 97
$            
& ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ', ',

Book No.9028188 02
) ;',
Drawings



(;7(51$/
6<67(06723
(;7(51$/
%<3$6623(1
(;7(51$/
%<3$6623(1
(;7(51$/
%<3$6623(1
(;7(51$/
)(('%$&.
%:3803581

(;7(51$/
)(('%$&.
29(5%2$5'
&XUUHQWSDJH
9$/9(23(1

+((/,1*02'( (;7(51$/
)(('%$&.
675,33,1*3803581

306
*5$17('
306
*5$17('
306
*5$17('
306
*5$17('
&20021

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDOLQSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
(;7
),7 37 37 37
  6,* 6,*
$   3(    
'& '&  '& '&
4

       
%
: %1 %8 :+ %. : %1 %8 :+ %.
: $ $ % % : % $
0)6 0)6
6LJQDO 6LJQDO
[ [
FDEOH FDEOH
VKLHOGHG VKLHOGHG
[[ [[
;    

),/7(5-%
&

9025776_12
:
6LJQDO
FDEOH
'
VKLHOGHG
[[ % $ % $
;       ;    
%XVEDU %XVEDU
 
; ;
 
( 
;









Electrical drawings

;

$            
& $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8,
) ;$,


),7
6<67(0:$7(5
)/2:

37
6<67(035(6685(

&XUUHQWSDJH

37
35(6685(6(1625
37
35(6685(6(1625

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 3/&$QDORJLQSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 

96
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
97
Electrical drawings

         
$ $ ;$2
&
3$: 3$: $28, 3$: 3$: $28,
     
4.4





%
;  
&

9025776_13
'






(
9

9
(;7

Book No.9028188 02
)
Drawings



9

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&$QDORJRXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$ $ ;36
&
4



9,2 9,2 *1'
.
' 
  



% .
' 



.
' 






&
  
(6 .
  ' 

9025776_14









'
.6
6 6 6 6 6
 
 

&

%
$ $ 0









Electrical drawings









;

;

$





;

;
)


32:(5
6833/< 
&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 3/&3RZHUVXSSO\ &XUUHQWSDJH 

98
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
99
Electrical drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
'2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2
           

PLQPPð
4.4

;

























%


 ;

;           3( 3(
5'

0
0
)DQ
&

%/



+



.6

;

9025776_15
[ [
[
'
:            
6LJQDO
FDEOH
[

PLQPPð
(




&,3 $ % $ % $ % $ % $
3( 3(

;

Book No.9028188 02
&20 &20 &20 &20 &20 &20 &20 &20 &20
)
Drawings



3 3 9 9 9 9



&XUUHQWSDJH

9 9 9 ),/7(502725 $/$50 )$1



3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
4

12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20
           























%
;            
&
3(
3(

9025776_16
'
:            
6LJQDO
FDEOH
VKLHOGHG
[
(
Electrical drawings

6+,36<67(0
)


306
5(4
306
5(4
306
5(4

&XUUHQWSDJH

306
5(4
&20021

306
581
306
581

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH

100
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
101
Electrical drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20
           
4.4

 
; $
 















%
%XVEDU

;

;            
&

9025776_17
'
:    
6LJQDO
FDEOH
VKLHOGHG
[
(



























6+,36<67(0

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

Book No.9028188 02
)
Drawings



306
581
306
581
&20021

9

&XUUHQWSDJH

9 9 9



3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
4

12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20
           

$
















%

;

;       ;      
&
3(
3(

9025776_18
: $ % :      
6LJQDO 6LJQDO
FDEOH FDEOH
'
VKLHOGHG VKLHOGHG
[[ [
),/7(5-%

;   3(
: %8 %. %1 :+ *<
( 0)6
[
(;7
Electrical drawings

    
 
)
6+,36<67(0
9


),/7(5
%$&.:$6+
9$/9( 
&XUUHQWSDJH

&20021
:$51,1*
&20021
$/$50
5(48(67/'&
%2267(53

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH

102
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
103
Electrical drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20 12 &20
           
4.4
























%
;            
&

9025776_19
:
'
:         '  
6LJQDO
FDEOH
VKLHOGHG
[
(

Book No.9028188 02
) 6+,36<67(0 6+,36<67(0
Drawings



5(48(67$27
%2267(53
5(48(6767$57
%:3803
5(48(67
23(129(5%2$5'
9$/9( 
&XUUHQWSDJH

385(%$//$67
581
5(48(6767$57
675,33,1*3803

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$ $ ;'2
&
4

$ &20 $ &20 $ &20 $ &20 $ &20 $ &20
           

















% 

;      
.6
' 
&

9025776_20

:







'
%  


;

)

)

)
(
Electrical drawings

)
6+,36<67(0


5(48(67),/7(5
%$&.)/3

&XUUHQWSDJH

3 3 3



3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH

104
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW &XUUHQWSDJH 
105
Electrical drawings

         
$
4.4

%
;.

;.

;.











&

9025776_21
;      3(
3(
'
:      :     
6LJQDO 6LJQDO
FDEOH FDEOH
[ [
(;7 6+,36<67(0
9 8    
     
2SHQ
(
 
&ROVH

3(
3(
  )%VLJQDOWRVKLSVV\VWHP


2SHQ
  )%VLJQDOWRVKLSVV\VWHP

   
&ORVH 9'&IRU)%VLJQDOIURPVKLSVV\VWHP
9
9'&IRUSLORWYDOYHIURPVKLSVV\VWHP

Book No.9028188 02
 
)
Drawings



9
)(('%$&.
&21752/&$%,1(7

9
23(5$7,21)(('%$&.
6+,36<67(0 &&&211(&7,21

&XUUHQWSDJH

9
23(5$7,21)(('%$&.
6+,36<67(0

3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
%\SDVVFRQWURO%\SDVVYDOYHFRQQHFWLRQ &XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$OID:DOOB)B
WRWKHH[WHQWH[SUHVVO\DJUHHGXSRQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWPD\FRQVWLWXWHD
FRQWUDFWXDOREOLJDWLRQRQWKH

&DEOHVXVHGVKRXOGEHVKLSERDUGFDEOHVGHVLJQHG
SDUWRI$OID/DYDO$%RQO\

$
12 7<3( 6RXUFH IURP ,16758&7,21 7DUJHW WR 5(0$5.
DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
4

: [ && 4 (;7 [ )ODPHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&


:/$1 &$7H6)873 && ; 0D[P /'& ; [ )LUHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
:/$1 &$7H6)873 && ; 0D[P /'& ; [ +DORJHQIUHHDFFRUGLQJWR,(& ,(&
: [ && ; 6+,36<67(0 8 [
)OH[LEOHLQVXODWLQJVOHHYLQJDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: [ && ; (;7 9 [
: [ && ; 6+,36<67(0 8 [ 2WKHUHTXLYDOHQWDQGDSSURYHGFDEOHVPD\EHXVHG
: [ && ; 66& 6+,36<67(0 8 [ &DEOHDUHDVDUHFDOFXODWHGZLWKFRUUHFWLRQIDFWRU
: [ && ; 6+,36<67(0 8 [ &RGHGHVLJQDWLRQVIRUFDEOHVREWDLQDEOHWKURXJKFDEOH
RWKHUZLVH RUIRUDQ\SXUSRVHZLWKRXWWKHH[SUHVVHGSHUPLVVLRQRI$OID/DYDO$OID/DYDOZLOOHQIRUFHLWVULJKWVUHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWWRWKHIXOOHVWH[WHQWRIWKHODZLQFOXGLQJ

%
: [ && ;. 6+,36<67(0 8 [ SURGXFHUV1H[DQV6ZHGHQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWDQGLWVFRQWHQWVLVRZQHGE\$OID/DYDO$% SXEO DQGSURWHFWHGE\ODZVJRYHUQLQJLQWHOOHFWXDOSURSHUW\DQGWKHUHWRUHODWHGULJKWV:LWKRXWOLPLWLQJDQ\ULJKWV

: [ && ; ),/7(5-% ; [


:KHUH66&LVLQGLFDWHGLWVKRXOGEHDVLJQDOVKLHOGHGFDEOH
UHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWQRSDUWRIWKLVPD\EHFRSLHGUHSURGXFHGRUWUDQVPLWWHGLQDQ\IRUPRUE\DQ\PHDQV HOHFWURQLFPHFKDQLFDOSKRWRFRS\LQJUHFRUGLQJRU

: [[ && ; 66& ),/7(5-% ; [


: [ && ; &,3 [ ZLWKWKHVKLHOGSURSHUO\FRQQHFWHGWRHDUWKDVVKRZQLQWKH
: &$7H6)873 && ; 0D[P 5&3 ; [ HOHFWULFDOGUDZLQJV
:) [ && 6: 5&3 6: [
: [[ && ; 66& [ 5HFRPHQGDWLRQRIYROWDJHFODVV
: [[ && ; 66& 5, ; [ 5DWHGYROWDJHRISRZHUFDEOHVN9
: [[ && ; 66& (;7 ),7 [ 5DWHGYROWDJHRILQVWUXPHQWDWLRQFDEOHVPLQ9
&
: [ && ; (;7 9 [
: [[ && ; 66& (;7 9 [
: [ && ; (;7 9 [
[&DEOHQRWLQFOXGHGLQ$OID/DYDOGHOLYHU\
: [ && ; 0 0 [
: [ && ; 0 0 [

9025776_30
: [ && ; 0 0 [
: [[ && ; 66& (;7 37 [
Control cabinet / Cable list

: [ && ; (;7 9 [


: [ && ;. (;7 9 [
'
: [ && ; (;7 9 [
(
5(0$5.6
WKHVHHNLQJRIFULPLQDOSURVHFXWLRQ

[ )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH


Electrical drawings

[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQ[PD[[ [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH


[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQFRPPRQDODUP [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6KLHOGHG&$7HRUEHWWHUPXOWLPRGHILEHUXP 5-FRQWDFW :Q RUILEHU/&FRQWDFW :Q)
[ &DEOHFURVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGRQOHQJWKDQGFODVVVRFLHW\UHJXODWLRQV
,IPRUHWKDQRQH/'&:QFRQQHFWVEHWZHHQFDELQHWV :Q7\SH/$1&$7H6)873
)


&XUUHQWSDJH 5,

4.4.4
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78)(1 3XUH%DOODVW &&   &&
SDJH

106
$SSU 6(780%1% &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ &DEOHOLVW &XUUHQWSDJH 
4 Drawings 4.4 Electrical drawings

4.4.5 Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Interconnection diagram


SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)


7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP


0RGLILFDWLRQ


'DWH

(;7 /'&
/ 5 / 5
[

/

/
32:(56833/<

/ 6 / 6
: 4

/

/
1DPH

/ 7 / 7

/

/
/'&


3( 3(

3(

3(
3(
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH
6(78021$
6(78021$


$27 /'&
 


 



 



5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW
(3/$1

 [ 
6,*1$/&$%/(


;$  :$  ;



 



 



 



$27 /'&
6+ 6+
3(

3(
-%$ 3(
5HSODFHGE\


$27 /'&
 
  

  
&XUUHQWSDJH


 

 

 




 





,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP

 



/'&

 
[



6,*1$/&$%/(

;$   ;
:%




 
  

  

 


 


 




 




 

'RFXPHQW1R





 

 
$27 /'&
6+ 6+
3(

3(

-%$ 3(

&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

$27 /'&
 
[



/$03&$%/(

 
:$


 
;% ;


 


 



7RWDOQRRISDJHV 

 /'&
3%



SDJH
1H[W

Book No.9028188 02 581770_18


107
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
/'&E

/'&E

/'&E
/'&D

/'&D
/'&

/'&

/'&

$
4

;

;

;

;
3(

3(

3(

3(
6RXUFH IURP

   3(         3(         3(         3(
6+

6+

6+

6+



%

:'
:$

:&
:%
[

[

[

[
&

581770_19
6+

6+

6+

6+



7DUJHW WR

   3(         3(         3(         3(
'
$27

$27

$27

$27

$27

$27

$27

$27
;%

;%

;%

;%
-%%

-%%

-%%
-%%
(
Electrical drawings

)
/$03&$%/( /$03&$%/( /$03&$%/( /$03&$%/(


&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW /'&    /'&
SDJH

108
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
4.4 0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ ,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
109
Electrical drawings

         
6LJQDOFRQGXFWRUVVKDOOEH
EOXHPPð
; / / / /
6XSSO\EORFN / / / /
$
/ / / /
/ /
PPð

PPð

PPð

/ /
 %.

 %.

 %.

   / /      
PPð

PPð

PPð

4 4 4


 %.

 %.

 %.

     
) )
4.4

,!! ,!! ,!! ,!! ,!! ,!! ,!! ,!! ,!!


              
3(
%
Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Circuit diagram

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
=
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.

 %.
/
/
/

 %.

 %.

 %.

(0&ILOWHU

*1<(
/2$'
/,1(
/ / /






&


7

7

7
; 8 9 : 3(
PPð

PPð

PPð
 %.

 %.

 %.

*1<(



0 ./
   3(
4 )DQ
;7 / / / SKDVH
/,  0 0
'
W V a
6, 
W V
,, 
/2&
/ / /
./ ./
   
1& &20 *1' 9
( :

%8

<(
(;732:(56833/<


[
32:(56833/< / 5 / 6 / 7 3(
;    
(;7
/ / / 3(
9$&

;

;

;

;

;

;

;

;

;

Book No.9028188 02
+]SKDVH



E

E

E
D

D

D





(OHFWULFDOSRZHU







GLVWULEXWLRQFHQWUDO

4

4

4

$

;

$

$

4

4

4

4

4

4
Drawings

)
4.4.6
5&3

6833/<9$& 6833/<
44

&XUUHQWSDJH

)$1&,5&8,7 6833/<
44
6833/<
44

3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW /'&   SDJH

581770_1
(G 6(78021$  /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3RZHUVXSSO\ODPSGULYHFDELQHW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
;
4

;
4

;
4
$ 
4

/ / /
/ / /
/ / /
           
4 4 4
$  $  $ 
,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,!
%

%

&
   3(    3(    3(
%
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
:+

:+

:+
%1

%1

%1
%.

%.

%.
: : :
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
&
:+

:+

:+
%1

%1

%1
%.

%.

%.
/36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36
$ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3(
/DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387
SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU
VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387
  3(   3(   3(   3(   3(   3(
'
:   :   :   :   :   :  
/36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36
[ [ [ [ [ [



(
;            

;

;

;

;
Electrical drawings

;

;

;

;
D

D

D

D
:$ :%
/36FDEOH /36FDEOH
[         [        

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03
)
               

$
$27 ;% 
&XUUHQWSDJH

%
$27 ;%
D
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&   SDJH

110
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581770_2
(G 6(78021$  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3RZHUVXSSO\ODPSGULYHFDELQHW
111
Electrical drawings

         
;
4

;
4

;
4
$ 
 
 
 
       
4 4
$  $ 
4.4

,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,!
&

&

   3(    3(
%
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(
:+

:+
%1

%1
%.

%.

: :
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(
&
:+

:+
%1

%1
%.

%.
/36 /36 /36 /36
$ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3(
/DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387
SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU
VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387
  3(   3(   3(   3(
'
:   :   :   :  
/36 /36 /36 /36
[ [ [ [



(
;        

;

;

;

;
;

;

;

;


;

;

;

;
E

E

E

E
;%

;%

;%

;%
:&
/36FDEOH

Book No.9028188 02
[        

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03
/$03

/$03
Drawings

)
       

D
&XUUHQWSDJH
&
$27 ;%
E
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW /'&   SDJH

581770_3
(G 6(78021$  /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3RZHUVXSSO\ODPSGULYHFDELQHW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
;
4

;
4

;
4
$ 
4

  
  
  
           
4 4 4
$  $  $ 
,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,! ,!
'

'

'
   3(    3(    3(
%
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
:+

:+

:+
%1

%1

%1
%.

%.

%.
: : :
PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð

PPð
*1<(

*1<(

*1<(
&
:+

:+

:+
%1

%1

%1
%.

%.

%.
/36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36
$ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3( $ / / / 3(
/DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387 /DPS ,1387
SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU SRZHU
VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387 VXSSO\ 287387
  3(   3(   3(   3(   3(   3(
'
:   :   :   :   :   :  
/36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36
[ [ [ [ [ [



(
;            
;

;

;

;
Electrical drawings

D

D

D

D
;%

;%

;%

;%
:'
/36FDEOH
[        

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03

/$03
)
       
D
E
&XUUHQWSDJH
'
$27 ;% 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&   SDJH

112
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581770_4
(G 6(78021$  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3RZHUVXSSO\ODPSGULYHFDELQHW
4 Drawings 4.4 Electrical drawings

SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)
E
0RGLILFDWLRQ

)

)

)
$
7











)
PPð
'DWH

(OHFWURQLFIXVH

$&
 %8




/
 /2$'


,&
 6(75(6(7

$&



/
 67$786 PPð
*1' 

$&
 1&


 %8
1DPH

/


%XVEDU
%XVEDU
;


:$

3(
VKLHOGHG



3(
[

6LJQDO

 
FDEOH
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

3(
 
; 

$
    


.


  
6(78021$
6(78021$





.6
    



XQLW
3RZHUVXSSO\
.


   

'&2.



.
    
$

,,1


  



  
$27 :$

$
$




  



   
.6


 




5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW
(3/$1


.6


 



;
 PPð 


  %8



  $  


$


   



[
[

 


'RRU
32:(521
:KLWH
+ /6  
  
.  
    
6 +
   
.
5HSODFHGE\

  

$  


  


.  
  
.6  
  
&XUUHQWSDJH

/36  





 
.  
)

  
.  

(OHFWURQLFIXVH

 

 /2$'



9'&SRZHU

,&

 6(75(6(7 
 67$786 
/'&

*1' 
 1& 

:%
VKLHOGHG


[

6LJQDO


FDEOH




; 

;


  


   




$


 $   




    


 


  4    


.


    


  /6  


$


    



'RFXPHQW1R

  .  


$


    



  
$


   



 
$


 
$27 :%





%

  ;  


$
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

    



+  
$


   



+ 


  
 


*6  
$


  


*6  
$


  



*6  
$


  



*6 
$


 


7RWDOQRRISDJHV 

 /'&
3%



SDJH
1H[W

581770_5

Book No.9028188 02 113


Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$
4

% 5;'2

% 5;$2
% 5;%&

% 5;&6

% 5;$7
% 5;36

% 5;',

% 5;',

% 5;$,
$

$
)

)
$
(

)

)
)
$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$
&
,)
,)
'
(
Electrical drawings

)


&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&   SDJH

114
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581770_6
(G 6(78021$  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&OD\RXW
115
Electrical drawings

         
&&
;

;
:

:

$
&&

&&
4.4

        6+         6+
%
2*:+

2*:+
*1:+

*1:+
%1:+

%1:+
%8:+

%8:+
:/$1 :/$1
2*

2*
*1

*1
%1

%1
%8

%8
&$7H6)873 &$7H6)873
&
; ;
        6+         6+
5- 5-
'
:/$1 :/$1
&$7H6)873 &$7H6)873
(
$
& 5- 5-
(3/ (3/
,) ,)

Book No.9028188 02
;%&
Drawings

)


&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW /'&   SDJH

581770_7
(G 6(78021$  /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&%XV 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
&
$
;36
$
4

9%&;;/ 9%&;;/ *1' 9,2 9,2 *1'


     
%
&
'
(
Electrical drawings









;

;

;
)
3/&32:(5 3/&


6833/< &20021

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&   SDJH

116
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581770_8
(G 6(78021$  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&3RZHUVXSSO\
117
Electrical drawings

         
/36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36 /36
E& E& E& E& E& E& D& D& & & & & & & D& D&
:+

:+
$                
*1' %1

*1' %1
               
               
*1

*1
/36

               
<(

<(
4.4

               
%



.
( 


&

.
) 






'

;

;
(
: :+ *1' %1
$      

Book No.9028188 02
& 7[' 5[' *1' 7[' 5[' *1'
;&6 56
Drawings

)


02'%86
&211(&7,21
/36

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW /'&   SDJH

581770_9
(G 6(78021$  /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&,QWHUIDFH 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
;

;

;







$
4


4




%
:
%  /6


 ,
4 ,,
%  /LTXLG/HDNDJH 
',3
3RLQW6HQVRU 6:,7&+

6(77,1*
4
1&

%


 0ƻ


& 4
D% 

4
D% 

4
E% 

'
4
E% 

4
E% 
.6

.6

)

;







(





Electrical drawings












$ ;        
& ( ( ( ( ( ( ( (
', ', ', ', ', ', ', ',
)
;', 0XOWLOLQH ;

/6
76
7(03+,*+ )86($/$50
/3606
$/$50&,5&8,7 )$1$/$50 :$7(5$/$50

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_10


118
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&'LJLWDOLQSXW
119
Electrical drawings

         
$
4.4

%
.6
;

;

;

;

&












'
(










Book No.9028188 02
$ ;        
& ( ( ( ( ( ( ( (
', ', ', ', ', ', ', ',
Drawings

)
;', 0XOWLOLQH ;

923(1 9&/26( 923(1 9&/26(   76
 
&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_11
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW   /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&'LJLWDOLQSXW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
&
$
$
4

;'2
'2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2 '2
           
%






&











;

'
: %8 %.
0

.
$ [ +HDW
H[FKDQJH
. +
YDOYH
& $ *UHHQ [
/$0321
'RRU

(
Electrical drawings





















;

+

6

;

;

;

;

;

;
)

$&7,9$7(/36 89/$0321 62/(12,'9$/9( 9 9 9

&XUUHQWSDJH
9 9

3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_12


120
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&'LJLWDORXWSXW
121
Electrical drawings

         
;

;






$
4.4

%
&
'
(



$            

Book No.9028188 02
& $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8, $,, $,8 $,8,
;$,
Drawings

)


896(1625
,1387

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_13
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW   /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&$QDORJLQSXW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$ $ ;$2
4

&
$2, $28 $28, $2, $28 $28, $2, $28 $28, $2, $28 $28,
           
%
&


' 
(
Electrical drawings






;

;
)


)$1&21752/

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_14


122
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3/&$QDORJRXWSXW
123
Electrical drawings

         
;

;

;
;








$
4.4


&
. 287
  
3:5
77 77
[ [ [ [ 9'&
   
'
; $ % 3(











:
[ :+ 5'














;

;

.6

.6
(
$            

Book No.9028188 02
& 6HQVRU 6HQVH 6HQVRU 6HQVRU 6HQVH 6HQVRU 6HQVRU 6HQVH 6HQVRU 6HQVRU 6HQVH 6HQVRU
;$7
Drawings

)
/'&$,5 /'&+($7(;&+$1*( $27


7(03(5$785( :$7(57(03

&XUUHQWSDJH

7(03(5$785(,1387

3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_15
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW   /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
3/&7HPSLQSXW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$
4


.
) 
%
.

.
;

;

;

;
































&
.6 77 76 /6 /6
$ $ $ $ 9 9 2 2 7 7 7 7 , , , ,
'
, , , , 0 0 0 0 2 2 2 2
76 76 /6 /6

;















(
Electrical drawings

 $ [ $
6 . 6 .
)  & $ ) [ $ $
5(6(7





'RRU







)









 $

 $

 $




+

;

+

;
 &XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_16


124
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW  /'&
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 6DIHW\UHOD\FLUFXLW
125
Electrical drawings

         
$OID:DOOB)B
WRWKHH[WHQWH[SUHVVO\DJUHHGXSRQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWPD\FRQVWLWXWHD
FRQWUDFWXDOREOLJDWLRQRQWKH

&DEOHVXVHGVKRXOGEHVKLSERDUGFDEOHVGHVLJQHG
SDUWRI$OID/DYDO$%RQO\

$
12 7<3( 6RXUFH IURP ,16758&7,21 7DUJHW WR 5(0$5.
DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: [ /'& 4 (;7 [ )ODPHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
:$ [ /'& ; $27 ;$ [ )LUHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
:% [ /'& ; $27 ;$ [ +DORJHQIUHHDFFRUGLQJWR,(& ,(&
:$ [ /'& ; ,1)250/(1*7+ $27 ;%
)OH[LEOHLQVXODWLQJVOHHYLQJDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
:% [ /'& ; ,1)250/(1*7+ $27 ;%
4.4

:& [ /'& ; ,1)250/(1*7+ $27 ;% 2WKHUHTXLYDOHQWDQGDSSURYHGFDEOHVPD\EHXVHG


:' [ /'& ; ,1)250/(1*7+ $27 ;% &DEOHDUHDVDUHFDOFXODWHGZLWKFRUUHFWLRQIDFWRU
&RGHGHVLJQDWLRQVIRUFDEOHVREWDLQDEOHWKURXJKFDEOH
RWKHUZLVH RUIRUDQ\SXUSRVHZLWKRXWWKHH[SUHVVHGSHUPLVVLRQRI$OID/DYDO$OID/DYDOZLOOHQIRUFHLWVULJKWVUHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWWRWKHIXOOHVWH[WHQWRIWKHODZLQFOXGLQJ

%
SURGXFHUV1H[DQV6ZHGHQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWDQGLWVFRQWHQWVLVRZQHGE\$OID/DYDO$% SXEO DQGSURWHFWHGE\ODZVJRYHUQLQJLQWHOOHFWXDOSURSHUW\DQGWKHUHWRUHODWHGULJKWV:LWKRXWOLPLWLQJDQ\ULJKWV

:KHUH66&LVLQGLFDWHGLWVKRXOGEHDVLJQDOVKLHOGHGFDEOH
UHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWQRSDUWRIWKLVPD\EHFRSLHGUHSURGXFHGRUWUDQVPLWWHGLQDQ\IRUPRUE\DQ\PHDQV HOHFWURQLFPHFKDQLFDOSKRWRFRS\LQJUHFRUGLQJRU

ZLWKWKHVKLHOGSURSHUO\FRQQHFWHGWRHDUWKDVVKRZQLQWKH
HOHFWULFDOGUDZLQJV
Lamp Drive Cabinet (LDC) / Cable list

&
[&DEOHQRWLQFOXGHGLQWKH$OID/DYDOGHOLYHU\
'
(
5(0$5.6
WKHVHHNLQJRIFULPLQDOSURVHFXWLRQ

[ )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH


[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQ[PD[[ [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQFRPPRQDODUP [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6KLHOGHG&$7HRUEHWWHUPXOWLPRGHILEHUXP 5-FRQWDFW :Q RUILEHU/&FRQWDFW :Q)

Book No.9028188 02
[ &DEOHFURVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGRQOHQJWKDQGFODVVVRFLHW\UHJXODWLRQV
,IPRUHWKDQRQH/'&:QFRQQHFWVEHWZHHQFDELQHWV :Q7\SH/$1&$7H
Drawings

)
4.4.7


&XUUHQWSDJH $27
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
/'&  SDJH

581770_20
(G 6(78021$ 3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW   /'&
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&DEOHOLVW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4.4 Electrical drawings 4 Drawings

4.4.8 UV reactor / Interconnection diagram


SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)


7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP


0RGLILFDWLRQ


'DWH

$27 0)6 $27


 
:


9$/9(

 
9 


1DPH

*1<( *1<(

3(

3(


2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

$27 $27
6(78021$
6(78021$


%1 [ %1
23(1&/26(


)(('%$&.


:+ :*6 :+


9 %8 %8 *6



%. %.



5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW
(3/$1

$27 0)6 $27


 
:



9$/9(

 
9 



*1<( *1<(
3(

3(
5HSODFHGE\

$27 $27


%1 [ %1
23(1&/26(


)(('%$&.

:+ :*6 :+



&XUUHQWSDJH

9 %8 %8 *6


%. %.



,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP

$27

$27 $27
[
/(9(/6:,7&+

%1 %1


:+ : :+
/6 %8 %8 





%. %.





'RFXPHQW1R

$27 $27
%1 [ %1
75$160,77(5

:+ : :+

7(03

77 
&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ

%8 %8


%. %.


$27 [ $27


%1 %1
:



6(1625

:+ :+
89

47 


%8 %8



7RWDOQRRISDJHV 

 $27
3%



SDJH
1H[W

126
581771_5
Book No.9028188 02
4 Drawings 4.4 Electrical drawings

SDJH
3UHY

'

&

$
%
(
)

7DUJHW WR 6RXUFH IURP
0RGLILFDWLRQ


[
'DWH

$27 : $27


6(1625

%. %.
89

47 


1DPH

[


$27 $27
2ULJLQDO
$SSU
(G
'DWH

:
6:,7&+

%1 %1
7(03


76 :+ :+ 
6(78021$
6(78021$



%8 %8

%. %.


5HSODFHPHQWRI

3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW
(3/$1

$27 0)6 $27


 
:



9$/9(

 
9 



*1<( *1<(
3(

3(


5HSODFHGE\

$27 0)6 $27


 
:



9$/9(

 
9 



*1<( *1<(
3(

3(
&XUUHQWSDJH


$27 0)6 $27


 
:


,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP


9$/9(

 
$27

9 


*1<( *1<(
3(

3(




'RFXPHQW1R


&XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ


7RWDOQRRISDJHV 

 $27
3%



SDJH
1H[W

581771_6

Book No.9028188 02 127


Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
;

;

;

;
/'&$

/'&%

/'&&

/'&'
/'&

/'&

/'&D

/'&E
$
4

                               
-%%
% ;%                                

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$
:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:$

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%
:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%

:%
&
UV reactor / Circuit diagram

$ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $
'
% % % % % % % % % % % % % % % %
/$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03 /$03
(
Electrical drawings

)
/'&

&XUUHQWSDJH 

4.4.9
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
$27   SDJH

128
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581771_1
(G 6(78021$  $27
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 3RZHUVXSSO\$27
129
Electrical drawings

         
/'&
;
$
/'&

$
       
-%$
4.4

;$        
%
         





&
         
: %1 :+ %8 %. : %1 :+ : %1 :+ %8 %.
0 0 0
[ [ [
'
(
77     76   47  
Ĭ

Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

)


7(03(5$785(
75$160,77(5

7(03(5$785(
&XUUHQWSDJH
6:,7&+
89
6(1625

3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW $27   SDJH

581771_2
(G 6(78021$  $27
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&RQWUROFLUFXLW$27 $ 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
/'&
%
/'&

$
4

             
-%$
% ;$                         
[ + [ +
89/$03 32:(5
[ 21 [ 21
*5((1 :+,7(
3(
&
     3(   3(   3(   3(   3(        












*6

*6
          
%1 %8 %.   *1<(   *1<(   *1<(   *1<(   *1<( %1 :+ %8 %. %1 :+ %8 %.
: : : : : : :*6 :*6
' 0 0)6 0)6 0)6 0)6 0)6 0 0
[ [ [
(
       
Electrical drawings

      3(   3(   3(   3(   3(
  / $ / $ / $ / $
0$; 0,1          
 $  $
32:(5 )$,/85( :(7  $  $
21 )/$6+,1* 6(1625
*5((1 5(' <(//2:
/6 9 9 9 9 9 9*6 9*6
)

9$/9( 9$/9( 9$/9( 9$/9( 9$/9( 23(1&/26( 23(1&/26(
/(9(/6:,7&+      )(('%$&. )(('%$&.
 &XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
$27   SDJH

130
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW

581771_3
(G 6(78021$  $27
4.4 $SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ &RQWUROFLUFXLW$27 %
131
Electrical drawings

         
$OID:DOOB)B
WRWKHH[WHQWH[SUHVVO\DJUHHGXSRQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWPD\FRQVWLWXWHD
FRQWUDFWXDOREOLJDWLRQRQWKH

&DEOHVXVHGVKRXOGEHVKLSERDUGFDEOHVGHVLJQHG
SDUWRI$OID/DYDO$%RQO\

$
12 7<3( 6RXUFH IURP ,16758&7,21 7DUJHW WR 5(0$5.
DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: 0)6 $27  $27 9 )ODPHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
:*6 [ $27 *6 $27 9*6 )LUHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: 0)6 $27  $27 9 +DORJHQIUHHDFFRUGLQJWR,(& ,(&
:*6 [ $27 *6 $27 9*6
)OH[LEOHLQVXODWLQJVOHHYLQJDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: [ $27  $27 /6
4.4

: [ $27  $27 77 2WKHUHTXLYDOHQWDQGDSSURYHGFDEOHVPD\EHXVHG


: [ $27  $27 47 &DEOHDUHDVDUHFDOFXODWHGZLWKFRUUHFWLRQIDFWRU
: [ $27  $27 76 &RGHGHVLJQDWLRQVIRUFDEOHVREWDLQDEOHWKURXJKFDEOH
RWKHUZLVH RUIRUDQ\SXUSRVHZLWKRXWWKHH[SUHVVHGSHUPLVVLRQRI$OID/DYDO$OID/DYDOZLOOHQIRUFHLWVULJKWVUHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWWRWKHIXOOHVWH[WHQWRIWKHODZLQFOXGLQJ

%
: 0)6 $27  $27 9 SURGXFHUV1H[DQV6ZHGHQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWDQGLWVFRQWHQWVLVRZQHGE\$OID/DYDO$% SXEO DQGSURWHFWHGE\ODZVJRYHUQLQJLQWHOOHFWXDOSURSHUW\DQGWKHUHWRUHODWHGULJKWV:LWKRXWOLPLWLQJDQ\ULJKWV

: 0)6 $27  $27 9


:KHUH66&LVLQGLFDWHGLWVKRXOGEHDVLJQDOVKLHOGHGFDEOH
UHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWQRSDUWRIWKLVPD\EHFRSLHGUHSURGXFHGRUWUDQVPLWWHGLQDQ\IRUPRUE\DQ\PHDQV HOHFWURQLFPHFKDQLFDOSKRWRFRS\LQJUHFRUGLQJRU

: 0)6 $27  $27 9


ZLWKWKHVKLHOGSURSHUO\FRQQHFWHGWRHDUWKDVVKRZQLQWKH
HOHFWULFDOGUDZLQJV
&
[&DEOHQRWLQFOXGHGLQWKH$OID/DYDOGHOLYHU\
'
4.4.10 UV reactor / Cable list

(
5(0$5.6
WKHVHHNLQJRIFULPLQDOSURVHFXWLRQ

[ )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH


[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQ[PD[[ [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQFRPPRQDODUP [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6KLHOGHG&$7HRUEHWWHUPXOWLPRGHILEHUXP 5-FRQWDFW :Q RUILEHU/&FRQWDFW :Q)

Book No.9028188 02
[ &DEOHFURVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGRQOHQJWKDQGFODVVVRFLHW\UHJXODWLRQV
,IPRUHWKDQRQH/'&:QFRQQHFWVEHWZHHQFDELQHWV :Q7\SH/$1&$7H
Drawings

)


&XUUHQWSDJH
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 3% 1H[W
SDJH
3XUH%DOODVWSURMHFW $27   SDJH

581771_7
(G 6(78021$  $27
$SSU 6(78021$ &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&DEOHOLVW 7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
6LJQDOFRQGXFWRUVFDQEHPPðLIQRWRWKHUZLVHVWDWHG
6LJQDOFRQGXFWRUVVKDOOEHEOXHLIQRWRWKHUZLVHVWDWHG
,QVXODWHGHQGIHUUXOHVVKDOOEHXVHG
$
4

23
7RXFKSDQHO
4.4.11 Remote control panel (optional) / Circuit diagram

5LQJIRU0
3(
/$1$ /$1%
  *1'
86% &20
%
5


    
6
2Q2II 
'RRU
:86%
&




+
'RRU 2SWLRQDO
6: &20 9$ 9%
  
86% [ [
'RRU
[ :/$1 ; ; ; ;
/&,1 /&287
&$7H6)873 7' 5'
'

*1<( PPð
*1<( PPð
:/$1 &RQQHFWWR23/$1$












&$7H6)873 LI6:LVQRWSUHVHQW
;
5-
(
;     3(         6+

PPð
9

*1<(
Electrical drawings

3( 3(
5LQJIRU0 5LQJIRU0

PPð
*1<(
P
)
5LQJIRU0

&XUUHQWSDJH
3UHY 'DWH  'RFXPHQW1R 5&3 1H[W
SDJH
5&3  SDJH

132
(G 6(78-$'  5&3

9015558
4.4 $SSU 6(78-$' &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
7RWDOQRRISDJHV 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ 5&3
133
Electrical drawings

         
$


7
6RXUFH IURP
4.4

8 9 : 3(
4.4.12 Transformer (optional) / Interconnection diagram

/ 5

/ 7
/ 6

%
:
[

&
;
/ 5

/ 7
/ 6
7DUJHW WR

/ / / 3(
'
([W

Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

)
&URVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGVRQ
VKLSVYROWDJHDQGSRZHU

RI3XUH%DOODVWV\VWHP 
&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 7UDQVIRUPHU 1H[W
SDJH SDJH

9028912_2
(G 6(78-$' 7UDQIRUPHU  
$SSU 6(78-$' &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQGLDJUDP &XUUHQWSDJH 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
Book No.9028188 02
Drawings

         
$
4

%
9WR3XUH%DOODVWV\VWHP
4.4.13 Transformer (optional) / Circuit diagram

8 9 :
7 %ROWVLQVLGHWUDQVIRUPHUFDVLQJ
&
3(
8 9 :
:
[
&URVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGVRQ / 5 / 6 / 7
VKLSVYROWDJHDQGSRZHU
' RI3XUH%DOODVWV\VWHP
(;7
9$&+]3KDVH
6KLSVSRZHU
/ / / 3(
5 6 7
(
Electrical drawings

)

&XUUHQWSDJH 
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 7UDQVIRUPHU 1H[W
SDJH SDJH

9028912_1


134
(G 6(78-$' 7UDQIRUPHU 
4.4 $SSU 6(78-$' &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&XUUHQWSDJH 
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\ &RQQHFWLRQ
135
Electrical drawings

         
$OID:DOOB)B
WRWKHH[WHQWH[SUHVVO\DJUHHGXSRQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWPD\FRQVWLWXWHD
FRQWUDFWXDOREOLJDWLRQRQWKH

&DEOHVXVHGVKRXOGEHVKLSERDUGFDEOHVGHVLJQHG
SDUWRI$OID/DYDO$%RQO\

$
12 7<3( 6RXUFH IURP ,16758&7,21 7DUJHW WR 5(0$5.
DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
: [ 7 ([W ; )ODPHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
)LUHUHWDUGHQWDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
+DORJHQIUHHDFFRUGLQJWR,(& ,(&
)OH[LEOHLQVXODWLQJVOHHYLQJDFFRUGLQJWR,(&
4.4

2WKHUHTXLYDOHQWDQGDSSURYHGFDEOHVPD\EHXVHG
&DEOHDUHDVDUHFDOFXODWHGZLWKFRUUHFWLRQIDFWRU
&RGHGHVLJQDWLRQVIRUFDEOHVREWDLQDEOHWKURXJKFDEOH
RWKHUZLVH RUIRUDQ\SXUSRVHZLWKRXWWKHH[SUHVVHGSHUPLVVLRQRI$OID/DYDO$OID/DYDOZLOOHQIRUFHLWVULJKWVUHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWWRWKHIXOOHVWH[WHQWRIWKHODZLQFOXGLQJ

%
SURGXFHUV1H[DQV6ZHGHQ
7KLVGRFXPHQWDQGLWVFRQWHQWVLVRZQHGE\$OID/DYDO$% SXEO DQGSURWHFWHGE\ODZVJRYHUQLQJLQWHOOHFWXDOSURSHUW\DQGWKHUHWRUHODWHGULJKWV:LWKRXWOLPLWLQJDQ\ULJKWV

:KHUH66&LVLQGLFDWHGLWVKRXOGEHDVLJQDOVKLHOGHGFDEOH
UHODWHGWRWKLVGRFXPHQWQRSDUWRIWKLVPD\EHFRSLHGUHSURGXFHGRUWUDQVPLWWHGLQDQ\IRUPRUE\DQ\PHDQV HOHFWURQLFPHFKDQLFDOSKRWRFRS\LQJUHFRUGLQJRU

ZLWKWKHVKLHOGSURSHUO\FRQQHFWHGWRHDUWKDVVKRZQLQWKH
HOHFWULFDOGUDZLQJV
5HFRPHQGDWLRQRIYROWDJHFODVV
5DWHGYROWDJHRISRZHUFDEOHVN9
& 5DWHGYROWDJHRILQVWUXPHQWDWLRQFDEOHVPLQ9
4.4.14 Transformer (optional) / Cable list

[&DEOHQRWLQFOXGHGLQ$OID/DYDOGHOLYHU\
'
(
5(0$5.6
WKHVHHNLQJRIFULPLQDOSURVHFXWLRQ

[ )HHGEDFN RSHQFORVHVLJQDOIRUE\SDVVYDOYH [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH


[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQ[PD[[ [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6\VWHPVL]HGHSHQGDQW PLQFRPPRQDODUP [[[FDQEHLQWHJUDWHGLQVDPHFDEOH
[ 6KLHOGHG&$7HRUEHWWHUPXOWLPRGHILEHUXP 5-FRQWDFW :Q RUILEHU/&FRQWDFW :Q)

Book No.9028188 02
[ &DEOHFURVVVHFWLRQGHSHQGRQOHQJWKDQGFODVVVRFLHW\UHJXODWLRQV
,IPRUHWKDQRQH/'&:QFRQQHFWVEHWZHHQFDELQHWV :Q7\SH/$1&$7H6)873
Drawings

)


&XUUHQWSDJH
3UHY 'DWH  (3/$1 'RFXPHQW1R 7UDQVIRUPHU 1H[W
SDJH SDJH

9028912_3
(G 6(78-$' 7UDQIRUPHU  
$SSU 6(78-$' &XVWRPHUGHVFULSWLRQ
&DEOHOLVW &XUUHQWSDJH 
4
0RGLILFDWLRQ 'DWH 1DPH 2ULJLQDO 5HSODFHPHQWRI 5HSODFHGE\
4.4 Electrical drawings 4 Drawings
5 Type approval certificate

Book No.9028188 02 137


5 Type approval certificate

TAC USCG 2017_Page_1

138 Book No.9028188 02


5 Type approval certificate

TAC USCG 2017_Page_2

Book No.9028188 02 139


5 Type approval certificate

TAC USCG 2017_Page_3

140 Book No.9028188 02


Chapter: 7. Service manual
System manual — PureBallast 3.1 750
USCG

Book No. 9028188 02, rev. 1


Published By:

Alfa Laval Tumba AB


SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40
This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of Alfa
Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Introduction 7
1.1 Preparations and conditions 7

2 Maintenance schedule 9
2.1 Calibration schedule 11
2.2 Recommended spare parts on board 13
2.3 Serial number information 13
2.3.1 Indicating serial number 13
2.3.2 Example 14

2.4 Placing of serial numbers 15

3 Operate valves manually 19


3.1 Open and close valves manually (CIP
valves) 19
3.2 Open and close valves manually 19
3.3 Lock valve in closed position 20
3.4 Unlock valve 21

4 UV reactor 23
4.1 Safety information 23
4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve 25
4.2.1 Disassemble UV lamp 25
4.2.2 Disassemble quartz sleeve 28
4.2.3 Assemble quartz sleeve 28
4.2.4 Check for leaks after quartz sleeve assembly 29
4.2.5 Assemble UV lamp 29

3
4.3 Internal inspection of UV reactor 30
4.4 Dismount and mount lamp power
supply (LPS) 31
4.5 Test LPS installation 33

5 Filter 35
5.1 Remove f lter cover and f lter element 38
5.2 Mount f lter element and f lter cover 40
5.3 Clean f lter element and pre-f lter 40

6 CIP module 43
6.1 Change and ref ll CIP liquid 43
6.1.1 Change CIP liquid 45
6.1.2 Refill CIP liquid 45

6.2 Repair CIP pump 46


6.2.1 Clean CIP pump 46
6.2.2 Disassemble CIP pump 47
6.2.3 Assemble CIP pump 48

6.3 Test CIP pump 49


6.4 Repair junction box and valve blocks 49
6.5 Repair valve block 49
6.5.1 Change valve body 50
6.5.2 Connect electrical cables to valve block 50
6.5.3 Clean valve block 51
6.5.4 Connect pneumatic hoses to valve block 51

7 Flow meter 53
7.1 Mount the f ow meter 53
7.2 Replace display and fuse 56

8 Valve actuator 59
8.1 Preparations and conditions 60
8.1.1 Tightening torques for actuators 60

4
8.2 Dismount actuator 61
8.3 Mount actuator on valve 61
8.4 Change direction of actuator – without
position sensor (V404–36, V320–4 and
V321–2) 63
8.5 Change direction of actuator – with
switch box (V201–3, V201–9, V201–32,
V212–31 and V403–35) 64
8.6 Change direction of actuator – with
position sensor (201-19 and 201–20) 64
8.7 Change direction of actuator – with
positioner (201–8) 66
8.8 Mount pilot valve on actuator 66
8.9 Adjust valve end position 67
8.10 Adjust valve traveling speed 68
8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8 70
8.12 Adjust cam position on V201-8 74

9 Ball valve 75
9.1 Replace seals in ball valve 75

10 Level switch 77
10.1 Mount level switch 77
10.2 Dismount level switch 78
10.3 Test level switch 78

11 Temperature switch and


temperature transmitter 79
11.1 Mount temperature switch / temperature
transmitter 79
11.2 Dismount temperature switch /
temperature transmitter 80

12 Control panel 81
12.1 Clean control panel 81
12.2 Replace control panel 81

13 Remote control panel (optional) 83


13.1 Mount and connect remote control
panel 83

14 Control cabinet and lamp drive 5

cabinet (LDC) 85
1 Introduction

This chapter contains information and instructions about how to service the PureBallast system.
Instructions are sorted per component. The chapter is opened with a maintenance schedule
covering checks and services that must be performed with specified intervals.

1.1 Preparations and conditions

NGE R
! DA
• Before maintaining the PureBallast system, the power supply must be switched off, to avoid
accidental starts. See instruction Abort operation and deactivate the system in chapter 3.
Operating instructions and control system description.

NOTE

• All maintenance and calibration activities must be recorded in the vessel’s maintenance log.
This is required by the ballast water convention. It is therefore recommended that the activities
in the maintenance and callibration schedules below are entered in the vessel’s general
maintenance system.
• Always read and follow the documentation that are included in shipment of components and
spare parts regarding handling, safety and disposal.
• Electrical welding requirements: Connect the welding unit’s negative lead (work lead) to the
component you will weld, close to the welding area.
• Before maintaining the PureBallast system, the following valves must be locked in closed
position: V201-3, V201-9, and V201-8. See instruction Lock valve in closed position on page 20.
• Follow local regulations for electrical installation and grounding (earthing).
• Follow rules when handling CIP liquid agent, regarding ventilation, personal protection etc.
• Point of contact: To order service or spare parts, contact your local Alfa Laval office. For
more information, see www.alfalaval.com.

Book No.9028188 02 7
1.1 Preparations and conditions 1 Introduction
2 Maintenance schedule

Follow this maintenance schedule to secure performance, safety and durability of the system and
its components. The schedule is sorted per component. The table refers to instructions usable
when performing the respective action.

Component Action Time interval Instructions Notes

General Testrun the Once a month. See 3. Operating If the system, for
system: Run a instructions and some reason, is not
ballast and/or control system operated by normal
deballast process. description. ballast operations,
Follow up with a it needs to be run
CIP process. Manual operation to verify that it is in
of valves: See good condition.
Note: If system is chapter 7. Service
used, but certain manual, section This will also
valves are not Valve actuator. exercise the valves,
used, for example actuators and other
V212–31, those components to
should be opened keep them in good
and closed condition.
manually. For
relief valves,
see Calibration
schedule.

General Inspect for Once a year.


corrosion and
erosion damage.

General Calibration of According to See Calibration


sensors Calibration schedule
schedule

UV reactor Outer inspection Once a year. If necessary, See Spare parts


of seals for change according catalogue for
leakage. to Open UV service kit.
reactor.

Check UV lamps Once a year. See Disassemble See Spare parts


for leakage. quartz sleeve. catalogue for
service kit.

Replace of UV Recommended to See Replace UV 16 UV lamp sets.


lamps. change all lamps lamp and quartz Spare part number:
after 3000 hours of sleeve. 9009521 80
operation.

Book No.9028188 02 9
2 Maintenance schedule

Replace IMO requirement: Sparepart number:


UV sensor Every second year. 9001357 03
(QT201–50) EPA requirement:
Every year.

Filter Inspection and Once a year. See Remove Replace filter


cleaning of filter filter element and element, if
element. pre-filter. damaged.

Cleaning once a See Spare parts


year nomally is catalogue for
enough. But in service kit.
exceptional cases
(vessels trading
very muddy
waters) it might
be necessary to
clean the element
more often than
once year.

Outer inspection Once a year. If necessary,


of seals for change faulty seals.
leakage.

CIP liquid pH value check. Every 3rd months, See Change CIP
whichever comes liquid or Refill CIP
first. liquid.

CIP liquid level Rule of thumb: See Change CIP If the CIP liquid
check. Once every 3 liquid or Refill CIP level is low but the
months. liquid. pH value is below
Depending 3, CIP liquid and
on number of water can be added
UV reactor to fill up the liquid
and ballasting level in the tank.
frequency, the liquid Note: pH value
check might have to must be checked
be performed more afterwards to
regularly. secure correct pH
value.

Replacement of When the pH value See Refill CIP Recommendation


CIP liquid. is higher than pH 3 liquid. to order 2 cans at a
or once a year. time. Part number:
or 596250 01
When the CIP
module has been
inactive for over
one year.

Control of stored Visual inspection See Preparations


CIP liquid. after three years. and conditions
under Change and
refill CIP liquid
instruction.

10 Book No.9028188 02
2 Maintenance schedule 2.1 Calibration schedule

Valve block Control that the Once a year. See chapter 7.


on CIP cables are firmly Service manual,
module attached to the section Connect
terminal strip in electrical cables to
the valve block. valve block.

Valves and Control that Once a year. See chapter 7.


actuators the component, Service manual,
cables and section Valve
hoses are firmly actuator for
attached. instructions.

Power Check power Once a year. See instruction


cables cables screw Power cable check
connections on page .

Control Replace battery in When alarm PLC Automatic check


system PLC module. battery low is when the control
indicated in the cabinet is turned on
control system. and every 24 hours.
or:
After 5 years. The battery is
or: placed in the
Before storage for PLC module in
longer periods. the control cabinet.

2.1 Calibration schedule


Follow this calibration schedule to secure performance of the system and its components. The
schedule is sorted per component.

Interval: Once a year, if nothing else is stated.

Component Informatoin / instruction

Flow meter Every second year.

1. Connect a calibrated portable ultrasonic flow meter close to the flow meter.
2. Establish flow in the system.
3. Compare value indicated in control system and measure equipment.

Book No.9028188 02 11
2.1 Calibration schedule 2 Maintenance schedule

Pressure 1. Connect calibrated portable measure equipment to the measure point


transmitters (screw to the side, under the handle).

Filter: (PT201-71, 2. Open V201-32 from the control system.


PT201-72) PT201-71 and PT201-72

Pressure 3. Compare values indicated for the three transmitters in control system
transmitter and measure equipment.
(PT201-16)
4. Open 403-35 from the control system, and compare again.
Pressure gauge PT201-16
(PI201-18)
5. Open V403-35 to apply pressure to the system.
Pressure service
valve (PT201-15) 6. Adjust handle on PT201-16 to establish pressure to measure point.
7. Compare value indicated in control system and measure equipment.
PI201-18

8. Compare value indicated in pressure gauge and measure equipment.


V201-15

9. If above tests are OK, valve V201–15 is OK.

QT201–50 Not calibrated. The component is replaced. See Maintenance schedule


above.

UV reactor 1. Depressurize and drain the reactor: Remove the drain plug at the bottom
components of the UV reactor.

Temperature TT201–33
transmitter
2. Dismount the transmitter and place in water with known temperature
(TT201-33)
(calibrated measure instrument).
Temperature 3. Compare value indicated in the control system and measure equipment.
switch (TS201-
60) TS201-60

Level switch 4. Dismount the switch and place in water with temperature < 65 ˚C.
(LS201-29) 5. Check that alarm A137 is displayed in the control system.
LS201-29

6. Dismount the sensor and lace it in a glass of water.


7. Check that you get a signal for the UV reactor in the control system.
8. Fill the UV reactor with fresh water.

Temperature Place a calibrated thermometer inside the cabinet and compare after 30
transmitter in minutes.
LDC (TT401)

12 Book No.9028188 02
2 Maintenance schedule 2.3 Serial number information

2.2 Recommended spare parts on board


One of each spare part or spare part kit is recommended to be stored onboard.

UV reactor

UV lamp set Content: 1 UV lamp and 2 O rings

Spare part number: 9009521 80

Quartz sleeve Content: 1 quartz sleeve and 2 O rings


set
Spare part number: 594645 82

Temperature Spare part number: 9006325 02


transmitter

Temperature Spare part number: 9006324 02


switch

Lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

Lamp power Spare part number: 9012146 01


supply (LPS)

CIP module

Spare part set Content: Diaphragm, muffler, ball and O rings

Spare part number: 9004587 80

Filter

Spare part set Spare part number: 9011963 84

2.3 Serial number information


This section describes where the serial number plate is placed on the PureBallast system
components.

Serial numbers shall be used at error reporting and other contacts where a specific component is
discussed.

2.3.1 Indicating serial number


Serial numbers shall be stated, including the following information:

Book No.9028188 02 13
2.3 Serial number information 2 Maintenance schedule

• Serial number for the complete PureBallast system. See label on the side of the control cabinet.
• Serial number for the component in question. If the component is installed on, or in, another
component, the number for the mother component shall be stated.
• Item number for the component. The item number identifies a unique component in the system.
It begins with a letter abbreviation indicating the component type, for example: LS (level switch),
P (pump) and PI (pressure gauge). A complete list of abbreviations is found in chapter 6.
Installation description and drawings, section Connection list.

2.3.2 Example
If the level switch is faulty, the following information shall be stated:

• PureBallast serial number


• Level switch serial number and the serial number for the UV reactor on which the level switch is
installed.
• Item number for the component (LS00000)

14 Book No.9028188 02
2 Maintenance schedule 2.4 Placing of serial numbers

2.4 Placing of serial numbers


The table below indicates the position of the serial number plate per component.

PureBallast water treatment system


Serial number for the complete PureBallast
system.

Electrical cabinets: Control cabinet and LDC


Including breakers.

Placing: Plate inside cabinet.

UV reactor

At the side of the UV reactor, as indicated in the


illustration.

7 AOT Snr

Book No.9028188 02 15
2.4 Placing of serial numbers 2 Maintenance schedule

Filter

Placing: At the side of the filter, as indicated


in the illustration.

7 FilterSnr Filtrex

Lamp power supply

LPSs are installed in the lamp drive cabinet.

NOTE

Version must be stated together with the serial number.


Version is stated on the serial number plate.

Placing: At the front of each LPS.

7 LDC sernr

16 Book No.9028188 02
2 Maintenance schedule 2.4 Placing of serial numbers

Valves and actuators

Serial number plate for various valves are placed


at the side of the actuator. One example is
illustrated to the right.

NOTE

This number shall be used both for the actuator and


the mechanical valve.

7 Valve Snr 591890

Flow meter

(Including flow transmitter and flow sensor)

Placing: At the side of the transmittor housing,


as indicated in the illustration.
7 serial#

NOTE

The serial number for the f ow transmitter is also valid


for the f ow sensor.

Book No.9028188 02 17
2.4 Placing of serial numbers 2 Maintenance schedule
3 Operate valves manually

This section covers instructions on how to open, close and lock/unlock valves manually.

Avoid operating valves manually. Valves are normally operated from page 1.1 Overview in
the control system (manual mode). See chapter 3. Operating instructions and control system
description for instruction.

3.1 Open and close valves manually (CIP valves)


Follow this instruction to manually operate the valves installed in the CIP module: V571-1, V321-4,
V321-1, V460-2, V320-2 and V310-6. Note that the orange diode on the valve body will not light
during manual operation.

Follow the steps below

1. Identify which button (illustrated on page 49) on the valve block that controls the valve. The
lower button operates the inner hose under the valve block, and vice versa. Also see the
sticker under the valve block.

2. Press the button on the valve body with a screw driver to operate the valve.

3.2 Open and close valves manually


Follow this instruction to manually operate valves using the position screw on the pilot valve.

Position 0 Closed (default position). If the position screw is in position 0 and the valve is
closed, it can be manually opened. But if the position screw is in position 0 and
the valve is opened, it cannot be manually closed.
Position 1 Opened.

Follow the steps below

• Air must be connected, but power does not have to be connected.


Follow the steps below

1. If there is limited access to the screw, it is possible to remove the DIN connector.

2. Place a screw driver in the position screw groove.


Note: Some pilote valves have a spring supported plastic screw that is pressed down before
the screw is turned.

Book No.9028188 02 19
3.3 Lock valve in closed position 3 Operate valves manually

3. Turn the screw to desired position.


— Position 1 to open.
— Position 0 to close.

4. When done, turn back the screw to position 0. If the DIN connector was removed, connect it
again.

3.3 Lock valve in closed position


Follow this instruction to lock valves in closed position. These valves are locked mechanically with
two bolts on the actuator.

Preparations and conditions

• Note that the end positions of the end stop bolts are factory adjusted and must not be readjusted.
Follow the steps below

1. Set the valve to closed position from the control system. Control the position indicator, to make
sure. The yellow position indicator is in line with the valve throttle (indicating open when
the position indicator is in line with the pipe).

2. Disconnect power and instrument air. Verify that the valve is not under pressure.

3. Open the padlock (2) on the actuator and remove the safety cover (1) from the bolts (3, 4).

7 576075_lock_manual

4. Measure exactly how far out the end stop bolt (4) is from a reference surface, for example the
actuator house. Make a note of the distance. This information is needed when unlocking
the valve.

5. Open the locking bolt (3) and turn them a couple of turns.

6. Screw the end stop bolt (4) to its bottom position and tighten the locking bolt.

7. Verify that the valve cannot be opened.

20 Book No.9028188 02
3 Operate valves manually 3.4 Unlock valve

8. Slide the safety cover over the end bolts and lock the safety cover with the pad lock.

9. Repeat the above procedure for all valves concerned.

3.4 Unlock valve


Follow this instruction to unlock valves from closed position.

Preparations and conditions

• Note that the end positions of the end stop bolts are factory adjusted and must not be readjusted.
Follow the steps below

1. Disconnect all power and instrument air. Verify that the valve is not under pressure.

2. Open the padlock (2) on the actuator and remove the safety cover (1) from the bolts (3, 4).

7 576075_lock_manual

3. Open the locking bolt (3) slightly.

4. Adjust the end stop bolt (4) to the same position (distance from reference surface) as before
locking the valve, according to the notes made during locking.

NOTE

• It is important to adjust the ends stop bolt to the correct position. Otherwise the actuator
may be damaged.
5. Tighten the locking bolt (3).

6. Verify that the valve can open and close.

Book No.9028188 02 21
3.4 Unlock valve 3 Operate valves manually

7. Slide the safety cover in position over the end stop bolts. Lock the safety cover with the pad
lock.

22 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor

This section covers instruction for service of the UV reactor.

4.1 Safety information


• Do not touch the glass of the UV lamp. Wear gloves and hold the lamp by the ceramic end
parts only. If a lamp is stained on its surface, wipe off the glass with a clean soft piece of cloth
soaked with alcohol. If not, it could cause breakage and shorten lamp life.
• When performing these routines, consider the need for service kits for UV and quartz sleeves,
containing O-rings, lamps, quartz sleeves etc. See Spare parts catalogue.
• Keep the UV lamp in its original protective cover and case when transporting, storing and
disposing of the lamp. Otherwise it could cause injury if the lamp breaks. Do not dispose of
original protective cover and case for the UV lamp, as they should be re-used for storage
and disposal. Mark cases with used UV lamps accordingly, so that they will not be mistaken
for new lamps.

NGE R
! DA
• Always disconnect the PureBallast system from the power supply before disassembling, and
secure it from being switched on.
• Always lock valve V201–9, V201–3 and V201–8 if you open the UV reactor in some way.
See Lock valve in closed position on page .
• UV lamps radiate ultraviolet radiation when lit. Only operate the UV lamp when correctly
installed inside the UV reactor with end caps properly closed.
• Never dismount or handle UV lamps before they are completely cooled down. A hot UV lamp is
under high internal pressure, and the risk of bursting exists. A hot lamp could also cause a
burn if it is touched.
• Before installation, check that the UV lamps and quartz sleeves are not broken.
• UV lamps and quartz sleeves are fragile and can easily become damaged. Exercise great care
when handling them. Do not apply vibrations or shock to the UV lamp. This can cause breakage
and shorten lamp life. Broken glass/quartz can also cause severe cuts. Always use protective
eye glasses and clean cotton gloves when handling UV lamps and quartz glass sleeves.

Book No.9028188 02 23
4.1 Safety information 4 UV reactor

NGE R
! DA
• UV lamps contain a small amount of mercury (less than 0.2 grams per lamp) and must be
handled and disposed of with care. Used lamps UV can be handled and disposed of in the same
way as fluorescent lamps. Please refer to national regulations. If a UV lamp has accidentally
been broken, mercury could be spilt. Remove mercury with a special tool such as a syringe
(or use pure sulphure to bind the mercury for easy collection).

• Do not allow mercury to come in contact with your eyes or skin. Do not inhale mercury fumes.
• Free mercury must be kept in an airtight bottle, and must be disposed of according to
national regulations.
• In case of having inhaled mercury fumes, consult a doctor and follow medical instructions.

24 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor 4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve

4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve

7 AOTexploded2

UV reactor, exploded (principle).

1. Cap
2. Cap nut
3. Bush
4. O-ring (inside bush)
5. Cable connector
6. Allen screw
7. Glass socket
8. O-ring
9. UV lamp
10. Quartz sleeve

4.2.1 Disassemble UV lamp


Follow this instruction to dismount the UV lamps.

Preparations and conditions

• The PureBallast system must be turned off, and the power disconnected.
• After UV lamps have been changed, the runtime must be reset in page control system page 4.4
Operation timers UVR 1–3. Requires login level Advanced operator.

Book No.9028188 02 25
4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve 4 UV reactor

• Wait at least 10 minutes after completed ballast or deballast process, to allow the UV reactor
to cool down to ambient temperature. If the UV lamps are hot they are under internal positive
pressure and may burst if broken.

NG
WARNI
!
• The UV reactor must not be under pressure when dismounting the UV lamps.

NG
WARNI
!
• Burn hazard: UV lamps can be hot and cause burns.
Follow the steps below

1. Unscrew the cap nuts (2) holding the caps (1). There is one nut on each side of the UV reactor
per UV lamp. If required, use a screwdriver on the nut, gently tapping with a hammer to release.

2. Carefully disconnect the two cable connectors (5) in both ends of the UV lamp (9).

7UVlampConnection

3. Carefully draw out the lamp bushes (3) on both sides.

Carefully draw out the UV lamp (9) with the electric cable, by holding the electric cables in
both ends. When pulled out, only hold the UV lamp by the ceramic ends. Immediately after
removal, place the lamp in its protective cover.
If required, use a screwdriver to press on the ceramic end of the lamp inside the bush on the
other side while carefully pulling the electric cable at the other end.

26 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor 4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve

7UVBushScrewdriver

4. Check that the quartz sleeve (10) is not broken.


To disassemble the quartz sleeves, see the instruction Disassemble the quartz sleeve.

5. If the quartz sleeves is not broken, mount the new UV lamp according to the instruction
Assemble UV lamp on page 29. If broken see the Preparations and conditions section above.

Book No.9028188 02 27
4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve 4 UV reactor

4.2.2 Disassemble quartz sleeve


Follow this instruction to disassemble the quartz sleeve.

NG
WARNI
!
• Hot water may escape from the UV reactor when removing the drain plug.
Follow the steps below

1. Close the UV reactor inlet (V201-19.n) and outlet (V201-20.n) valves from the control system
set in manual mode.

2. Depressurize and drain the UV reactor: Remove the drain plug at the bottom of the UV reactor.

3. Disconnect the instrument air, as a safety precaution.

4. Disassemble the UV lamp according to the instruction Disassemble UV lamp on page 25.

5. Loosen the three Allen screws (6) of the glass socket (7) on both sides; just a few turns to
release them.

6. Unscrew the Allen screws completely at one side. Carefully remove the glass socket, to avoid
breaking the quartz sleeve. Then remove the glass socket on the other side.

7. Remove the O-rings (8) on both sides. The O-rings are firmly stuck in their seat, and will be
damaged during removal, but shall be replaced at assembly. Use an angled or hooked O-ring
tool to loosen and remove the O-ring. Be careful to avoid to break the glass.
If the O-ring is hard to remove, try the following:
– Moisten the O-ring with acetone or denatured alcohol.
– Loose the O-ring in a couple of places before removing it.
– Perforate the O-ring to get a good grip.

8. Carefully remove the quartz sleeve (10).

9. Carefully clean the surface and remove any small parts, for example glass or rubber.

4.2.3 Assemble quartz sleeve


Follow the instruction below to assemble quartz sleeve and check for leaks.

Preparations and conditions

• Two new O-rings (8) for each quartz sleeve (10).


• Two new O-rings for each glass socket (7) might be needed.
• Use waxed screws.
• Glass sockets and bushes must be dry and clean before mounting.
Follow the steps below

1. Insert the quartz sleeve (10) in the UV reactor.

28 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor 4.2 Replace UV lamp and quartz sleeve

2. Wet the O-rings (8) with water and slip them over respective side of the quartz sleeve.
Check that the O-ring are positioned evenly on both sides. If not, they may be damaged
and cause leaks.
The O-rings shall not be pressed into position, the glass socket will press them into position
when fastened later.

3. Carefully mount the first glass socket on the quartz sleeve with three Allen screws evenly, but
do not tighten the screws. Note that the waxed screws must be used to avoid seizing.

7QuartzSleeve

4. Once the Allen screws (6) are evenly entered, carefully tighten them evenly to a torque of 7 Nm.

5. Mount the second glass socket.

6. Connect the instrument air.

7. Follow the instruction Check for leaks after quartz sleeve assembly.

4.2.4 Check for leaks after quartz sleeve assembly


Follow the instruction below to secure that there are no leaks that may damage the UV lamps.

Follow the steps below

1. Pressurize the UV reactor with water to between 2 and 4 bar (0.2 and 0.4 MPa).

2. Visually check for leaks.

4.2.5 Assemble UV lamp


Follow the instruction below to mount UV lamps.

Preparations and conditions

• A leakage check must have been performed according to the instruction Check for leaks after
quartz sleeve assembly.
• Use waxed screws.

Book No.9028188 02 29
4.3 Internal inspection of UV reactor 4 UV reactor

• New heat resistant O-rings must be used in the two bushes. Always replace used O-rings.
• Keep the UV lamp in its protective cover as long as possible. Do not touch the glass of the
lamp; hold the lamp by its ceramic end parts.
• Glass sockets and bushes must be dry and clean before mounting.
• After UV lamps hav e been changed, the runtime must be reset in control system page 4.4
Operation timers UVRs.
Follow the steps below

1. Mount the new heat resistent O-rings in the two lamp bushes (3).

2. Place one bush on the UV lamp (9).

3. Insert the UV lamp and bush into the UV reactor.

4. Insert the other bush in the opposite side of the UV reactor.

5. Make sure that the connection is clean to ensure good electric connection (no rust, burning or
fading on the connectors). Reconnect the two cable connectors for the UV lamp.

7UVlampConnection

6. Mount the UV lamp caps and tighten the cap nut at both ends of the UV lamp, by hand only.
Make sure that the electric cable is is not squeezed between the cap and the bush when the
cap is mounted. Slack can be pushed into the bush.

7. Re-fit the drain plugs at the bottom of the UV reactor and/or at the flanges under the UV reactor.

8. Control the control system page 3.1 Alarm list, to make sure there is no alarm when after
the the lamp power supply is on.

4.3 Internal inspection of UV reactor


Follow this instruction to open the UV reactor for internal inspection and cleaning, for example of a
UV lamp or quartz sleeve has been broken.

Preparations and conditions

• The UV reactor must be depressurized and the UV reactor must be emptied from water.

30 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor 4.4 Dismount and mount lamp power
supply (LPS)

7 OpenAOT

1. Access hatch

Follow the steps below

1. Remove the bolts on the access hatch (1).

2. Inspect the bottom of the UV reactor to see if there are any dirt or larger particles. If so, remove.
Note: Be careful not to break the quartz sleeves.

3. Check the sealing. Replace if necessary.

4. Reassemble when done.

4.4 Dismount and mount lamp power supply (LPS)


Follow this instruction to replace a lamp power supply inside a lamp drive cabinet (LDC).

Preparations and conditions

Book No.9028188 02 31
4.4 Dismount and mount lamp power supply 4 UV reactor
(LPS)

NG
WARNI
!

• Switch off the main breaker on the LDC door. The LPS has high voltage/power (600 V)
inside and on the lamp power connector, even when UV lamps are not lit.
• The LDC contains a fan, which can cause injury if in operation.
Follow the steps below

7 LPSmaint

1. Dismount LPS

Release two power connectors at the bottom of the LPS and the signal cable connector
at the top.

2. Loosen the nuts at the bottom (1) and the top (2) of the two rods holding the LPS. If necessary,
loosen nuts for adjacent LPS.

NOTE

Make sure not to drop the washer into the LPS. It may cause short circuit.

3. Pull the handle to remove the LPS.

4. Mount LPS

Set the DIP switches on the LPS according to chapter 4. Parameters, section Lamp power
supply (LPS) parameters.

5. Push the new LPS to the wall of the cabinet.

6. Reconnect the three connectors. Make sure the connectors sit tight.

32 Book No.9028188 02
4 UV reactor 4.5 Test LPS installation

7. Tighten the nuts to attach the LPS.

8. Turn on the fuse to the LPS.

9. Switch on the main breaker on the LDC door and check that both LPS:s function correctly
according to instruction Test LPS installation below.

10. Send the replaced LPS to Alfa Laval for repair.

4.5 Test LPS installation


Follow this instruction to make sure that the installation is OK and safe to use.

Preparations and conditions

NG
WARNI
!
• This instruction must be performed after cable connection. If not hazardous situation may arise
which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

DANGER
!
• Before operating the UV reactor, make sure that there is water in the UV reactor.
Follow the steps below

1. Make sure that the UV reactor breaker is switched off.

2. Check that there is water in the UV reactor(s) (LS201-29). Check the LED on the level switch:
Steady yellow light indicates that there is water in the UV reactor.

3. Switch on the main breaker on the LDC door. Switch on the power to the UV reactor using the
switches on the breaker cabinet(s).

4. Start UV lamps one by one from the control system (set to manual mode). Make sure that the
UV lamps are lit. This is checked in the UV reactor popup and on the LPS.
Note: It can take up to 90 seconds for the lamp to start.

5. Check LEDs on the LPS and the alarm list in the control system. Make sure that no alarms
have been triggered by the LPS.

6. Turn off the lamp.

Book No.9028188 02 33
4.5 Test LPS installation 4 UV reactor
5 Filter

This section covers the instructions for filter service.

Preparations and conditions

These preparations and conditions are valid for all instructions.

• Disconnect the power to the filter, using the main switch on the control cabinet.
• Always lock valve V201–9, V201–3 and V201–8 if you open the filter. See Lock valve in
closed position on page .
• Only perform maintenance and servicing work when the filter is cooled, depressurized and
drained.
• Shut off the air supply to the filter.
• Visually inspect gasket during maintenance. Replace if necessary.
• Lifting device is needed for this instruction.
Filter cover and element weight (kg): 220.

Filter – Exploded view

Book No.9028188 02 35
5 Filter

36 Book No.9028188 02
7 FiltrexExploded
5 Filter

1 Gear reducer
2 Gear shaft
3 Electric motor
4 Thrust bearing flange fixing bolt
5 Gear reducer flange / cover fixing bolt
6 Thrust bearing
7 Backflush shaft bushing gasket
7a Backflush shaft bushing asket
8 Filter vent plug
9 Filter cover
10 Cover bolt
11 Backflush shaft bushing
12 Filter element fixing bolt
13 Filter cover gasket
14 Filter body
15 Filter element
16 Backflush nozzle
17 Filter element gasket
18 Backflush shaft bushing
19 Filter drain plug
20 Backflush line gasket
22 Pressure transmitter
29 Junction box
30 Backflush nozzle support
31 Backflush nozzle fixing bolt
32 Backflush nozzle support gasket
33 Base frame
34 Base frame fixing bolt
40 Ring spear
41 Thrust bearing upper flange
42 Thrust bearing lower flange
43 Seeger
44 Cover lifting lug
45 Rotation indicator
70 Nameplate
80 Prefilter

Book No.9028188 02 37
5.1 Remove filter cover and filter element 5 Filter

5.1 Remove f lter cover and f lter element


Follow this instruction to remove filter cover and filter element.

Follow the steps below

1. Close the following valves: V201-3, V201-32, and V310-2 according to the instruction in
the Operate valves manually on page 19.

2. Unscrew the bolts (5) holding the gear motor (1).


If the electrical cable is short, it might be necessary to disconnect it before removing the motor.

3. Remove the motor (using a lifting device, if necessary). Be careful not to harm the motor
fitting when lifting it from it’s seat.

7 FilterMotor

4. Remove the cover bolts (10) and the lifting lugs (44).

5. Screw two filter cover bolts in the lifting lugs holes until the cover raises slightly from the filter
house.

7 LiftingBolt

38 Book No.9028188 02
5 Filter 5.1 Remove filter cover and filter element

6. Remove the cover bolts and fasten the lifting lugs in their holes again.

7 LiftingLug

7. Fasten a lifting device in the lifting lugs and lift the filter cover (9) with the filter element carefully
out of the filter.
Note: The filter should be lifted in one continuous movement, without sudden jerks – even if
the filter element is slightly stuck in the filter house.

8. Place the filter element on its side.

9. Remove bolts to the bottom shaft support that holds the shaft inside the filter element (15).
Remove it carefully.

10. Remove the seeger ring (43) from the backflush shaft bushing (11).

7 FiltrexSeeger

11. Pull out the backflush shaft bushing. If it is stuck, give a couple of light blows with a wooden
hammer on the top of the shaft to release it.

12. Place the filter element upside-down.

Book No.9028188 02 39
5.3 Clean filter element and pre-filter 5 Filter

13. Unscrew the four Allen screws inside the element to loosen the filter cover.

7 FiltrexAllenS

14. Lift the filter element from the cover.

15. Lift the pre-filter (80) from the bottom of the filter house.

5.2 Mount f lter element and f lter cover


Filter element and cover is mounted in reverse order as described in instruction Remove filter
cover and filter element.

Note:

• Clean the upper inside of the house. The area where the gasket meet the housing should
be clean.
• No force should be used to fit the filter element in the filter house or to fit the motor in its seat.
• Check the gaskets. Replace if necessary.
• Fill up the filter with fresh water after it is mounted.
• There is not need to de-air the filter when it is filled up.
5.3 Clean f lter element and pre-f lter
Follow this instruction to clean the filter element. At the same time, check that the filter element
is in good condition.

Preparations and conditions

• Alpacon descalant offshore may be used as cleaning agent. See Safety data sheet / CIP liquid
in chapter 6. Installation description and drawings.
• Mixing ratio for Alpacon descalant offshore is 1 part concentrated Alpacon descalant to 20 parts
fresh water. Follow this mixing ratio, regardless of recommendation on label.
• Alpacon descalant offshore storage temperature: 0 °C to +55 °C.

40 Book No.9028188 02
5 Filter 5.3 Clean filter element and pre-filter

NG
WARNI
!
• Risk for eye and skin irritation. Avoid contact with eyes and wear protective gloves and goggles.
Follow rules when handling CIP liquid agent, regarding ventilation, personal protection etc.

NG
WARNI
!
• If Alpacon descalant offshore comes in contact with eyes or skin, rinse thoroughly with cold
water.
• The pH value should be approximately 2.0–3.0.
• Proceed with the utmost caution when transporting, assembling, disassembling and cleaning
the filter element.
Follow the steps below

1. Follow the instructions Remove filter element (page 38) to remove the filter element.

2. Rinse the pre-filter with water and a brush.

3. Remove the filter element gasket (17).

4. Soak the filter element in the cleaning agent with the opening facing upwards. Leave it to soak
for 1–4 hours. Let the element dip dry before next step.

5. Place the element in so it does not fall over when cleaning it.

6. Spray the filter element with water (60–80 °C) from the outside, using a flat nozzle. Note: If a
high-pressure cleaner is used, the pressure must not exceed a maximum of 15 bar. If a cleaner
with higher capacity is used, compensate by increasing the distance, minimum 30 cm.

7. Blow the filter element with instrument air (with 10 micron filter or finer), from the outside.

8. 8. Inspect the filter element from the outside with a magnifier to make sure that it is clean. If
needed, repeat the procedure. This time it is enough to let the element soak for 5 minutes.

9. Clean the inside of the filter house.

10. Put the filter element gasket back. Reassemble the rest of the filter.

Book No.9028188 02 41
5.3 Clean filter element and pre-filter 5 Filter
6 CIP module

This section covers instruction for service of the CIP module.

6.1 Change and ref ll CIP liquid


Alpacon descalant is used as cleaning agent in the CIP module. It contains no solvents and no
inorganic acids. It is non-flammable and non-hazardous. See Safety data sheet / CIP liquid in
chapter 6. Installation description and drawings.

Preparations and conditions

ON
CAUTI
!
• Risk for eye and skin irritation. Avoid contact with eyes and wear protective gloves and goggles.
Follow rules when handling CIP liquid agent, regarding ventilation, personal protection etc.

ON
CAUTI
!
• If Alpacon descalant offshore comes in contact with eyes or skin, rinse thoroughly with cold
water.
• Max tightening torque for bolts on flanges: 20 Nm.
• The instructions requires pH test equipment (paper indicator or pH meter). This is not a part of
Alfa Laval’s scope of supply.
• The pH value should be between 2.0 and 3.0. From the beginning, the pH value is approximately
2.0. When the pH value rises to 3.0 the cleaning liquid must be changed.
• Mixing ratio for Alpacon descalant offshore is 1 part concentrated Alpacon descalant offshore to
20 parts fresh water. Follow this mixing ratio, regardless of recommendation on label.
• The CIP tank shall be filled with maximum 250 liters. Min and max filling of CIP liquid can
be read on the CIP tank.
• Alpacon descalant offshore storage temperature: 0 °C to +55 °C.
• Used CIP liquid may contain residues from the cleaning process that can potentially have an
impact on the environment, although this impact is regarded as very small. There are no
transport restrictions.
• Used CIP liquid is drained to one of the following: drain, waste or sludge tank. Do not drain to
bilge. Handle according to local regulations.
• When performing these routines, consider the need for service kits. See Spare parts catalogue.

Book No.9028188 02 43
6.1 Change and refill CIP liquid 6 CIP module

7 CIP

CIP module

1. CIP liquid tank cap


2. Valve block
3. Pump P321–5 (UVR reactor drain)
4. Pump P320–1 (CIP liquid)
4. Drain line with manual valve

44 Book No.9028188 02
6 CIP module 6.1 Change and refill CIP liquid

6.1.1 Change CIP liquid


Follow this instruction to change CIP liquid, when necessary due to high pH value.

Follow the steps below

1. If the drain valve (3) is connected to tank, follow the sub steps below. Otherwise, go to step 2.

a. Open the manual drain valve V460-3 under the CIP tank.
b. Wait for the tank to be totally drained. Then close the drain valve.
2. If the drain valve is not connected to the tank, the steps below can be followed. This operation
requires login level Advanced operator or higher.

a. Open valves V320-2 and V460-2 from the control valve, and V230–11 manually. Start
pump P321-5 (3) and P320-1 (4).
b. Wait for the tank to be totally drained. Then stop the pumps and close the valves in
reversed order. Go to step 3.
3. Open the cap (1) on top of the CIP tank. Fill the tank with approximately 240 liters of fresh
water, almost up to the Max indication on the tank.

4. Pour the CIP liquid into the tank.

5. Measure the pH value in the tank to secure that it is approximately 2.0. If not, adjust the
proportions: If the pH value is too high, add more CIP cleaning agent. Measure again.

6. Go to control system page 4.3 – Operation timers. Make a note of the number of UV reactors
that has been CIPed since last time the CIP liquid was changed. Press the Reset button for
“Total number CIP:ed reactors”. Requires login level Advanced operator. If this is done each
time the CIP liquid is changed, it is possible to build up experience on how many UV reactors it
is possible to CIP before it is time to change CIP liquid.

6.1.2 Ref ll CIP liquid


Follow this instruction to refill CIP the CIP tank when there is low liquid level in the tank.

Follow the steps below

1. Measure the pH value in the tank. Based on the pH value, estimation must be done regarding
the proportions between Alpacon descalant offshore and water. Note that the mixing ratio is
stated under Preparations and conditions above.

2. Mix the cleaning agent with water separately. The result will get better than if mixed mix in
the tank.

3. Pour the mixed CIP liquid into the tank. Do not fill over Max indication on the tank.

4. Measure the pH value in the tank to secure that it is approximately 2.0. If not, adjust the
proportions: If the pH value is still too high, the CIP liquid must be changed. See the Change
CIP liquid instruction in this chapter.

Book No.9028188 02 45
6.2 Repair CIP pump 6 CIP module

6.2 Repair CIP pump


Follow this instruction to repair CIP pump.

Preparations and conditions

ON
CAUTI
!
• Always wear protective eye glasses and gloves while working on the pump.

NG
WARNI
!
• Always disconnect the PureBallast system from the power supply before disassembling, and
secure it from being switched on.
• Before disassembling the pump, the pneumatic hoses must be disconnected, and the extension
pipe must be removed and blocked.
• Drain the pump from liquids.
• The pump should be placed horizontally on a work bench.

7 CIP pump

CIP pump, exploded view

6.2.1 Clean CIP pump


Follow the steps below

46 Book No.9028188 02
6 CIP module 6.2 Repair CIP pump

1. Remove the pump from the CIP tank.

2. Rinse the pump with fresh water.

6.2.2 Disassemble CIP pump


Follow this instruction to disassemble the CIP pump.

6.2.2.1 Disassemble the main parts

Follow the steps below

1. Remove the CIP pump from the CIP module and place it on a work bench.

2. Unscrew the nuts (37) on one side of the housing (11).

3. Place the pump on the side that still has the nuts (the pump lays on the nuts) on a stable ground.

4. Carefully remove the "loose housing" (11).

5. Carefully lift up the suction and discharge connections (13). You have the centre block (12)
and one of the housings with pin screws (14) left.

6. Upend the pump and carefully pull out the pin screws (14). Be careful not to damage the
diaphragms (15).

6.2.2.2 Disassemble the housing

Follow this instruction to disassemble the housing.

Follow the steps below

1. Put the house wall with the flat side down on a plane surface.

2. Remove the spacer sleeve (19), by turning it 180°. To do that:

• Put a piece of plastic towards one side of the spacer sleeve.


• Knock on it so that the spacer sleeve is turning.
• Put one of the pin screws in the hole on the spacer sleeve and turn it until it lays upside
down (180°) compared to the starting position. Pull the spacer sleeve carefully against
the lower valve seat (21) until it is free and can be put out.
3. Stick a something not pointed into the hole for the discharge connection and gently press out
the upper valve seat (20).

4. Place one of the pin screws on the inside (behind) the valve ball stopper on the lower valve
seat (21). Carefully pull out the valve seat in the housing.

5. Remove the valve ball (23) from the valve seat, buy using a pin screw: Press out the valve ball
stopper (22), which will release the valve ball.

Book No.9028188 02 47
6.2 Repair CIP pump 6 CIP module

6.2.2.3 Disassemble the center block

Follow this instruction to disassemble the centre block.

Preparations and conditions

• Have backup spares of the sealing (36) and backup O-ring (47). There is a risk that these parts
get damaged during this operation.
Follow the steps below

1. Press the diaphragms (15) to their neutral position (both have the same distance to the
centre block).

2. Hold one of the diaphragms (15) and unscrew the other. Then pull out the remaining diaphragm
with the diaphragm shaft (16).

3. Disassemble the circlips (27) which keep the air valve (61) on its place.

4. Press out the air valve. A wood shaft of a hammer can be used. Be careful not to damage the
sealing edges towards the diaphragm or the air valve.

5. If the shaft sealings (36) seem to be worn out, carefully remove them with a pointed tool.

6.2.3 Assemble CIP pump


Follow the instructions below to assemble the CIP pump.

6.2.3.1 Assemble center block

Follow the steps below

1. Mount the circlip (27) on one side.

2. Apply some soft soap solution on the air valve O-rings (30).

3. Push the air valve (61) into the housing. Make sure that the O-rings (30) remain in the right
position. Put the circlip (27) on the other side.

4. Put the diaphragm (15) with shaft (16) into the centre block. Screw the next diaphragm (15)
onto the shaft (16) and fix the holes.

6.2.3.2 Assemble the main parts

Follow the steps below

1. Make sure that the O-rings (18) are placed on the in/outlet (13) before assembling of pump.

2. Turn the housing (11) with the flat side up.

3. Make sure all pin screws (14) have one nut (37) and one washer (38) each. Nut should only be
put on one or two threads.

4. Put all the pin screws through the housing and then turn the housing so it rests on the nuts.

48 Book No.9028188 02
6 CIP module 6.5 Repair valve block

5. Put the centre block (12) to the housing with screws through the centre block. Be careful not to
damage the diaphragms.

6. Place suction and discharge connections (13) in their positions in the housing. Be careful not
to damage the O-rings (18).

7. Put the second housing (11) onto the pin screws (14). Make sure that suction/discharge
connections are in right direction. Be careful with the O-rings.

8. Fasten the nuts (37) crosswise by hand, with or without washers depending on how much of
the thread comes out. Turn the nuts gently with a tool to close the pump. If some of the nuts
were fastened without washer, unscrew those and put washers underneath. After a few weeks
operation a follow up draft of the nuts is recommended.

6.3 Test CIP pump


Follow the instruction below to verify that the CIP motor is functioning.

1. Open valves V320-2 and V460-2 from the control system, and V230–11 manually. Start
pump P321-5 (4) and P320-1 (4).

2. Observe if the motors sound and functions OK. If not, check installation and connections and
attend to and test again.

3. Stop the pumps and close the valves in reversed order.

6.4 Repair junction box and valve blocks


Read the conditions below before reparing the junction box or valve blocks.

6.5 Repair valve block


Follow this instruction to repair the valve block, mounted on the CIP module.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve bodies does not have individual placing, they can be placed in any order.

DANGER
!
• Always disconnect the PureBallast system from the power and air supply before disassembling,
and secure it from being switched on.

Book No.9028188 02 49
6.5 Repair valve block 6 CIP module

7 Valve block

Valve block

1. Cover (Terminal strip inside)


2. Valve body
3. Button to operate valve
4. Signal plate
5. Cable gland

6.5.1 Change valve body


Follow the steps below

1. Remove the scresw holding the valve bodies (2) and the signal plate (4).

2. Unscrew the screws holding the valve body (2).

3. Lift the valve body.

4. Attach a new sealing on the new valve body and fasten the valve body to the valve block.

6.5.2 Connect electrical cables to valve block


Follow this instruction to connect the electrical cable from the control cabinet to the CIP valve block.

Follow the steps below

50 Book No.9028188 02
6 CIP module 6.5 Repair valve block

1. Open the cover (1) on the front.

2. Attach the cables according to electrical drawing Control cabinet / interconnection diagram in
chapter 6. Installation description and drawings.

3. Fasten the cable to the cable gland (5).

4. Fasten the cover (1).

6.5.3 Clean valve block


Follow this instruction to clean the valve block house from dirt.

Follow the steps below

1. Disconnect the outgoing air hoses from the valve block.

2. Operate the service air according to instruction Open and close valves manually (CIP valves)
on page 19 to blow out the dust.

3. Connect the air hoses again.

6.5.4 Connect pneumatic hoses to valve block


Follow this instruction to connect pneumatic hoses to the valve block, if they have been
disconnected.

Follow the steps below

1. Connect the hoses according to the signal plate (4) on the valve block.

Book No.9028188 02 51
6.5 Repair valve block 6 CIP module
7 Flow meter

The flow meter consists of two main parts:

• Flow sensor: A pipe with four electrodes detecting the flow. On top of the pipe, there is a
terminal box, where the flow transmitter is mounted.
• Flow transmitter: Monitors and transmits information to the PureBallast control system. The
flow transmitter is also used to set parameters for the flow meter.
• The flow sensor and flow transmittor are pre-assembled from factory, and the parameters are
pre-set. At installation, or if the transmitter or its display are replaced, parameter settings must
be checked and reset according to chapter 4. Parameters, section Flow transmitter parameters.

7.1 Mount the f ow meter


Follow the steps below to mount the flow meter.

Preparation and conditions

• See chapter 6. Installation description and drawings, section Control cabinet / Interconnection
diagram for detailed information.
• It is recommend that a shielded power cable is used.

NG
WARNI
!
• Potential hazards / Grounding
The flow meter shall be grounded.
Installing the sensor

The sensor is installed between the two pipe flanges.

Note: Screws, nuts seals, etc. are not included in the scope of supply.

Book No.9028188 02 53
7.1 Mount the flow meter 7 Flow meter

7 Installing Promag W sensor

Seals

• Hard rubber lining — additional seals are always necessary.


• Polyurethane lining — no seals are requited.
• For DIN (DN) flanges, use seals according to EN 1514–1.
• Make sure that the seals do not protude into the piping cross-section.

ON
CAUTI
!
• Risk of short circuit.
Do not use electrically conductive sealing compounds such as graphite.
Screw tightening

Always tighten the screws uniformely and in an diagonally opposite sequence. Overtightening the
screws will deform the sealing faces and damage the seals.

Turning the transmitter housing

Aluminium field housing for non- Ex area.

7 Turning AL-field housing, non EX area

Turning the onsite display

54 Book No.9028188 02
7 Flow meter 7.1 Mount the flow meter

7 Turning the onsite display

1. Press the slide latches on the display module and remove the modile from the cover plate of
the electronics compartment (a).
2. Turn the display to desired position (max 4 x 45 degrees in both directions) and reset it onto the
cover plate of the electronics compartment (b).
Connecting the transmitter housing

The cable from the flow transmitter shall be connected to the control cabinet. See chapter 6.
Installation description and drawings, section Control cabinet / Interconnection diagram for detailed
information.

7 Connect housing

Transmitter connection:
1. Connection diagram inside the connection compartment cover
2. Both power supply cable and signal cable
3. Optional
4. Optional

Grounding

The flow meter shall be grounded with a ground cable connected to the UVR.

7 Grounding

Book No.9028188 02 55
7.2 Replace display and fuse 7 Flow meter

7.2 Replace display and fuse

NG
WARNI
!
• Risk of electric shock! Exposed components carry dangerous voltages.
Make sure that the power supply is switched off before you remove the cover of the electronics
compartment.
The procedure for replacing the display and fuse is as follows:

To replace display: See step 1–3 below.

To replace fuse : Se step 1–6 below.

The main fuse is located on the power supply board.

1. Switch off power supply.

2. Unscrew cover of the electronics compartment from the transmittor housing.

3. Remove the local display as follows:


-Press the latches at the side and remove the display module
-Disconnect the ribbon cable of the display from the amplifier board.

7 Tool list

7 Opening Field housing and replacing display

Opening Fileld housing and replacing display

4. Remove the screws and remove the cover from the electronics compartment.

5. Remove the power supply board. Insert a suitable tool into the hole, provided for the purpose
and pull the board clear of its holder.

6. Remove cap (1) and replace the device fuse (2).

Use only fuses of the following type:


– Power supply 20 to 55 V AC / 16 to 62 V DC use a 2.0 A slow-blow / 250 V; 5.2 × 20 mm

56 Book No.9028188 02
7 Flow meter 7.2 Replace display and fuse

7 Replacing the fuse

Replacing the device fuse on the power supply board (step 5–6)
1. Protective cap
2. Device fuse

7. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.

7 Re-assembly

Re-assembly

Book No.9028188 02 57
7.2 Replace display and fuse 7 Flow meter
8 Valve actuator

This section contain instructions for the valve actuator.

7 Actuator and switch

Valve actuator with switch box for position feedback to control system

1. Switch box
2. Bracket
3. Actuator
4. Pilote valve
5. Bracket - Used for valves with dimension 400
6. Coupling with position indicator - Used for valves
with dimension 400
7. DIN connector
8. Position indicator

Book No.9028188 02 59
8.1 Preparations and conditions 8 Valve actuator

7 Actuator

Valve actuator with puck for position sensor

1. Safety cover
2. Pad lock
3. Lower position for indicator screw
4. Upper position for indicator screw — with screw
5. Position indicator
6. Center screw
7. Bracket
8. Puck
9. Locking bolt
10. End stop bolt.

8.1 Preparations and conditions


• Do not operate the actuator over pressure limits. It will damage internal parts as well as cause
damage to the housing.
• Do not disassemble individual spring elements. Disassembly may result in personal injury.
• Do not remove end caps or disassemble the actuator while the actuator is pressurized.
• The actuator must not be lubricated. It is factory lubricated for the life of the actuator during
normal working conditions. The standard lubricant is suitable for use from −20 °C (−4 °F)
to +80 °C (+176 °F).
• If a valve actuator is removed, check for loose spindle-bushing. Then make sure the loose
bushing is refitted to avoid play between the actuator and the valve spindle.
• Actuator are mounted together with the valve body and pilot valve at delivery. Valve and actuator
mounting are sealed to guarantee correct position indication in relation to throttle position.

8.1.1 Tightening torques for actuators


Torque is stated in Nm.

60 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.3 Mount actuator on valve

M5 05–06
M6 10–11
M8 23–25
M10 48–52
M12 82–86
M14 132–138
M16 200–210
M20 390–410

8.2 Dismount actuator


Follow this instruction to dismount an actuator.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.
Follow the steps below

1. Remove the DIN connector to disconnect the power. Let the air connection remain.
Result: Valve goes to closed position (due to the air connection). The yellow indicators on the
puck shows position of valve: closed. The yellow position indicators are in line with the valve
throttle (indicating closed when the position indicators are in opposite line with the pipe).

2. Disconnect the air hose to the pilot valve. Verify that the actuator is not pressurized. Always
use caution and double-check that ports 2 and 4 are vented and are free from any accessory
and/or device.

3. If the actuator have a switch box at the top: Loosen the four screws holding the switch box to
the actuator. Remove the switch box together with its bracket.

4. Loosen the four hexagonal screws holding the actuator to the valve.

5. If the actuator is mounted on the valve with a bracket and coupling (dimension 400): Loosen
the screws holding the bracket to the valve. Make sure not to loose the coupling between the
valve and actuator when lifting the actuator.

6. Lift the actuator from the valve.

8.3 Mount actuator on valve


Follow this instruction to mount an actuator.

Preparations and conditions

Book No.9028188 02 61
8.3 Mount actuator on valve 8 Valve actuator

ON
CAUTI
!
• The actuator must not be pressurized at any time during installation as it may result in injury.
• The valve must be in closed position.
• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.
• The utmost cleanliness is required during air supply connection to the actuator, that is, the
connecting pipe thread, fittings and seals must be clean and dirt-free.
• Before fitting onto the valve, make sure the actuator/valve is correctly orientated, depending on
which direction of rotation is required.
Follow the steps below

1. Note the position of the groove (2) of the valve stem (3). It indicates the position of the valve
throttle. The illustration shows a square variant, but octagonal versions exist.

7 ValveStem

1. Allowed travel sector.


2. Valve stem groove
3. Valve stem
5. Lock pin opening (covered by rubber plug).

2. Make sure that the lock pin (inside the valve stem) only travels in the allowed sector (1) and
that it does not pass the opening (5).

3. If the actuator is mounted on the valve with a bracket and coupling (dimension 400): First fit
the coupling on the valve stem. Make sure that the red position indicator on the coupling is in
line with the pipe when the valve is open.

4. Fit the actuator onto the valve stem (or the coupling). The actuator may only be positioned in
even 90° intervals in relation to the valve. It is not allowed to adjust the position by turning the
actuator by hand after it is fitted on the valve stem.

5. Mount the actuator on the valve with the four hexagonal screws. For each screw, one washer
and one spring washer shall be used. Tighten with torque according to the table Tightening
torques for actuators on page 60.

62 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.4 Change direction of actuator – without
position sensor (V404–36, V320–4 and V321–2)

6. If the actuator have a switch box at the top: Make sure that the yellow position indicator under
the switch box is in line with the throttle (according to the groove in the valve stem). The yellow
position indicator shall be in line with the valve throttle (indicating open when the position
indicator is in line with the pipe). If not, remove the position indicator, turn it 90° and refit it.
Mount the switch box with the bracket on the actuator, using the four bolts.

7. Reconnect the air hose to the pilot valve.

8. Operate the valve to make sure it operates in the desired direction of rotation.

8.4 Change direction of actuator – without position


sensor (V404–36, V320–4 and V321–2)
Follow this instruction to turn an actuator without position sensors on the UV reactor.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.
Follow the steps below

1. Loosen the four screws holding the actuator to the valve.

2. Lift the actuator from the valve.

3. Note the position of the groove of the valve stem. It indicates the position of the valve throttle.

4. Fit the actuator onto the valve stem.

5. Unscrew the center screw (4) holding the puck (6) and a bracket (5).

7 ActDirectWithout

6. Lift the puck (6), rotate it 90° and fasten it with the center screw (4) and bracket (5).

Book No.9028188 02 63
8.6 Change direction of actuator – with 8 Valve actuator
position sensor (201-19 and 201–20)

7. Make sure that the yellow position indicators (3) is in line with the throttle (according to the
groove in the valve stem). The yellow position indicators shall be in line with the valve throttle
(indicating open when the position indicator is in line with the pipe). If not, remove the position
indicators, turn them 90° and refit.

8. Connect power and air.

8.5 Change direction of actuator – with switch box


(V201–3, V201–9, V201–32, V212–31 and V403–35)
Follow this instruction to turn an actuator with switch box.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.
• The valve must be mounted and connected to air and power before adjustment.
Follow the steps below

1. Dismount the actuator according to Dismount actuator on page 61.

2. Remount the actuator according to Mount actuator on valve on page 61.

3. Before mounting the switch box, change the position of the yellow position indicator, so it
is in line with the throttle.

4. Remount the switch box according to Mount actuator on valve.

8.6 Change direction of actuator – with position


sensor (201-19 and 201–20)
Follow this instruction to turn an actuator with a position sensor, if necessary due to lack of space.
Note that the actuator normally should not be altered.

This instruction is valid for the following valves: V201-19 and V201-20 on the UV reactor.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.
• The valve must be mounted and connected to air and power before adjustment.
Follow the steps below

1. Dismount the actuator from the valve according to instruction Dismount actuator on page 61.
Put the actuator on a work bench.

64 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.6 Change direction of actuator – with position
sensor (201-19 and 201–20)

2. Disconnect the DIN connector (2) from the coil: First loosen the screw (1), and then pull up
the connector.

7 DisconDINcon

3. Unscrew the center screw (6) holding the puck (8) and a bracket (7).

7 DirActPosSnsr

4. Lift the puck (8), rotate it 90° so that one position indicator (5) with a screw is in contact with the
position sensor. Fasten the puck with the center screw (6) and bracket (7).

5. Move the screw on yellow position indicator to the top position and move the screw on black
position indicator to the bottom position.

6. Make sure that the position sensor have a maximum distance of 1 mm from the puck (7). The
position sensor and the position indicator screws must be close to give a signal. If not, loosen
the screws and adjust the position. Tighten the screws to fixate the position.

7. Fit the actuator onto the valve stem in its new position according to instruction Mount actuator
on valve on page 61.

Book No.9028188 02 65
8.8 Mount pilot valve on actuator 8 Valve actuator

8. Make sure that the yellow indicator (5) in line with the valve throttle according to the groove in
the valve stem.

9. Reconnect the DIN connector.

10. Connect power.

11. Check that the installation is OK, by making sure that the A1 LED is lit on the position sensor
(visible from the side).

12. Connect air.

8.7 Change direction of actuator – with positioner


(201–8)
Follow this instruction to turn the actuator on control valve 201–8, if necessary due to lack of space.
Note that the actuator normally should not be altered.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.

Follow the steps below

1. Dismount the actuator from the valve according to instruction Dismount actuator on page 61.

2. Fit the actuator onto the valve stem in its new position and mount it on the valve with the four
hexagonal screws. For each screw, one washer and one spring washer shall be used. Tighten
with torque according to the table Tightening torques for actuators on page 60.

3. The position indicator scale shall be correct, but make sure that the scale still indicates correct
opening percent according to the valve throttle position. If not, loosen the four bolts to the
bracket holding the switch box. Lift it and turn the scale so it is correct.

4. Refit the switch box. Make sure that the peg on the scale fits to the carrier on the puck
mounted on the actuator.

8.8 Mount pilot valve on actuator


Follow this instruction to mount a pilot valve on actuator and connect them.

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be in closed position.


• Air and power must be disconnected. The valve position must not be adjusted during the routine.

66 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.9 Adjust valve end position

7 MountPilote

Pilot valve and actuator

1. Mounting screw holes


2. Throttle valve
3. Port 1 for air connection (under)
4. Throttle valve
5. DIN connector
6. Screw.

Follow the steps below

1. Check that the O-rings are fitted on the pilot valve, on the side facing the actuator.

2. Fit the pilot valve on in the actuator, so that the pin on the actuator fits the hole on the pilot
valve. The throttle valves (2 and 4) shall be directed downwards.

3. Mount the pilot valve with two Allen screws in the holes (1).

4. Connect air to port 1 (3) on the pilot valve.

5. Fit the DIN connector (5) on the coil, including gasket. Then fasten the connector with the
screw (6).

8.9 Adjust valve end position


Follow this instruction to tune the open and closed end positions for a valve. This is done if the
valve tends to get stuck in the end position or not close completely.

Book No.9028188 02 67
8.10 Adjust valve traveling speed 8 Valve actuator

7 576075_lock_manual

Preparations and conditions

• The valve shall be closed (0°) position 0.


Follow the steps below

1. Note the exact position of the position indicator for reference after adjustment.

2. Open the padlock (2) on the actuator and remove the safety cover (1).
Result: Two sets of bolts are displayed. The right set adjusts closing position and the left
set adjusts open position.

3. Loosen the locking bolt (3).

4. Adjust end position by turning the end stop blot (4) with small turns.
– Clockwise decrease the end position.
– Counterclockwise increase the end position.

NOTE

• The total adjustment degree is 10° for each position.


5. Operate the valve. Compare the new position of the position indicator to see the result on the
adjustment. If needed, adjust again.

6. Tighten the locking bolt (3) to fixate the position of the end stop bolt (4).

8.10 Adjust valve traveling speed


Follow this instruction to adjust valve traveling speed.

68 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.10 Adjust valve traveling speed

7 AdjustTravel

Follow the steps below

1. Operate the valve manually to check traveling speed according to the instruction in the Operate
valves manually on page 19.

2. To adjust opening speed:


Faster: Screw the throttle (1) valve port 3 counterclockwise.
Slower: Screw the throttle valve (1) port 3 clockwise.

3. To adjust closing speed:


Faster: Screw the throttle valve (2) port 5 counterclockwise.
Slower: Screw the throttle valve (2) port 5 clockwise.

Book No.9028188 02 69
8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8 8 Valve actuator

8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8


Follow this instruction to calibrate the positioner at installation or when needed.

7 201-8Positioner4

1. Arrestor device (screw driver adjusting)


2. Unlock the wheel
3. Locking wheel (screw driver adjusting)
4. Direction to lock the wheel
5. Adjustment wheel
6. Transmission ratio selector

Preparations and conditions

• The valve must be installed and connected to air and power.


• The valve must be closed.
• The cover must be removed.
• The positioner must have power. If the positioner display is empty (no power): Open V201-8
manually (approximately 1-5 %) from control system to supply power to the positioner.
• Do not adjust the cam wheels: 2 grey wheels above the adjustment wheel (5).
• Buttons on the positioner:

7 201-8Positioner

70 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8

Software settings - Alfa Laval values:

Parameter Settings in menu


1 turn

2 90° (is automatically 90° when turn is used)


34 0.7

Follow the steps below

1. Make sure that the transmission ratio selector (6) is set to 90° according to sticker on the
component. If not: Adjust by pressing the bar with a screw driver.

2. Make sure that the Arrestor device wheel (1) is set to 90°. If not: Adjust by turning.

3. Press HAND button for 5 seconds to enter the parameter list.

4. Make sure that Menu 1 is displyaed. If not: Press HAND button repeatedly until it is.
Make sure that “turn” is displayed in the menu. If not: press + or – repeatedly until it is.

5. Press the hand button repeatedly until Menu 4 is displayed.


(To go backward, press HAND button and – button.)

6. Press + button for 5 seconds to start automatic calibration.

7. If calibration stops (as displayed below), follow these steps:

7 201-8Positioner2

- Use a screw driver to loosen the yellow locking wheel (counter clockwise).
- Turn the adjustment wheel (5) by hand until a 0 is displayed between the “d” and the “U” as
shown in the illustration. Normally this is when the value in the screen is close to 0.

7 201-8Positioner3

- Lock the locking wheel (3) with a screw driver (clockwise).


- Press the + button to continue the calibration.
8. Wait until “FINISH” is displayed on the screen.

9. Press the hand button once.


Result: Menu 4 “INITA” is displayed.

Book No.9028188 02 71
8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8 8 Valve actuator

10. Press the hand button for 5 seconds until a number or “VER” is displayed, then let go of the
button.
Result: “MAN” is displayed”.

11. Press the hand button once.


Result: A final adjustment is started, and then “AUT” is displayed.

72 Book No.9028188 02
8 Valve actuator 8.11 Calibrate positioner on V201-8

Trouble shooting

If any problem occurs, do the following:

1. Check the mechanical installation and air supply.

2. Reset factory settings and restart calibration:

- Reset to factory settings: Press HAND button repeatedly until menu 50 is displayed.
- Press + button until “oCAY” is displayed.
- Restart instruction Calibrate positioner on V201-8 from step 4.
- Set the parameters according to Alfa Laval software settings. See table above.

Book No.9028188 02 73
8.12 Adjust cam position on V201-8 8 Valve actuator

8.12 Adjust cam position on V201-8


Follow this instruction to adjust cam setting for the pneumatic positioner feedback on valve V201-8,
so that the operating indication is correct in the control system.

Hint: A multimeter can be used to indicate position of the cam wheels, if it is hard to hear the click
from the micro switch, or if it is inconvenient to see valve position in control panel. Connect a
multimeter to connection point 41 and 42 in the positioner.

- Closed circuit = 0 ohm.


- Open circuit = ∞.
Instruction for multimeter indicated in italic.

Follow the steps below

1. In control panel: Set system in manual mode.

2. Open V201-8 manually to approximately 50 % in the panel.

3. Close it to approximately 10 %.

4. On the positioner: Adjust both cam wheels to same position. Cam wheels are above the
adjustment wheel (5) on page 70.

5. Turn the cam wheels in any direction until it valve indicates steady green in the control panel.
Miltimeter indicate circuit closed.

6. Turn the cam wheel slowly counter clock wise until you hear a click from the micro switch in
the positioner. Stop directly after the click. Stop directly after the multimeter changes to
indicate circuit open.

7. Check that the valve is indicated as open (steady green) in the control panel.

8. Close the valve to 0 %.


Result 1: Valve closed, indicated with no color. Circuit closed. Setting is OK. You are done.

Result 2: Valve indicated as red. Cam wheels are in wrong position, for example due to the
wheels been turned too much after the click). Miltimeter indicate circuit open. Repeat from
step 2 until setting is OK.

74 Book No.9028188 02
9 Ball valve

This section contains maintenance information for the ball valve.

9.1 Replace seals in ball valve


Follow this instruction to replace the seals in ball valve.

7 BallV

Ball valve, exploded view

Preparations and conditions

Maximum tightening torque

Valve size Max. torque of Max. torque of stem nut (14)


body bolts (8)

25 = 1 inch 13–16 Nm 14.3 Nm

32 = 1¼ 20–25 Nm 14.3 Nm
inches

50 = 2 inches 35–40 Nm 19.4 Nm

Book No.9028188 02 75
9.1 Replace seals in ball valve 9 Ball valve

Follow the steps below

1. Relieve the line pressure.

2. With the valve in the open position (lever to be parallel to the axis of the pipe), remove all the
body bolts (19) except one.

3. Loosen the nut (20) on the remaining bolt. Swing the body outside the pipe.

4. Dismount the stem (8).

5. Replace seals (5, 6, 7, 9, 10, and 24). They are available in a spare parts kit for the ball valve.

6. Mount in reverse order. The body bolts of the valve should be tightened evenly. Tighten
one-side snugly, then the one diagonally across. Repeat for the other bolts, bringing them all
down tightly in sequence. Make sure the maximum tightening torque is observed according
to the table above:

7. Check that the valve is operating correctly.

8. Check for leaks when the water flow is on.

76 Book No.9028188 02
10 Level switch

This section contains information about the level switch LS201-29 installed in the UV reactor. For
information about status indications, see chapter 5. Alarms and faultfinding, section Level switch.

7LS Component

Level switch

10.1 Mount level switch


Preparations and conditions

• Do not alter the forks in any way.


• Be careful not to damage the fork in any way.

NOTE

• Disconnect power supply before mounting or dismounting the component.


Follow the steps below

1. Connect the level switch according to the label on the component.

2. Seal the level switch with lock tight or equivalent pipe seal.

3. Mount the sensor until the joint is finger-tight.

4. Identify the sensor align mark (▼) on the component. Make sure that it is positioned on the
upper side of the level switch.

Book No.9028188 02 77
10.3 Test level switch 10 Level switch

5. Complete the seal carefully by tightening the component with a spanner. Use the spanner on
the hexagon flats, but not on the level switch body.

10.2 Dismount level switch


Preparations and conditions

• The external surface may be hot. Care must be taken to avoid possible burns.
Follow the steps below

1. Disconnect the level switch according to the label on the device.

2. Loosen the component with a spanner. Use the spanner on the hexagon flats, but not on
the level switch body.

3. Remove the level switch and remove the old seal from the threads.

10.3 Test level switch


Follow the instruction below to test that a level switch functions OK.

Follow the steps below

1. Make sure that the component i powered (the green LED shall be lit).

2. Hold a magnet to the test point indicated on the on the level switch, indicated below.

7LS Test

3. Make sure the level switch reacts to the magnet. The component is OK if the green and
yellow LED is lit.

78 Book No.9028188 02
11 Temperature switch and
temperature transmitter

This section contains information about the temperature switch TS201-60 and the temperature
transmitter TT201–33 installed in the UV reactor. The two components are similar in design, so
the same instructions can be used.

7 TS and TT

Temperature switch and temperature transmitter

Preparations and conditions

NOTE

• Disconnect power supply before mounting or dismounting the component.


11.1 Mount temperature switch / temperature
transmitter
Follow the steps below

1. Seal the component’s threads using lock tight or equivalent pipe seal.

2. Mount the component until the joint is finger-tight.

3. Tighten the component with a spanner. Use the spanner on the hexagon flats, but not on
the components body.

4. Connect the component’s screwed-on power cord.

Book No.9028188 02 79
11.2 Dismount temperature switch / 11 Temperature switch and temper-
temperature transmitter ature transmitter

11.2 Dismount temperature switch / temperature


transmitter
Preparations and conditions

• The external surface may be hot. Care must be taken to avoid possible burns.
Follow the steps below

1. Disconnect the component’s screwed-on power cord.

2. Loosen the component with a spanner. Use the spanner on the hexagon flats, but not on
the components body.

3. Remove the level switch and remove the old seal from the threads.

80 Book No.9028188 02
12 Control panel

This section covers instructions for service of the control system.

12.1 Clean control panel

NOTE

• Control panels may only be cleaned when set in wipe mode. This is to prevent unintended
functions from being triggered by buttons pressed during cleaning.
Preparations and conditions

• Never use aggressive solvents, chemicals, scouring agents, pressurized air or steam jet.
Follow the steps below

1. Press the Wipe button on the screen.


Result: Disable the touch screen function for 10 seconds to make it possible to clean the
screen without the risk of starting a process or changing a setting.

2. Clean the display and surrounding front cover with a soft cloth and mild detergent. Do not
spray detergent directly on the control panel.

12.2 Replace control panel


Follow this instruction to replace the control panel.

Preparations and conditions:

• The system must be shut down.


• Connect cables as in the old control panel. Port LAN A must be used for the Ethernet cable at
the backside of the panel.
• After the panel is mounted: Load new software to the panel according to the release note
for the software. Also set communication according to Set control panel IP address and Set
remote control panel communication.

Book No.9028188 02 81
12.2 Replace control panel 12 Control panel
13 Remote control panel
(optional)

This section covers information on how to mount and connect the remote control panel. The remote
control panel is either ordered with a mounting plate (for installations in wall, worktop etc) or an IP
protective back cover (for installation on stand etc).

13.1 Mount and connect remote control panel


Preparations and conditions

• Remote control panel is mounted according to according to drawing Remote control panel /
Dimension drawing on page on page . Note the clearance area.
• Use a 24 VDC power cable with minimum cross section of 0.75 mm2, preferably halogen free
and flexible.
• Connect power cable to terminal X1 in remote control panel.
• Communication cable (W501) between the remote control panel and control cabinet can be
either Ethernet or fiber. Cable requirements and connection points below:

- Ethernet cable – Type: Cat 5e (or better), shielded. Max length: 100 meters. One remote
control panel: From terminal X2 in remote control panel s to terminal X13 in the control
cabinet. Two From terminal X2 in second remote control panel to either switch SW1 in
control cabinet or to switch SW1 in the first remote control panel.
- Fiber cable – Type: Multi-mode fiber cable with LC connector. Max length: 500 meters.
From remote control panel’s switch SW1 to switch SW1 in control cabinet.
See Remote control panel / Circuit diagram on page .

Book No.9028188 02 83
13.1 Mount and connect remote control panel 13 Remote control panel (optional)
14 Control cabinet and lamp
drive cabinet (LDC)

This section covers maintenance information for the control cabinet.

14.1 Disassemble and assemble I/O system


This section covers maintenance information about the I/O system (X20 electronic modules). For
information about status and error indications, pleas see chapter 5. Alarms and fault finding.

Follow the steps below

1. Hold down the plastic clip on the top of the terminal block and pivot the block towards you.

7IO1_X025002A

2. Pull away the terminal block.

3. Hold down the triangle on the top of the I/O board and loosen the board.

7IO2_X025003A

Book No.9028188 02 85
14.1 Disassemble and assemble I/O system 14 Control cabinet and lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

4. Pull the board straight out (otherwise it can fasten in one of its guides).

7IO3_X025004A

5. Compare the part number of the new I/O board to the old board, to make sure it is correct.

6. If changing more than one board at a time, check with the electrical diagram to ensure that
the boards are mounted in the right places.

7. Mount the new I/O board by pressing it straight into place. Make sure the board is firmly in
place, otherwise it will be impossible to mount the cable terminal.

7IO4_X025005A

8. Remount the terminal block. Make sure the clip on the bottom of the block fastens properly in
place on the axel on the bus holder.

7IO5_X025007A

86 Book No.9028188 02
14 Control cabinet and lamp drive cabinet 14.2 Cable gland installation – General cables
(LDC)

9. Pivot the terminal block on the axel until the clip on the terminal block top fastens into place in
the I/O board.

7IO6_X025006A

14.2 Cable gland installation – General cables


This section covers information about how to install the cables into the control cabinet and LDC
using the cable glands. Power cables to the LDC are installed according to instruction Cable gland
installation – Power cable to LDC.

Follow this instruction to mount cables into the cabinets.

Follow the steps below

1. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the frame with Roxtec Assembly Gel or equivalent, specially
in the corners.

7 Cable1

2. Insert the cables through the frame.

3. Adapt the modules, which are to hold cables.

4. Peel off layers until you achieve a 0.1-1.0 mm gap between the two module halves when
held against the cable.

Book No.9028188 02 87
14.2 Cable gland installation – General cables 14 Control cabinet and lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

7 Cable2

7 Cable3

5. Lubricate all modules thoroughly, both on the inside and the outside surfaces.

7 Cable4

6. Insert the modules from the back of the frame opening. If possible, start with the largest
modules.

7 Cable5

88 Book No.9028188 02
14 Control cabinet and lamp drive cabinet 14.3 Cable gland installation – Power
(LDC) cable to LDC

7. Tighten the compression unit firmly to seal the frame. Maximum 10 Nm. A good indication is
when the lubrication is squeezed out between the modules.

7 Cable6

14.3 Cable gland installation – Power cable to LDC


Follow this instruction to install the power cable to the LDC using the cable gland.

Follow the steps below

1. Adapt the seal to the cable by removing layers from the halves. The halves may not differ by
more than one layer.

7 LDC gland1

2. Achieve an approximate 0.1–1 mm gap between the halves when testing against the cable.
There shall be a visual gap.

7 LDC gland2

3. Lubricate thoroughly on the inside surfaces and sparsely on the outside of the seal.

Book No.9028188 02 89
14.4 Power cable check 14 Control cabinet and lamp drive cabinet (LDC)

4. Insert the halves one by one into the sleeve.

7 LDC gland8

5. Tighten the Allen screws crosswise. The seal will compress and seal the transit.

14.4 Power cable check


Check power cables screw connections, to eliminate potential risk of fire due to loose cables.

This check should be performed in LDC, control cabinet, UVR junction box.

1. Turn off power to PureBallast from the vessel’s switch board, to make it currentless. Where
applicable, turn off power to the individual cabinet.

2. Make a random check of approximately 10 % the cables in different areas of the cabinet.

- Make sure that the cables are fastened with sufficiently tightened screws.
- If one cable is loose, check all cables connected to this component / component of the
same type.
- Note: Be careful not to tighten the screws so that the cables are damaged.

90 Book No.9028188 02
.

Spare parts catalogue


PureBallast 3.1 750

Specification No. 9005247-03/5


Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2
Published By:
Alfa Laval Tumba AB
SE-147 80 Tumba, Sweden

Telephone: +46 8 530 650 00


Telefax: +46 8 530 310 40

© Alfa Laval Tumba AB 2017-09-18


Original instructions
This publication or any part there of may not be
reproduced or transmitted by any process or
means without prior written permission of
Alfa Laval Tumba AB.
Contents
1 Important information 5

2 Control cabinet 6
2.1 Cabinet 10
2.2 I/O module 12
2.3 Relay module 14
2.4 Wire set 16

3 Lamp drive cabinet 18


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 20

4 Remote control panel (optional) 40


4.1 Cover 42

5 Log box (optional) 44

6 UV Reactor JIS 46
6.1 UV reactor JIS 50
6.2 Junction box, A side 52
6.3 Junction box 54
6.4 Valve 56

7 Filter, ACB-985-300 58
7.1 Filter, ACB-985-300 60
7.2 Junction box 62

8 Adaptor 64

9 Valve V309-1 66

10 Backf ush pump (optional) 68

11 Valve, JIS A300 70

3
12 Valve V201-32 and 403-35 72

13 Control valve V201-8 74

14 Flow transmitter, A300 76

15 CIP module 78
15.1Pump P320-1 and P321-5 82
15.2Valve 84
15.3Valve block 86

16 Sampling device (QT201.1,


QT201.1) (optional) 88

17 Pressure monitoring device 90

18 Booster pump, P401-1 (optional) 92

19 Booster pump, P403-1, JIS


(optional) 94

20 Air f lter regulator (optional) 96

21 Extended options (SPC) 98


21.1Valve V212-31 (optional) 100
21.2Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional) 102

22 Cross reference list 104

4
1 Important information

1 Important information

• State number of ordered parts. Note that the quantity in the tables do not states number of parts
delivered (only the how many of that parts that are included in the mother component).

• It is only possible to order parts included in the tables.

• Safeguard your commitment to quality by always using genuine Alfa Laval spare parts.
Remember, Alfa Laval cannot accept responsibility for the failure of separator equipped with
non-original spare parts. We guarantee the quality and reliability of our products.

• This manual refers to unit number printed on the equipment name-plate.

• When ordering, refer to part number listed in this catalogue and serial number, described in
chapter 7. Service manual, section Serial number information.

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 5


PureBallast 3.1 750

2 Control cabinet

*=On request only, contact your local Alfa Laval representative

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9025738-
Ref Part No Description -80* Notes
Quantity
1 9012086 83 Cabinet 1 See page 10
2 9006851 01 Software, PLC, PB3.0 1
3 9006852 01 Software, panel 1
4 592122 03 HMI Panel wide without co 1
6 9006805 01 DIN-rail 35x15 2
7 9006806 01 DIN-rail 35x15 1
8 221891 04 Lock nut 12
9 223101 47 Washer 12
10 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 14
11 582212 122 Terminal block 3
12 582212 13 End plate 3
13 9019135 03 Contactor AF09Z 1 K2
13.1 9019138 01 Over current prot. Relay Ex 1 F2
14 9019135 03 Contactor AF09Z 1 K3
14.1 9019138 01 Over current prot. Relay Ex 1 F3
15 9014707 01 Power supply unit 1
16 9004299 04 Fuse 4
17 582212 67 Terminal, PIT 2,5-3PV 7
17.1 582212 71 Plug In Bridge, FBS 3-5BU 1
18 582212 63 Terminal D-PIT 2,5-3L 1
19 9019135 04 Contactor AF16Z 1 K4
19.1 9019138 03 Over current prot. Relay Ex 1 F4
20 9019135 04 Contactor AF16Z 1 K5
20.1 9019138 02 Over current prot. Relay Ex 1 F5
21 9025840 80 I/O module 1 See page 12
22 582212 147 Patch panel 2
23 582212 91 VIP-2, D 9SUB 1
24 9019186 05 Terminal, PT 4-PE/3L 4
25 582212 102 Terminal PITTB 2,5 PE 1
26 9019186 06 End cover, D-PT 4-PE/3L 1
27 582212 104 Terminal PITTB 2,5 42
28 582212 105 End plate D-PITTB 1
29 582212 67 Terminal, PIT 2,5-3PV 4
30 582212 63 Terminal D-PIT 2,5-3L 1
31 582212 168 Separating plate 2
32 582212 123 Power terminal block, 1
33 9002362 80 Relay module 3 See page 14
34 593724 03 Distance screw 4
35 582221 90 PE Connection bar 1 245mm
36 594009 03 Screw 2
37 582212 206 Bar holder 3
38 582212 15 PE/SC Bar 1 500mm
39 594009 02 Screw 3
40 582212 207 Cable clamp 10
41 9006814 01 Cable channel 100x80 1
42 583556 17 Cable channel 40x80 1
43 583556 16 Cable channel 40x80 2
44 9003522 06 Cable channel, 25x80 1
45 9003522 07 Cable channel, 25x80 2
48 223101 47 Washer 2
49 221851 05 Cap nut 2
50 9019186 07 Safety relays, PSR-MC30 1
51 221701 03 Screw 16
52 591103 67 Emergency stop 1
54 9011552 01 Buzzer 1
56 582212 155 Socket with USB 2
59 9025837 01 Switch OT63FT3 1
59.1 591103 37 Breaker handles 1
59.2 9025837 02 Shroud OTS63T3 2

6 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2 Control cabinet

3029A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 7


PureBallast 3.1 750

*=On request only, contact your local Alfa Laval representative

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9025738-
Ref Part No Description -80* Notes
Quantity
61 9006853 01 Fan 1
62 9006854 01 Air outlet 1
63 595361 02 Cable seal 2
66 9012150 81 Wire set 1 See page 16
67 582221 101 Splicing connector 2
68 582212 215 Connector 1
74 1270001 Lifting instruction 1
75 554214 01 Cable tie 1
76 591103 86 Over current prot. 1 Q2
76.2 591103 64 Connection 1
76.3 591103 10 Auxiliary contact 3
77 591103 54 Over current prot. Relay 1 Q3
78 591103 60 Over current prot. Relay 1 Q4
80 595728 02 Switch 1
81 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
82 595673 03 Ethernet cable 2
83 582212 147 Patch panel 1
84 582212 91 VIP-2, D 9SUB 1
85 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 1
86 582212 90 Cable-D 9SUB 1
87 580986 76 Communication module 1

8 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2 Control cabinet

3029A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 9


PureBallast 3.1 750

2.1 Cabinet
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012086-
Ref Part No Description -83 Notes
Quantity
2 9012091 81 Door 1
4 26556 Spring washer 6
5 9025887 01 Mounting plate 1
6 587276 02 Washer 16
7 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 12
8 221716 01 Screw 4
10 593778 01 Latch, housing 1
11 593779 01 Latch, insert 1
12 593991 01 Latch 1
13 9003013 01 Rod Guide 2
14 9003024 02 Rod for latching 2
15 593780 01 Key 1
17 223107 34 Spring washer 4
18 221891 04 Lock nut 4
20 593254 01 Retaining ring 1
21 221711 19 Screw 1
22 593282 01 Washer 1
23 221803 02 Nut 2
24 223101 73 Washer 1
25 593239 01 Nut 1
26 581688 01 Bracket 4
27 594488 01 Washer 4
28 221711 16 Screw 8
29 223101 47 Washer 8
30 221891 04 Lock nut 8
31 587276 02 Washer 6
32 70560 Washer 6
33 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 6
34 9014753 01 Piano hinge 1
35 9014815 01 Cover panel 1
36 598571 01 Torx head pan screw M4 8
37 221851 18 Cap nut 8
38 223101 31 Washer 4
39 9015118 01 Mounting spacer hole thro 2
40 9015117 01 Mounting spacer single ta 2
41 9012093 01 Magnet 4
42 9015123 01 Torx head pan screw M5 4

10 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2.1 Cabinet 2 Control cabinet

2878A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 11


PureBallast 3.1 750

2.2 I/O module


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9025840-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 597033 22 PLC 1 Incl. locking plate.
1.1 597033 18 Interface module 1
1.2 580986 76 Communication module 1
2 580986 17 Bus module 11
3 580986 30 Supply Bus Module 1
4 580986 51 12 Digital Input 3
5 580986 08 4 Analogue input 1
6 580986 53 2 Analogue Output 1
7 580986 32 Supply Module 1
8 580986 59 12 Digital Output 1
9 580986 06 6 Relay output 5
10 580986 16 Terminal block 12-pin 12
11 580986 20 Locking Plate right 0 Included in pos:1
12 580986 55 Compact flash card 1

12 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2.2 I/O module 2 Control cabinet

3030A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 13


PureBallast 3.1 750

2.3 Relay module


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9002362-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 582212 119 Interface relay, 24V 8
2 582212 120 Input adapter 1
3 582212 121 System cable 1
Z 582212 172 Relay, mini

14 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2.3 Relay module 2 Control cabinet

2724A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 15


PureBallast 3.1 750

2.4 Wire set


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012150-
Ref Part No Description -81 Notes
Quantity
1 9008383 06 Cable, 2,5mm² PE 5
2 9008383 08 Cable, 1,5mm² 12
3 9008387 01 Cable 100
4 595673 04 Ethernet cable 2
5 582212 90 Cable-D 9SUB 1
6 595673 02 Ethernet cable 1
8 9008383 15 Cable, 16mm² 3

16 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


2.4 Wire set 2 Control cabinet

2377A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 17


PureBallast 3.1 750

3 Lamp drive cabinet


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9011938-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9012046 80 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 1 See page 20
2 9012146 01 Lamp Power supply 16

18 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3 Lamp drive cabinet

2874A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 19


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012046-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9011952 80 Cabinet 1 See page 24
2 9004211 01 Centrifugal fan 1
3 221030 10 Screw 5
3.1 223101 47 Washer 5
4 9012058 80 Terminal block 1 See page 28
5 594009 04 Screw 2
6 223101 03 Washer 4
7 221891 01 Lock nut 2
8 594728 01 Temperature sensor 1
9 9004214 01 Heat exchanger 1
10 221030 10 Screw 12
11 223101 47 Washer 6
11.1 223101 04 Washer 11
12 221803 02 Nut 5
13 590624 03 Temperature sensor 1
14 9004303 02 Sensor, liquid 1
15 221803 03 Nut 1
16 223101 17 Washer 1
17 9008403 80 Solenoid valve 1
18 9004254 01 Check valve 1
19 523127 04 Hexagon nipple 2
20 9004426 01 Hose 2
21 591103 69 Pilot light Green 1
24 591103 70 Pilot light White 1
26 591103 71 Pushbutton, ill. Blue 1
26.1 591103 87 Blue LED 1
26.2 591103 88 Holder for 3 pos 1
26.3 591103 89 Contact block 1 NO 1
27 9004442 03 Marking, Reset 1
28 582212 164 Phoenix Contact 16
29 581803 43 Plug M 3p 16
30 582212 165 Phoenix Contact 16
31 582221 90 PE Connection bar 1 400mm
32 593724 03 Distance screw 4
33 594009 03 Screw 2
34 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 16
35 591103 86 Over current prot. 8
35.1 591103 10 Auxiliary contact 8
37 591103 64 Connection 3
38 9014707 01 Power supply unit 1
39 9004299 04 Fuse 2
40 9012135 80 I/O module 1 See page 30
41 582212 122 Terminal block 1
42 582212 13 End plate 1
43 591103 32 Fuse 2
44 591103 91 Bus bar 1
45 582212 182 Safety module 1
46 582212 146 Interface relay, 24V 3
47 9014546 01 Temperature relay 1
48 9014704 80 Terminal block 1 See page 32
50 9006677 01 Filter 1
51 223101 47 Washer 4
52 221891 04 Lock nut 4
53 9004313 82 Breaker 1
54 9005494 04 Transmitted handle kit 1
55 591103 46 Breaker door seal 1
56 591103 61 Self-res. short-circ. lim 3
57 591103 40 Supply block 1
58 591103 03 Bus bar 250A 1 12 terminal lugs

20 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

3009A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 21


PureBallast 3.1 750

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9012046-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
59 591103 41 End cap 2
60 9014833 01 DIN-rail, 35x15 1
61 223101 47 Washer 4
62 221891 04 Lock nut 4
63 582212 147 Patch panel 2
64 9011936 80 Terminal block 1 See page 34
65 9012198 80 Terminal block 1 See page 36
66 587276 02 Washer 12
67 70560 Washer 12
68 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 12
70 594009 07 Screw 4
84 1270001 Lifting instruction 1
85 554214 01 Cable tie 1
86 9015197 82 Wire set 1 See page 38
Z 591103 62 RHE handle
Z0.1 9003114 02 Cable gland
Z0.2 597330 01 Cable seal
Z0.3 597331 01 Cable seal

22 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

3009A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 23


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.1 Cabinet
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9011952-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9011951 80 Cabinet 1 See page 26
2 9012193 01 Mounting plate 1
3 587276 02 Washer 18
4 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 10
5 221716 01 Screw 8
6 9015611 01 Sheet 1
7 223101 47 Washer 4
8 221891 04 Lock nut 4
10 223101 47 Washer 6
11 221891 04 Lock nut 6
13 592005 15 DIN-rail, 35x15 1
14 9003565 03 DIN-rail, 35x15 1
15 9003565 02 DIN-rail, 35x15 1
16 223101 47 Washer 17
17 221891 04 Lock nut 14
18 583556 20 Cable channel 40x80 1
19 583556 19 Cable channel 40x80 1
20 583556 21 Cable channel 40x80 1
21 583556 04 Cable channel 1
22 586056 07 Cable channel 60x80 1
34 223101 47 Washer 13
35 221851 05 Cap nut 13
37 9004212 01 Inlet duct 1
38 9004213 01 Protection 1
39 221891 02 Nut 4
40 223101 16 Washer 4
41 594009 02 Screw 4
42 9003390 01 Bracket, fan 1
43 9006316 01 Cover, fan 1
44 223101 47 Washer 9
45 221030 10 Screw 9
46 591889 01 Cable tie mount 3
50 9003030 01 Drawing Pocket 1
51 223101 47 Washer 2
52 221803 02 Nut 2
53 9014585 01 Sheet, LPS 1
54 9014554 01 Sheet, LPS 1
55 594009 05 Screw 8
56 9002947 01 Yoke 18
57 9002942 01 Stud bolt 36
61 9006322 01 Sheet 1
62 221030 02 Screw 36
63 223101 47 Washer 72
64 221891 04 Lock nut 36
65 9015616 01 Sheet 1
66 70560 Washer 2
67 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 1
68 221716 01 Screw 1

24 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2881A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 25


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.2 Cabinet
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9011951-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
3 9008903 05 Washer 12
4 221035 51 Screw 12
5 9014640 01 Door, RH 1
6 9014642 01 Door, LH 1
9 223101 47 Washer 12
10 221803 02 Nut 12
15 9003075 01 Sheet 2
16 593254 01 Retaining ring 2
17 9003410 01 Sheet, heat exchanger 1
18 221030 10 Screw 9
19 223101 47 Washer 2
20 9003401 01 Sheet, heat exchanger 1
21 221030 10 Screw 3
22 223101 47 Washer 3
23 9003186 01 Plug 1
29 591874 04 Seal 1 Upper LPS rack, left
30 591874 06 Seal 1 Upper LPS rack, right
34 9014759 01 Sheet, EMC 1
49 9014762 01 Handle 1
50 9016266 01 Rod for latching 2
50.1 9016270 01 Rod adapter 4
51 9016268 01 Rod guide 8
52 9014732 01 Three point lock 1
53 9014735 01 Handle 1
54 9016266 02 Rod for latching 2
54A 9003024 01 Rod for latching 1
55 593780 01 Key 1
56 9003114 02 Cable gland 1
57 9003113 01 Cable seal 1
58 223101 41 Washer, 4,3x9x0,8 10
59 221891 02 Nut 10
64 9003031 01 Condensation outlet 2 Cabinet floor and heat exchanger floor
65 9003186 02 Plug 3
66 9008424 01 Protection 9
67 9003089 02 Vibration damper 2
68 223101 49 Washer 13x24x2,5 2
69 221726 10 Screw 2

26 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2882A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 27


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.3 Terminal block


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012058-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 598323 02 DIN rail TS 15 1
2 582212 202 Terminal MPT1,5 9
3 582212 203 Terminal MPT1,5 PE 2
4 582212 204 Terminal D-MPT1,5 1
5 582212 205 Clip fix 15 2

28 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2880A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 29


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.4 I/O module


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012135-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 580986 64 Bus Module 1
2 580986 17 Bus module 7
3 580986 62 Interface Module 1
4 580986 63 Bus Supply 1
5 580986 72 Communication module 1
6 597033 10 8 Digital input Module 2
7 580986 59 12 Digital Output 1
8 580986 40 Input Module 1
9 580986 53 2 Analogue Output 1
10 580986 61 4 Analog Input (PT100) 1
11 580986 16 Terminal block 12-pin 8
12 580986 19 Locking Plate left 1
13 580986 20 Locking Plate right 1

30 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2870A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 31


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.5 Terminal block


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9014704-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 582212 67 Terminal, PIT 2,5-3PV 6
2 582212 64 Terminal PIT 2,5-3PE 1
3 582212 63 Terminal D-PIT 2,5-3L 1
4 582212 71 Plug In Bridge, FBS 3-5BU 1
5 582212 03 Plug In Bridge 1
6 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2

32 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2871A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 33


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.6 Terminal block


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9011936-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
3 582212 130 Support, L=95,5 2
4 582212 122 Terminal block 2
5 582212 88 PIT 2,5 22
6 582212 89 D-ST2,5 1
7 582212 15 PE/SC Bar 1 138mm
8 582212 137 Sc clamp SK 20 1
9 582212 136 Sc clamp SK 14 1

34 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2872A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 35


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.7 Terminal block


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012198-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
3 582212 122 Terminal block 1
4 582212 13 End plate 1
5 582212 132 Sealable cover profile 2
6 582212 130 Support, L=95,5 2
7 582212 156 Terminal, PT 6 32
8 582212 15 PE/SC Bar 1 285mm
9 582212 137 Sc clamp SK 20 4
10 582212 157 End cover, D-PT 6 1
11 582212 133 Cover profile (AP-3) L=1m 1 292mm

36 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2873A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 37


PureBallast 3.1 750

3.1.8 Wire set


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9015197-
Ref Part No Description -82 Notes
Quantity
1 9008383 01 Cable, 70mm² 5
2 9008383 02 Cable, 35mm² 15
3 9015704 01 Cable, 4mm² 25
4 9015704 02 Cable, 4mm² 25
5 9015704 03 Cable, 4mm² 25
6 9008383 06 Cable, 2,5mm² PE 5
7 9008383 12 Cable, 25mm² PE 1
8 9008383 13 Cable, 6mm² PE 2
9 9008383 08 Cable, 1,5mm² 6
11 9008387 01 Cable 150
12 9008693 01 Cable, 2x2x0,5mm² 6
14 595673 03 Ethernet cable 2
15 9004439 01 Cable 1
16 9015692 01 Cable, 1,5mm² 65
17 9015704 04 Cable, 4mm² PE 25

38 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


3.1 Lamp drive cabinet, subas 3 Lamp drive cabinet

2377A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 39


PureBallast 3.1 750

4 Remote control panel (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012055-
Ref Part No Description -83 Notes
Quantity
1 9014979 01 Top plate 1
3 221711 16 Screw 8
3.1 9016593 01 Spacer 8
4 592122 03 HMI Panel wide without co 1
6 223101 47 Washer 3
7 221851 05 Cap nut 3
8 592005 14 DIN-rail, 35x15 1
9 223101 47 Washer 2
10 221891 04 Lock nut 2
11 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
12 582212 95 Terminal, PIT 2,5 TWIN 4
12.1 582212 03 Plug In Bridge 1
13 582212 96 Terminal, PIT 2,5 TWIN-PE 1
14 582212 04 End plate 1
15 582212 147 Patch panel 1
16 582212 155 Socket with USB 1
18 9011552 01 Buzzer 1
20 591103 72 Pushbutton Black 1
20.1 591103 92 Cover 1
22 9009760 01 Relay, D-sub 1
22.1 582212 214 D-SUB gender changer 1
23 595673 04 Ethernet cable 1
24 9011960 01 Bracket 1
25 223101 47 Washer 2
26 221891 04 Lock nut 2
28 594009 06 Screw 2
29 223101 47 Washer 2
30 221891 04 Lock nut 2
31 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
32 595728 02 Switch 1
33 595673 04 Ethernet cable 1
34 587276 02 Washer 2
35 70560 Washer 2
36 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 2
37 9015557 80 Wire set 1
38 9011943 80 Cover 1 See page 42
39 582212 215 Connector 1

40 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


4 Remote control panel (optional)

2875A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 41


PureBallast 3.1 750

4.1 Cover
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9011943-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9011944 01 Cover 1
2 594488 01 Washer 4
3 581688 01 Bracket 4
4 221711 16 Screw 8
5 223101 47 Washer 8
6 221891 04 Lock nut 8
7 589569 79 Cable Gland - M25 2
8 589569 35 Counter nut M25 2
9 589569 48 Cable Gland - M16 2
10 589569 33 Counter nut M16 2
11 587276 02 Washer 2
12 70560 Washer 2
13 221891 05 Hexagon lock nut 2

42 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


4.1 Cover 4 Remote control panel (optional)

2883A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 43


PureBallast 3.1 750

5 Log box (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9002245-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 582212 05 End stop 7
2 582212 122 Terminal block 2
3 582212 123 Power terminal block, 1
4 582212 124 Circuit breaker 2
5 582212 125 Power supply unit 1
9 582212 88 PIT 2,5 3
10 582212 89 D-ST2,5 1
11 582221 90 PE Connection bar 1 450mm
12 591103 56 Over current prot. Relay 1
15 594781 01 Distance 2
19 9002362 80 Relay module 5 See page 14
24 594009 03 Screw 8
25 593724 02 Distance screw 8
26 593724 01 Distance screw 2
29 9003490 01 Bracket set 1

44 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


5 Log box (optional)

3021A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 45


PureBallast 3.1 750

6 UV Reactor JIS
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9002700-
Ref Part No Description -84 Notes
Quantity
1 9002699 82 UV reactor JIS 1 See page 50
2 9010984 81 Junction box, A side 1 Valves, sensors & feed back
See page 52
3 9010987 80 Junction box 1 Lamp cables
See page 54
4 221803 02 Nut 8
5 223101 32 Washer 8
7 9001357 03 Sensor AT201-50 1
8A 9007167 24 Valve, A350 1
8B 9007166 06 Air actuator, AT 451U 1
8C 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
8D 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
8E 594410 01 Valve connector 1
8F 595215 01 Plate 1
8G 9009912 01 Sensor 1
8H 9015525 03 Indicator cap 1
8.1A 9007167 24 Valve, A350 1
8.1B 9007166 06 Air actuator, AT 451U 1
8.1C 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
8.1D 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
8.1E 594410 01 Valve connector 1
8.1F 595215 01 Plate 1
8.1G 9009912 01 Sensor 1
8.1H 9015525 03 Indicator cap 1
9 9011365 01 Hexagon head screw 32
10 223101 64 Washer 32
12 9006325 02 Thermometer, resistance 1 TT201-33
13 9006324 02 Temperature, switch 1 TS201-60
14 558663 04 Gasket washer 2
15 594171 01 Limit switch (vibration) 1 LS201-29
16A 9010631 99 Cable (valves and signals)
18 526350 05 Plug 1
19 558663 03 Gasket washer 2
20 594413 80 Valve 1 V320-4
See page 56
20.1 594413 80 Valve 1 V321-2
See page 56
20.2 594413 80 Valve 1 V404-36
See page 56
21 2210463 23 Screw 12
22 223101 37 Washer 12
23 9006822 01 Relief valve, 6 bar 1 RV201-23
24 597049 01 Coupling, elbow 90 1
25 594707 02 Pipe 1
26 581534 01 Distributor 1
27 260321 25 Hexagon screw 2
28 592304 01 Plug 1
29 592304 02 Plug, 1/4 1
30 552801 50 Push-on connector 5
31 9004638 01 Clamp 1
32 2210296 02 Screw 1
33 223101 33 Washer 2
34 221803 03 Nut 1
35A 9011226 99 Cable (UV lamp to junction box)
37 595272 01 Tube, 6x1 mm 4
38 558710 02 Air Hose Nipple 5
63 598571 02 Torx head pan screw M4 4
64 526336 04 Nipple 1
70 597044 03 Cable 2 PE, junction box - reactor

46 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6 UV Reactor JIS

2688A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 47


PureBallast 3.1 750

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9002700-
Ref Part No Description -84 Notes
Quantity
71 597044 04 Cable 1 PE, AOT reactor - hull
74 223101 32 Washer 3
81 221803 26 Nut 4
82 223101 41 Washer, 4,3x9x0,8 4
83 221031 22 Screw 3
93 593301 03 Insulating washer 32
94 593300 05 Insulating sleeve 32
95 554214 06 Cable tie 30
Z 9009521 80 Lamp, spare set
Z0.1 594645 82 Quartz sleeve set

48 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6 UV Reactor JIS

2688A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 49


PureBallast 3.1 750

6.1 UV reactor JIS


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9002699-
Ref Part No Description -82 Notes
Quantity
3 66169 Drive screw 8
6 9003326 01 Glass socket 32
7 221711 13 Screw 96
8 9002009 81 Lamp bush 32
9 9004878 80 Cap 32
10 9002860 01 Nut 32
20 221711 23 Screw 16
21 9003669 01 Bottom bracket 2
22 221040 04 Screw 16
23 41456 Washer 24
24 221035 06 Screw 4
25 70560 Washer 20
27 221035 36 Screw 8
28 9003662 01 Plate 1
29 2210295 03 Screw 1
30 223101 17 Washer 2
31 9003672 01 Upper bracket 2
32 221035 03 Screw 8
33A 9004889 01 Lifting bracket 1
33B 556465 01 Label 1
34 221040 55 Screw 4
35 35120 Nut 4
36 9007794 01 Cable rail 2
38 9009416 01 Cable rail 2
39 221031 21 Screw 8
40 223101 32 Washer 12
41 221803 28 Nut 4
43 9010633 01 Screw, hexagon socket 2
44 223101 47 Washer 2
45 221803 02 Nut 2

50 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6.1 UV reactor JIS 6 UV Reactor JIS

2685A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 51


PureBallast 3.1 750

6.2 Junction box, A side


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9010984-
Ref Part No Description -81 Notes
Quantity
1 9010981 01 Enclosure 1
2 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
3 582212 88 PIT 2,5 28 Marked acc. to electrical doc.
4 582212 122 Terminal block 3 Marked acc. to electrical doc.
6 582212 70 Plug In Bridge, FBS 3-5 1 402
7 582212 89 D-ST2,5 1
8 582212 151 Socket 6
9 582212 150 Socket 5
10 9003031 01 Condensation outlet 1
11 589569 58 Cable gland EMC-brush M32 2
12 589569 44 Counter nut EMC M32 2
13 591103 70 Pilot light White 1
14 591103 69 Pilot light Green 1

52 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6.2 Junction box, A side 6 UV Reactor JIS

2800A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 53


PureBallast 3.1 750

6.3 Junction box


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9010987-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9010983 01 Enclosure 1
2 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
3 582212 156 Terminal, PT 6 32 Marked acc. to electrical doc.
4 582212 157 End cover, D-PT 6 1
5 9003031 01 Condensation outlet 1
6 589569 58 Cable gland EMC-brush M32 4
7 9004959 01 Insert, 8x6 mm 4
8 589569 44 Counter nut EMC M32 4
9 589569 59 Cable gland EMC-brush M40 4
10 589569 45 Counter nut EMC M40 4

54 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6.3 Junction box 6 UV Reactor JIS

2888A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 55


PureBallast 3.1 750

6.4 Valve
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
594413-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 590037 01 Valve, DN32 1
2 576075 21 Air actuator, SR101 1
3 576071 01 Pilot valve 1
4 585976 01 Coil, 24 V DC 1
5 594410 01 Valve connector 1
6 583012 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
Z 576075 71 Actuator spare part kit, DA/SR 101 1

56 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


6.4 Valve 6 UV Reactor JIS

2330A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 57


PureBallast 3.1 750

7 Filter, ACB-985-300
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9023677-
Ref Part No Description -60 Notes
Quantity
1 9023657 60 Filter, ACB-985-300 1 See page 60
2 591090 04 Flange 1 1/4" 1
3 526337 08 Reducing hexagon nipple 1
5 221711 07 Screw 2
6 9024168 01 Elbow union 2
7 526337 02 Reducing hexagon nipple 2
8 1767267 01 Needle valve 2
9 9017973 01 Pressure transmitter 2
13 526336 04 Nipple 1
14 9006822 03 Relief valve, 10 bar 1
15 561094 06 Straight coupling 1
16 9019487 02 Tube 1
19 9023647 83 Gear motor 1
20 221046 01 Screw 4
21 9018672 23 M709-43 1
22 9024155 01 Bracket 1
23 7007238 01 Screw 4
24 9012246 80 Junction box 1 See page 62
25 221711 25 Screw 4
25.1 223101 32 Washer 4
25.2 221803 28 Nut 4
26 9026074 01 Cable bracket 1
27 221711 07 Screw 2
28 223101 32 Washer 2
29 9026072 01 Bracket 1
30 221711 07 Screw 2
31 221711 13 Screw 1
32 223101 32 Washer 3
33 587276 01 Washer 1
34 9025165 02 Cable 1
40 1270001 Lifting instruction 1

58 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


7 Filter, ACB-985-300

3040A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 59


PureBallast 3.1 750

7.1 Filter, ACB-985-300


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9023657-
Ref Part No Description -60 Notes
Quantity
4 9024205 07 Bolt 4
6 9011970 04 Bearing 1
7 9011972 04 Gasket 2
7.1 9011973 04 Bushing 1
8 9024206 07 Plug 2
9 9011974 50 Filter cover 1
10 9024205 15 Bolt 16
11 9011973 09 Bushing 1
12 9024205 23 Bolt 4
13 9011972 09 Gasket 1
14 9011974 35 Filter body 1
15 9011975 04 Filter element 1
16 9011972 14 Nozzle 1
17 9011972 19 Gasket 1
18 9011973 14 Bushing 1
19 9024206 15 Plug 3
20 9011972 24 Gasket 1
30 9024207 07 Nozzle support 1
31 9024205 31 Bolt 4
32 9011972 29 Gasket 1
33 9011974 23 Base frame 1
34 9024205 39 Bolt 4
36 9011970 32 Grease fitting 1
40 9024208 07 Ring spear 1
41 9011970 16 Bearing flange 1
42 9011970 24 Bearing flange 1
43 9024209 07 Retaining ring 1
44 9024210 07 Lifting lug 2
77 9011973 34 Bushing 1
80 9011978 04 Prefilter 1
87 9024206 23 Plug 6
Z 9011963 84 Maintenance kit Yearly maintenance

60 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


7.1 Filter, ACB-985-300 7 Filter, ACB-985-300

3044A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 61


PureBallast 3.1 750

7.2 Junction box


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9012246-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9012247 01 Enclosure 1
2 582212 148 End stop (clip fix) 2
3 582212 88 PIT 2,5 13
4 582212 122 Terminal block 4
4.1 590640 55 Terminal PT 6-PE 1
5 582212 89 D-ST2,5 1
5.1 582212 157 End cover, D-PT 6 1
6 589569 77 Cable Gland - M12 1
7 589569 48 Cable Gland - M16 3
9 589569 79 Cable Gland - M25 1
10 589569 80 Cable Gland - M32 1
11 589569 32 Counter nut M12 1
12 589569 33 Counter nut M16 3
13 589569 34 Counter nut M20 1
14 589569 35 Counter nut M25 1
15 589569 36 Counter nut M32 1

62 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


7.2 Junction box 7 Filter, ACB-985-300

2866A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 63


PureBallast 3.1 750

8 Adaptor
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9021972-
Ref Part No Description -87 Notes
Quantity
1 9021405 01 Adaptor plate, DN300-A300 1
2 9017549 08 Gasket 1
3 260192 08 Screw 12
4 223101 39 Washer 12

64 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


8 Adaptor

3033A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 65


PureBallast 3.1 750

9 Valve V309-1

NOT VALID IF BACKFLUSH PUMP IS INSTALLED.

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9025644-
Ref Part No Description -84 Notes
Quantity
1 9018543 64 Valve, EN DN80 1
1A 9007167 03 Valve, DN80 1
1B 9007166 01 Air actuator, AT 101U 1
1C 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
1D 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
1E 9007184 02 Insulate plate
1.1 594410 01 Valve connector 1
2 9018672 10 V309 1
4 2210463 03 Screw 8
5 223101 37 Washer 8
6 9021639 01 Adaptor, DN80-A80 1
7 2210463 03 Screw 8
8 223101 37 Washer 8

66 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


9 Valve V309-1

3023A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 67


PureBallast 3.1 750

10 Backf ush pump (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9025646-
Ref Part No Description -82 Notes
Quantity
1 9018653 05 Centrifugal pump 1
1.1 589569 79 Cable Gland - M25 1
1.2 589569 35 Counter nut M25 1
2 9018543 63 Valve, EN DN65 1
2A 9007167 02 Valve, DN65 1
2B 9007166 01 Air actuator, AT 101U 1
2C 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
2D 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
2.1 594410 01 Valve connector 1
4 9018672 10 V309 1
6 2210463 09 Screw 8
7 223101 37 Washer 16
8 221803 40 Nut 8
9 2210463 03 Screw 4
10 223101 37 Washer 4
11 1765908 08 Gasket 1
12 9025753 01 Elbow adaptor, 65 1
13 2210463 03 Screw 4
14 223101 37 Washer 4

68 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


10 Backflush pump (optional)

3034A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 69


PureBallast 3.1 750

11 Valve, JIS A300


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9007170-
Ref Part No Description -88 Notes
Quantity
1 9007167 23 Valve, A300 1
2 9007166 06 Air actuator, AT 451U 1
3 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
5 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
6 9007193 01 Actuator cable 1
7 9007196 02 Bracket 1
8 9007186 01 Switch box 1
19 587927 07 Locking device, AL79 451 1

70 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


11 Valve, JIS A300

2710A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 71


PureBallast 3.1 750

12 Valve V201-32 and 403-35


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9007172-
Ref Part No Description -88 -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9007167 15 Valve, A50 1
1 9007167 23 Valve, A300 1
2 9007166 01 Air actuator, AT 101U 1
2 9007166 06 Air actuator, AT 451U 1
3 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1 1
5 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2 2
6 9007193 01 Actuator cable 1 1
7 9007196 01 Bracket 1
7 9007196 02 Bracket 1
8 9007186 01 Switch box 1 1
Z 9007184 01 Insulate plate

72 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


12 Valve V201-32 and 403-35

2714A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 73


PureBallast 3.1 750

13 Control valve V201-8


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9007174-
Ref Part No Description -87 Notes
Quantity
1 9007167 22 Valve, A250 1
2 9007166 05 Air actuator, AT 351U 1
7 9007196 02 Bracket 1
9 9007191 01 Mounting kit, Positioner 1
10 9007190 01 Positioner 1
13 552801 02 Push-in connector 2
16 569035 05 Flexible pipe, PA12, 8/6 1
19 587927 05 Locking device, AL79 351 1
24 552801 02 Push-in connector 2
27 9007200 01 Manifold 1
28 9007201 01 Filter 1
29 571697 01 O-ring, small 1
30 523127 01 Hexagon nipple 1
31 592304 02 Plug, 1/4 1
Z 9007184 04 Insulate plate

74 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


13 Control valve V201-8

2712A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 75


PureBallast 3.1 750

14 Flow transmitter, A300


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9024585-
Ref Part No Description -93 Notes
Quantity
1 9024593 15 Flow transmitter, JIS A30 1
Z 9025145 01 Transmitter + display
Z0.1 9025145 02 Display
Z0.2 9030002 80 Cable gland kit

76 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


14 Flow transmitter, A300

3035A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 77


PureBallast 3.1 750

15 CIP module

*=On request only, contact your local Alfa Laval representative

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9002547-
Ref Part No Description -80* Notes
Quantity
1 9003450 01 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 02 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 03 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 04 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 05 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 06 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 07 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 08 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 09 Frame complete 1
1 9003450 10 Frame complete 1
2 590414 01 Tank 1
3 9004533 80 Pump P320-1 and P321-5 2 See page 82
4 9002825 80 Valve 7 See page 84
5 9003730 01 Valve housing 3
6 9002915 01 Check valve 2
7 9003732 01 O-ring 6
8 590313 01 Valve, angle seat 1
9 590476 01 Nipple, ISO-R 3/4-1/2 1
10 9005046 01 Backflow preventer 1
11 589526 07 U-bolt clamp, c-c 56,5 1
12 526350 06 Plug 1
13 569035 01 Flexible pipe, PA12, 6/4 1
14 569035 05 Flexible pipe, PA12, 8/6 1
15 9003172 80 Valve block 1 See page 86
16 9004479 80 Filter regulator 1
18 9003514 01 Speed controller 2
19 9004517 01 Reducer 2
20 9002962 01 Pipe #1 1
21 9002963 01 Pipe #2 1
22 9004237 01 Pipe #3 1
23 9003935 01 Pipe #4 2
24 9014747 01 Pipe #5 1
25 9014748 01 Pipe #6 1
26 9002586 01 Pipe #7 2
27 9003570 01 Pipe #8 4
28 9003949 01 Pipe #9 1
29 9002589 01 Pipe #10 1
30 9003792 01 Pipe #11 2
31 9002591 01 Pipe #12 1
32 9003837 01 Pipe #13 2
33 9004247 01 Pipe #14 1
34 9002592 01 Pipe #15 1
35 9003851 01 Pipe #16 1
36 9003853 01 Pipe #17 1
37 9003854 01 Pipe #18 2
38 9003863 01 Pipe #19 1
39 9003886 01 Pipe #20 1
40 9003888 01 Pipe #21 1
42 591675 01 Hose, 32 1
43 569038 05 Hose, 32 1
44 592665 01 Hose, 25 1
45 9003574 01 O-ring 6
46 9005743 01 Pipe clamp 5
47 599223 03 Hose clamp 38-50 10
48 599223 02 Hose clamp 32-44 3
49 592676 05 Insulation sheet, 10mm 4
50 592676 07 Insulation sheet, 5mm 7
51 592790 01 Insulation sheet 1
52 558710 01 Air Hose Nipple 1

78 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


15 CIP module

2558A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 79


PureBallast 3.1 750

*=On request only, contact your local Alfa Laval representative

Machine unit number or


Subassembly description
9002547-
Ref Part No Description -80* Notes
Quantity
53 221716 02 Screw 2
54 221711 17 Screw 2
55 221701 04 Screw 4
56 223101 41 Washer, 4,3x9x0,8 4
57 221711 16 Screw 18
58 223101 47 Washer 18
59 587276 02 Washer 2
60 27345 Nut, M8 12
61 70560 Washer 14
62 9005147 01 Pipe #22 1
63 552801 50 Push-on connector 7
64 221040 53 Screw 5
65 590539 03 Clip list 1
66 548152 03 Washer 5
67 9014736 01 Coupling 1
68 580758 06 Push-In Fittings 2
Z 590414 02 Tanck screw cap
Z0.1 9014527 81 Conversion kit, CIP Only relevant for CIP modules before
2012-11-13

80 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


15 CIP module

2558A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 81


PureBallast 3.1 750

15.1 Pump P320-1 and P321-5


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9004533-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9004533 01 Pump 1
Z 9004587 80 Spare part set Incl. O-rings, diaphragm, ball, muffler
indicated in dwg.
Z0.1 9004588 80 Spare part set Incl. air valve, sealings and O-rings,
indicated in dwg.

82 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


15.1 Pump P320-1 and P321-5 15 CIP module

2606A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 83


PureBallast 3.1 750

15.2 Valve
Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9002825-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9002825 01 Valve 1
Z 9003574 01 O-ring

84 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


15.2 Valve 15 CIP module

2609A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 85


PureBallast 3.1 750

15.3 Valve block


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9003172-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9003172 01 Valve block side 1
2 9003172 02 Valve block 5
3 9003172 03 Valve block side 1
4 9003172 04 Valve 2x 3/2 5
5 9003172 05 Connection box 1
6 9003172 06 Cable gland NPT3/4 1
7 9003172 07 Plug 1
8 9003172 08 Plug 1
9 9003172 09 O-ring 1
10 9003172 10 Sign bracket 2
11 9003172 11 Sign plate 1
13 9003172 12 Cable gland, M32 1

86 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


15.3 Valve block 15 CIP module

2607A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 87


PureBallast 3.1 750

16 Sampling device (QT201.1, QT201.1) (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
589745-
Ref Part No Description -90 -91 Notes
Quantity
1 591662 80 Adaptor pipe 1 1
2 591667 01 Pitot tube 1 1
3 1765908 07 Gasket 2 2
4 2210462 30 Screw 4 4 M6S 16x70 fzb
5 221803 34 Nut, M16 4 4 M6M 16 fzb
6 70490 Washer 16 16 BRB 17x30x3 fzb
7 591631 01 Blind flange, DN50/A50 1 1
8 591628 81 Valve, manual A50 1 1
9 2210462 28 Screw 8 M6S 16x45 fzb
9 2210462 45 Screw, M16x45 8 M6S 16x45 fzb
14 591666 01 Rod 1 1

88 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


16 Sampling device (QT201.1, QT201.1)
(optional)

2780A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 89


PureBallast 3.1 750

17 Pressure monitoring device


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9006076-
Ref Part No Description -82 Notes
Quantity
1 9007231 01 Needle valve, DN15 1
2 526336 04 Nipple 3
3 9006075 01 Manifold 1
4 9001406 83 Pressure transmitter Kit 1
5 543054 09 Pressure gauge 1 0-16 bar
6 9006822 02 Relief valve, 8 bar 1
8 544465 06 Locking liquid 1

90 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


17 Pressure monitoring device

2709A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 91


PureBallast 3.1 750

18 Booster pump, P401-1 (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9019601-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9019604 01 Pump 1
5 589569 34 Counter nut M20 1
Z 9019944 02 Shaft seal

92 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


18 Booster pump, P401-1 (optional)

3036A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 93


PureBallast 3.1 750

19 Booster pump, P403-1, JIS (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9019606-
Ref Part No Description -91 Notes
Quantity
1 9019609 02 Centrifugal pump 1
1.2 589569 34 Counter nut M20 1
4 2210463 23 Screw 4
5 223101 37 Washer 4
6 1765908 03 Gasket 1
7 9019321 01 Adaptor plate, A50-DN50 1
8 9017549 03 Gasket 1
9 2210463 23 Screw 4
10 223101 37 Washer 4
11 2210463 07 Screw 4
12 223101 37 Washer 8
13 221803 40 Nut 4
14 1765908 06 Gasket 1
Z 9019944 01 Centrifugal pump spare pa

94 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


19 Booster pump, P403-1, JIS (optional)

3037A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 95


PureBallast 3.1 750

20 Air f lter regulator (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9018092-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
1 9018092 01 Filter regulator 1
2 9018092 02 Pressure relief valve 1
3 9018092 03 Bracket 1
Z 9018092 99 Filter element Replace every 2 years

96 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


20 Air filter regulator (optional)

3039A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 97


PureBallast 3.1 750

21 Extended options (SPC)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9025583-
Ref Part No Description - Notes
Quantity
11 9007168 68 Valve V212-31 (optional) 1 V212-31
See page 100
41 9022284 80 Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional) 1 See page 102

98 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


21 Extended options (SPC)

2377A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 99


PureBallast 3.1 750

21.1 Valve V212-31 (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9007168-
Ref Part No Description -68 Notes
Quantity
1 9007167 09 Valve, DN300 1
2 9007166 06 Air actuator, AT 451U 1
3 9007185 01 Pilot valve 1
5 9007192 01 Throttle valve, 1/4 2
6 9007193 01 Actuator cable 1
7 9007196 02 Bracket 1
8 9007186 01 Switch box 1
12 9005789 03 Gearbox 1
13 552801 02 Push-in connector 1
14 1764011 02 Silencer 1
15 592304 02 Plug, 1/4 1
16 569035 05 Flexible pipe, PA12, 8/6 1
17 580758 06 Push-In Fittings 1
18 9005792 02 Handwheel 1
19 587927 07 Locking device, AL79 451 1

100 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


21.1 Valve V212-31 (optional) 21 Extended options (SPC)

2716A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 101


PureBallast 3.1 750

21.2 Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional)


Machine unit number or
Subassembly description
9022284-
Ref Part No Description -80 Notes
Quantity
2 9019604 01 Pump 1 P401-1
3 9022405 01 Heat exchanger 1
5 9022377 01 Expansion tank 1
6 9022378 01 Relief valve 1 RV401
7 591090 03 Flange 2
8 1765908 01 Gasket 2
9 526353 11 Reducing hexagon nipple 2
10 592823 01 Tee, 3/4 2
11 526338 05 Bushing 1
12 523127 04 Hexagon nipple 4
13 523127 07 Hexagon nipple 2
15 546600 04 Pipe union 1
16 576636 04 Ball valve 3/4" 1 V370-1
17 2245102 09 Hose clip 1
18 9022296 01 Hose 1
19 9022297 01 Pipe 1
20 9022302 01 Hose 1
21 589526 05 U-bolt clamp, c-c 35 1
22 221891 14 Nut 2 Lock nut, M8
23 221046 07 Screw 4 Screw, M12x45
24 221046 09 Screw 8 Screw, M12x60
25 221803 22 Nut 12 Nut, M12
26 223101 35 Washer 24 Washer, M12
27 221041 20 Screw 2 Screw, M10x25
28 221803 29 Nut 6 Nut, M10
29 223101 61 Washer 10 Washer, M10
30 221036 02 Screw 2 Screw, M8x25
31 221803 21 Nut 2 Nut, M8
32 223101 33 Washer 6 Washer, M8
33 544465 06 Locking liquid 1
35 589569 34 Counter nut M20 1
37 9018672 33 RV401 1
38 9018672 34 PI401 1
39 9018672 20 V370-1 1
40 9018672 35 P401-1 1
42 221891 15 Lock nut 2 Lock nut, M10
44 9023059 01 Extension socket 1
Z 9019944 02 Shaft seal
Z0.1 9022920 01 End plate 1
Z0.2 9022920 02 End plate 2
Z0.3 9022920 03 Channel plate

102 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


21.2 Closed cooling unit, LDC (optional) 21 Extended options (SPC)

3019A

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 103


22 Cross reference list

22 Cross reference list

+ Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.
1270001 21 84 221711 13 58 31 221891 04 10 18
1270001 58 40 221711 16 10 28 221891 05 10 33
1270001 8 74 221711 16 40 3 221891 05 21 68
1764011 02 100 14 221711 16 42 4 221891 05 24 4
1765908 01 102 8 221711 16 80 57 221891 05 24 67
1765908 03 94 6 221711 17 80 54 221891 05 40 36
1765908 06 94 14 221711 19 10 21 221891 05 42 13
1765908 07 88 3 221711 23 50 20 221891 05 10 7
1765908 08 68 11 221711 25 58 25 221891 14 102 22
1767267 01 58 8 221716 01 24 5 221891 15 102 42
2210295 03 50 29 221716 01 24 68 223101 03 20 6
2210296 02 46 32 221716 01 10 8 223101 04 20 11.1
221030 02 24 62 221716 02 80 53 223101 16 24 40
221030 10 20 3 221726 10 26 69 223101 17 20 16
221030 10 20 10 221803 02 20 12 223101 17 50 30
221030 10 24 45 221803 02 24 52 223101 31 10 38
221030 10 26 18 221803 02 26 10 223101 32 46 5
221030 10 26 21 221803 02 46 4 223101 32 47 74
221031 21 50 39 221803 02 50 45 223101 32 50 40
221031 22 47 83 221803 02 10 23 223101 32 58 25.1
221035 03 50 32 221803 03 20 15 223101 32 58 28
221035 06 50 24 221803 03 46 34 223101 32 58 32
221035 36 50 27 221803 21 102 31 223101 33 46 33
221035 51 26 4 221803 22 102 25 223101 33 102 32
221036 02 102 30 221803 26 47 81 223101 35 102 26
221040 04 50 22 221803 28 50 41 223101 37 46 22
221040 53 80 64 221803 28 58 25.2 223101 37 66 5
221040 55 50 34 221803 29 102 28 223101 37 66 8
221041 20 102 27 221803 34 88 5 223101 37 68 7
221046 01 58 20 221803 40 68 8 223101 37 68 10
221046 07 102 23 221803 40 94 13 223101 37 68 14
221046 09 102 24 221851 05 24 35 223101 37 94 5
2210462 28 88 9 221851 05 40 7 223101 37 94 10
2210462 30 88 4 221851 05 6 49 223101 37 94 12
2210462 45 88 9 221851 18 10 37 223101 39 64 4
2210463 03 66 4 221891 01 20 7 223101 41 26 58
2210463 03 66 7 221891 02 24 39 223101 41 47 82
2210463 03 68 9 221891 02 26 59 223101 41 80 56
2210463 03 68 13 221891 04 10 30 223101 47 10 29
2210463 07 94 11 221891 04 20 52 223101 47 20 3.1
2210463 09 68 6 221891 04 21 62 223101 47 20 11
2210463 23 46 21 221891 04 24 8 223101 47 20 51
2210463 23 94 4 221891 04 24 11 223101 47 21 61
2210463 23 94 9 221891 04 24 17 223101 47 24 7
221701 03 6 51 221891 04 24 64 223101 47 24 10
221701 04 80 55 221891 04 40 10 223101 47 24 16
221711 07 58 5 221891 04 40 26 223101 47 24 34
221711 07 58 27 221891 04 40 30 223101 47 24 44
221711 07 58 30 221891 04 42 6 223101 47 24 51
221711 13 50 7 221891 04 6 8 223101 47 24 63

104 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


PureBallast 3.1 750

Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.

223101 47 26 9 556465 01 50 33B 582212 05 44 1


223101 47 26 19 558663 03 46 19 582212 102 6 25
223101 47 26 22 558663 04 46 14 582212 104 6 27
223101 47 40 6 558710 01 78 52 582212 105 6 28
223101 47 40 9 558710 02 46 38 582212 119 14 1
223101 47 40 25 561094 06 58 15 582212 120 14 2
223101 47 40 29 569035 01 78 13 582212 121 14 3
223101 47 42 5 569035 05 74 16 582212 122 6 11
223101 47 6 48 569035 05 78 14 582212 122 20 41
223101 47 50 44 569035 05 100 16 582212 122 34 4
223101 47 80 58 569038 05 78 43 582212 122 36 3
223101 47 6 9 571697 01 74 29 582212 122 44 2
223101 49 26 68 576071 01 56 3 582212 122 52 4
223101 61 102 29 576075 21 56 2 582212 122 62 4
223101 64 46 10 576075 71 56 Z 582212 123 6 32
223101 73 10 24 576636 04 102 16 582212 123 44 3
223107 34 10 17 580758 06 80 68 582212 124 44 4
2245102 09 102 17 580758 06 100 17 582212 125 44 5
260192 08 64 3 580986 06 12 9 582212 130 34 3
260321 25 46 27 580986 08 12 5 582212 130 36 6
26556 10 4 580986 16 12 10 582212 132 36 5
27345 80 60 580986 16 30 11 582212 133 36 11
35120 50 35 580986 17 12 2 582212 136 34 9
41456 50 23 580986 17 30 2 582212 137 34 8
523127 01 74 30 580986 19 30 12 582212 137 36 9
523127 04 20 19 580986 20 12 11 582212 13 6 12
523127 04 102 12 580986 20 30 13 582212 13 20 42
523127 07 102 13 580986 30 12 3 582212 13 36 4
526336 04 46 64 580986 32 12 7 582212 146 20 46
526336 04 58 13 580986 40 30 8 582212 147 21 63
526336 04 90 2 580986 51 12 4 582212 147 6 22
526337 02 58 7 580986 53 12 6 582212 147 40 15
526337 08 58 3 580986 53 30 9 582212 147 8 83
526338 05 102 11 580986 55 12 12 582212 148 20 34
526350 05 46 18 580986 59 12 8 582212 148 32 6
526350 06 78 12 580986 59 30 7 582212 148 34 1
526353 11 102 9 580986 61 30 10 582212 148 36 1
543054 09 90 5 580986 62 30 3 582212 148 40 11
544465 06 90 8 580986 63 30 4 582212 148 40 31
544465 06 102 33 580986 64 30 1 582212 148 52 2
546600 04 102 15 580986 72 30 5 582212 148 54 2
548152 03 80 66 580986 76 12 1.2 582212 148 62 2
552801 02 74 13 580986 76 8 87 582212 148 8 81
552801 02 74 24 581534 01 46 26 582212 148 8 85
552801 02 100 13 581688 01 10 26 582212 148 6 10
552801 50 46 30 581688 01 42 3 582212 150 52 9
552801 50 80 63 581803 43 20 29 582212 151 52 8
554214 01 21 85 582212 03 32 5 582212 155 40 16
554214 01 8 75 582212 03 40 12.1 582212 155 6 56
554214 06 47 95 582212 04 40 14 582212 156 36 7

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 105


22 Cross reference list

Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.

582212 156 54 3 583556 04 24 21 590539 03 80 65


582212 157 36 10 583556 16 6 43 590624 03 20 13
582212 157 54 4 583556 17 6 42 590640 55 62 4.1
582212 157 62 5.1 583556 19 24 19 591090 03 102 7
582212 15 34 7 583556 20 24 18 591090 04 58 2
582212 15 36 8 583556 21 24 20 591103 03 20 58
582212 15 6 38 585976 01 56 4 591103 10 20 35.1
582212 164 20 28 586056 07 24 22 591103 10 8 76.3
582212 165 20 30 587276 01 58 33 591103 32 20 43
582212 168 6 31 587276 02 10 31 591103 37 6 59.1
582212 172 14 Z 587276 02 21 66 591103 40 20 57
582212 182 20 45 587276 02 24 3 591103 41 21 59
582212 202 28 2 587276 02 40 34 591103 46 20 55
582212 203 28 3 587276 02 42 11 591103 54 8 77
582212 204 28 4 587276 02 80 59 591103 56 44 12
582212 205 28 5 587276 02 10 6 591103 60 8 78
582212 206 6 37 587927 05 74 19 591103 61 20 56
582212 207 6 40 587927 07 70 19 591103 62 21 Z
582212 214 40 22.1 587927 07 100 19 591103 64 20 37
582212 215 40 39 589526 05 102 21 591103 64 8 76.2
582212 215 8 68 589526 07 78 11 591103 67 6 52
582212 63 6 18 589569 32 62 11 591103 69 20 21
582212 63 32 3 589569 33 42 10 591103 69 52 14
582212 63 6 30 589569 33 62 12 591103 70 20 24
582212 64 32 2 589569 34 62 13 591103 70 52 13
582212 67 6 17 589569 34 92 5 591103 71 20 26
582212 67 32 1 589569 34 94 1.2 591103 72 40 20
582212 67 6 29 589569 34 102 35 591103 86 20 35
582212 70 52 6 589569 35 42 8 591103 86 8 76
582212 71 6 17.1 589569 35 62 14 591103 87 20 26.1
582212 71 32 4 589569 35 68 1.2 591103 88 20 26.2
582212 88 34 5 589569 36 62 15 591103 89 20 26.3
582212 88 44 9 589569 44 52 12 591103 91 20 44
582212 88 52 3 589569 44 54 8 591103 92 40 20.1
582212 88 62 3 589569 45 54 10 591628 81 88 8
582212 89 34 6 589569 48 42 9 591631 01 88 7
582212 89 44 10 589569 48 62 7 591662 80 88 1
582212 89 52 7 589569 58 52 11 591666 01 88 14
582212 89 62 5 589569 58 54 6 591667 01 88 2
582212 90 16 5 589569 59 54 9 591675 01 78 42
582212 90 8 86 589569 77 62 6 591874 04 26 29
582212 91 6 23 589569 79 42 7 591874 06 26 30
582212 91 8 84 589569 79 62 9 591889 01 24 46
582212 95 40 12 589569 79 68 1.1 592005 14 40 8
582212 96 40 13 589569 80 62 10 592005 15 24 13
582221 101 8 67 590037 01 56 1 592122 03 40 4
582221 90 20 31 590313 01 78 8 592122 03 6 4
582221 90 6 35 590414 01 78 2 592304 01 46 28
582221 90 44 11 590414 02 80 Z 592304 02 46 29
583012 01 56 6 590476 01 78 9 592304 02 74 31

106 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


PureBallast 3.1 750

Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.

592304 02 100 15 595673 03 38 14 9003024 02 10 14


592665 01 78 44 595673 03 8 82 9003030 01 24 50
592676 05 78 49 595673 04 16 4 9003031 01 26 64
592676 07 78 50 595673 04 40 23 9003031 01 52 10
592790 01 78 51 595673 04 40 33 9003031 01 54 5
592823 01 102 10 595728 02 40 32 9003075 01 26 15
593239 01 10 25 595728 02 8 80 9003089 02 26 67
593254 01 26 16 597033 10 30 6 9003113 01 26 57
593254 01 10 20 597033 18 12 1.1 9003114 02 21 Z0.1
593282 01 10 22 597033 22 12 1 9003114 02 26 56
593300 05 47 94 597044 03 46 70 9003172 01 86 1
593301 03 47 93 597044 04 47 71 9003172 02 86 2
593724 01 44 26 597049 01 46 24 9003172 03 86 3
593724 02 44 25 597330 01 21 Z0.2 9003172 04 86 4
593724 03 20 32 597331 01 21 Z0.3 9003172 05 86 5
593724 03 6 34 598323 02 28 1 9003172 06 86 6
593778 01 10 10 598571 01 10 36 9003172 07 86 7
593779 01 10 11 598571 02 46 63 9003172 08 86 8
593780 01 26 55 599223 02 78 48 9003172 09 86 9
593780 01 10 15 599223 03 78 47 9003172 10 86 10
593991 01 10 12 66169 50 3 9003172 11 86 11
594009 02 24 41 7007238 01 58 23 9003172 12 86 13
594009 02 6 39 70490 88 6 9003172 80 78 15
594009 03 20 33 70560 10 32 9003186 01 26 23
594009 03 6 36 70560 21 67 9003186 02 26 65
594009 03 44 24 70560 24 66 9003326 01 50 6
594009 04 20 5 70560 40 35 9003390 01 24 42
594009 05 24 55 70560 42 12 9003401 01 26 20
594009 06 40 28 70560 50 25 9003410 01 26 17
594009 07 21 70 70560 80 61 9003450 01 78 1
594171 01 46 15 9001357 03 46 7 9003450 02 78 1
594410 01 46 8E 9001406 83 90 4 9003450 03 78 1
594410 01 46 8.1E 9002009 81 50 8 9003450 04 78 1
594410 01 56 5 9002362 80 6 33 9003450 05 78 1
594410 01 66 1.1 9002362 80 44 19 9003450 06 78 1
594410 01 68 2.1 9002586 01 78 26 9003450 07 78 1
594413 80 46 20 9002589 01 78 29 9003450 08 78 1
594413 80 46 20.1 9002591 01 78 31 9003450 09 78 1
594413 80 46 20.2 9002592 01 78 34 9003450 10 78 1
594488 01 10 27 9002699 82 46 1 9003490 01 44 29
594488 01 42 2 9002825 01 84 1 9003514 01 78 18
594645 82 47 Z0.1 9002825 80 78 4 9003522 06 6 44
594707 02 46 25 9002860 01 50 10 9003522 07 6 45
594728 01 20 8 9002915 01 78 6 9003565 02 24 15
594781 01 44 15 9002942 01 24 57 9003565 03 24 14
595215 01 46 8F 9002947 01 24 56 9003570 01 78 27
595215 01 46 8.1F 9002962 01 78 20 9003574 01 78 45
595272 01 46 37 9002963 01 78 21 9003574 01 84 Z
595361 02 8 63 9003013 01 10 13 9003662 01 50 28
595673 02 16 6 9003024 01 26 54A 9003669 01 50 21

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 107


22 Cross reference list

Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.
9006806 01 6 7 9007193 01 70 6
9003672 01 50 31
9006814 01 6 41 9007193 01 72 6
9003730 01 78 5
9006822 01 46 23 9007193 01 100 6
9003732 01 78 7
9006822 02 90 6 9007196 01 72 7
9003792 01 78 30
9006822 03 58 14 9007196 02 70 7
9003837 01 78 32
9006851 01 6 2 9007196 02 72 7
9003851 01 78 35
9006852 01 6 3 9007196 02 74 7
9003853 01 78 36
9006853 01 8 61 9007196 02 100 7
9003854 01 78 37
9006854 01 8 62 9007200 01 74 27
9003863 01 78 38
9007166 01 66 1B 9007201 01 74 28
9003886 01 78 39
9007166 01 68 2B 9007231 01 90 1
9003888 01 78 40
9003935 01 9007166 01 72 2 9007794 01 50 36
78 23
9003949 01 78 28 9007166 05 74 2 9008383 01 38 1
9004211 01 20 2 9007166 06 46 8B 9008383 02 38 2
9004212 01 24 37 9007166 06 46 8.1B 9008383 06 16 1
9004213 01 24 38 9007166 06 70 2 9008383 06 38 6
9004214 01 20 9 9007166 06 72 2 9008383 08 16 2
9004237 01 78 22 9007166 06 100 2 9008383 08 38 9
9004247 01 78 33 9007167 02 68 2A 9008383 12 38 7
9004254 01 20 18 9007167 03 66 1A 9008383 13 38 8
9004299 04 6 16 9007167 09 100 1 9008383 15 16 8
9004299 04 20 39 9007167 15 72 1 9008387 01 16 3
9004303 02 20 14 9007167 22 74 1 9008387 01 38 11
9004313 82 20 53 9007167 23 70 1 9008403 80 20 17
9004426 01 20 20 9007167 23 72 1 9008424 01 26 66
9004439 01 38 15 9007167 24 46 8A 9008693 01 38 12
9004442 03 20 27 9007167 24 46 8.1A 9008903 05 26 3
9004479 80 78 16 9007168 68 98 11 9009416 01 50 38
9004517 01 78 19 9007184 01 72 Z 9009521 80 47 Z
9004533 01 82 1 9007184 02 66 1E 9009760 01 40 22
9004533 80 78 3 9007184 04 74 Z 9009912 01 46 8G
9004587 80 82 Z 9007185 01 46 8C 9009912 01 46 8.1G
9004588 80 82 Z0.1 9007185 01 46 8.1C 9010631 99 46 16A
9004638 01 46 31 9007185 01 66 1C 9010633 01 50 43
9004878 80 50 9 9007185 01 68 2C 9010981 01 52 1
9004889 01 50 33A 9007185 01 70 3 9010983 01 54 1
9004959 01 54 7 9007185 01 72 3 9010984 81 46 2
9005046 01 78 10 9007185 01 100 3 9010987 80 46 3
9005147 01 80 62 9007186 01 70 8 9011226 99 46 35A
9005494 04 20 54 9007186 01 72 8 9011365 01 46 9
9005743 01 78 46 9007186 01 100 8 9011552 01 40 18
9005789 03 100 12 9007190 01 74 10 9011552 01 6 54
9005792 02 100 18 9007191 01 74 9 9011936 80 21 64
9006075 01 90 3 9007192 01 46 8D 9011943 80 40 38
9006316 01 24 43 9007192 01 46 8.1D 9011944 01 42 1
9006322 01 24 61 9007192 01 66 1D 9011951 80 24 1
9006324 02 46 13 9007192 01 68 2D 9011952 80 20 1
9006325 02 46 12 9007192 01 70 5 9011960 01 40 24
9006677 01 20 50 9007192 01 72 5 9011963 84 60 Z
9006805 01 6 6 9007192 01 100 5 9011970 04 60 6

108 Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2


PureBallast 3.1 750

Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref. Part No. Page Ref.

9011970 16 60 41 9015117 01 10 40 9019604 01 102 2


9011970 24 60 42 9015118 01 10 39 9019609 02 94 1
9011970 32 60 36 9015123 01 10 42 9019944 01 94 Z
9011972 04 60 7 9015197 82 21 86 9019944 02 92 Z
9011972 09 60 13 9015525 03 46 8H 9019944 02 102 Z
9011972 14 60 16 9015525 03 46 8.1H 9021405 01 64 1
9011972 19 60 17 9015557 80 40 37 9021639 01 66 6
9011972 24 60 20 9015611 01 24 6 9022284 80 98 41
9011972 29 60 32 9015616 01 24 65 9022296 01 102 18
9011973 04 60 7.1 9015692 01 38 16 9022297 01 102 19
9011973 09 60 11 9015704 01 38 3 9022302 01 102 20
9011973 14 60 18 9015704 02 38 4 9022377 01 102 5
9011973 34 60 77 9015704 03 38 5 9022378 01 102 6
9011974 23 60 33 9015704 04 38 17 9022405 01 102 3
9011974 35 60 14 9016266 01 26 50 9022920 01 102 Z0.1
9011974 50 60 9 9016266 02 26 54 9022920 02 102 Z0.2
9011975 04 60 15 9016268 01 26 51 9022920 03 102 Z0.3
9011978 04 60 80 9016270 01 26 50.1 9023059 01 102 44
9012046 80 18 1 9016593 01 40 3.1 9023647 83 58 19
9012058 80 20 4 9017549 03 94 8 9023657 60 58 1
9012086 83 6 1 9017549 08 64 2 9024155 01 58 22
9012091 81 10 2 9017973 01 58 9 9024168 01 58 6
9012093 01 10 41 9018092 01 96 1 9024205 07 60 4
9012135 80 20 40 9018092 02 96 2 9024205 15 60 10
9012146 01 18 2 9018092 03 96 3 9024205 23 60 12
9012150 81 8 66 9018092 99 96 Z 9024205 31 60 31
9012193 01 24 2 9018543 63 68 2 9024205 39 60 34
9012198 80 21 65 9018543 64 66 1 9024206 07 60 8
9012246 80 58 24 9018653 05 68 1 9024206 15 60 19
9012247 01 62 1 9018672 10 66 2 9024206 23 60 87
9014527 81 80 Z0.1 9018672 10 68 4 9024207 07 60 30
9014546 01 20 47 9018672 20 102 39 9024208 07 60 40
9014554 01 24 54 9018672 23 58 21 9024209 07 60 43
9014585 01 24 53 9018672 33 102 37 9024210 07 60 44
9014640 01 26 5 9018672 34 102 38 9024593 15 76 1
9014642 01 26 6 9018672 35 102 40 9025145 01 76 Z
9014704 80 20 48 9019135 03 6 13 9025145 02 76 Z0.1
9014707 01 6 15 9019135 03 6 14 9025165 02 58 34
9014707 01 20 38 9019135 04 6 19 9025753 01 68 12
9014732 01 26 52 9019135 04 6 20 9025837 01 6 59
9014735 01 26 53 9019138 01 6 13.1 9025837 02 6 59.2
9014736 01 80 67 9019138 01 6 14.1 9025840 80 6 21
9014747 01 78 24 9019138 02 6 20.1 9025887 01 10 5
9014748 01 78 25 9019138 03 6 19.1 9026072 01 58 29
9014753 01 10 34 9019186 05 6 24 9026074 01 58 26
9014759 01 26 34 9019186 06 6 26 9030002 80 76 Z0.2
9014762 01 26 49 9019186 07 6 50
9014815 01 10 35 9019321 01 94 7
9014833 01 21 60 9019487 02 58 16
9014979 01 40 1 9019604 01 92 1

Book No. 9028682 02 Rev. 2 109

You might also like